PureSample
pr 1 od00 uc 0+ ts !
TM
Laboratory &
EQUIPMENT SUPPLIES
PLANT PHYSIOLOGY
REFRACTOMETERS
MICROSCOPES
BATHS & CIRCULATORS
FUME HOODS & CABINETS
www.ereinc.com
ORDERS, SERVICE & TECH SUPPORT:
1-888-287-3732
TEL
514-326-8852
sales@ereinc.com
CENTRIFUGES
ERE Inc. Environmental Remediation Equipment Inc. 8605 Champs d’Eau Montreal, Quebec, Canada H1P 3B8 Tel: (514) 326 8852 • Fax: (514) 326 8961
Ordering Information You can order by phone, fax, email, and online. Our PureSample™ customer service staff will be happy to assist you.
Telephone: 1-888-287-3732 Fax: 514-326-8961 Email: sales@ereinc.com Register online today and receive our monthly promotions and product updates:
www.ereinc.com
Discounts available for bulk orders or yearly contracts
Our products are subject to change.
Table of Contents Air Sampling
1
Sampling for Gel-Impaction Slides, Sampling for Viable Bioaerosols
50
Electrophoresis Systems & Transilluminators, Thermal Cyclers
Anaerobic Chambers
2
Autoclaves
3
Balances
4
Baths & Circulators
Molecular Biology
12
Baths, Immersion Circulators, Cooling & Heating Circulator Baths
Oxygen & Carbon Dioxide Testing
52
pH
54
Plant Physiology
61
Refractometers
66
Refractometers, Polarimeters
Centrifuges
16
Sieves & Sieve Shakers
74
Cryoscopes
24
Shakers & Stirrers
77
Fume Hoods & Cabinets
25
Surface Tension
81
Incubators
27
Ultrasonic Sonifiers & Baths
82
Ultrasonics, Ultrasonic Cleaners
Microscopes
32
Water Analysis
86
Water Purification
90
General Laboratory Supplies
93
Elite Compound Microscopes, Compound Microscopes, Inverted Microscopes, Zoom Stereomicroscopes, Elite Microscope Cameras, Basic Microscope Cameras, Meiji Techno Microscopes, Microscope Accessories
Mills & Grinders
44
Jaw Crushers, Rotor Mills, Cutting Mills, Knife Mills, Disc Mills, Mortar Grinders, Mixer Mills, Planetary Ball Mills
AIR SAMPLING
Sampling for Gel-Impaction Slides
Buck Bio-Culture™
Buck BioSlideTM
The Bio-Culture™ sampling pump provides selectable, continuous (6 to 8 hours), constant sample flowrate and is simple to operate. Its quiet operation allows unobtrusive sampling in IAQ, medical, clean room, public & residential building applications.
Model B1020 Bioaerosol sampling pump is compact, lightweight, 10 - 20 LPM controlled flow sampling pump for bioaerosol sampling with Impaction-Gel. Both an LED & audible alarm provide confirmation of end-of-sample or depleted battery. Convenient timer for 1, 2, 5, 10 minute samples & continuous mode. A full five hours of continuous operation (at 15 LPM). It comes with a calibrated rotameter for quick flow check or calibration and a charger.
Features • Holds 90 mm agar Petri dish • Flows up to 120 LPM • 380 holes - 1 mm diameter • Convenient timer for 1, 2, 5,10 minute samples & continuous mode • Tripod mount to allow 90 degree sampling • Sampling head is easily sterilized with gas torch or autoclave • 4 times the flow rate of an Anderson sampler
Sampling for Viable Bioaerosols MicroFlowTM Microbiological Air Sampler The MicroFlowTM Microbiological Air Sampler is used for sampling biocontaminants (bacteria, molds, spores, fungi, pollen, etc.) in any production or environmentally controlled area. MicroFlowTM allows to verify & quantify microorganism presence.
Buck BioAireTM Model B520 Bioaerosol sampling pump is compact, lightweight, 5 - 20 LPM controlled flow sampling pump for bioaerosol sampling. Accommodates the BioAireTM cassettes as well as the Air-O-CellTM. Both an LED & audible alarm provide confirmation of end-of-sample or depleted battery. Convenient timer for 1, 2, 5, 10 minute samples & continuous mode. A full five hours of continuous operation (at 15 LPM). It comes with a calibrated rotameter for quick flow check or calibration & charger.
1
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Features • Autoclavable anodized aluminum support plate & aluminum sampling head with conical holes; 60 mm head: 219 holes (1 mm) 90 mm head: 380 holes (1 mm) • Manual, sequential, or programmable with delayed start • Five flow rates 30, 60, 90, 100, 120 LPM • Data logging up to 99 samples • Remote operation via infrared control • Sample in horizontal or vertical without tripod auxilium • 5 languages: English, Spanish, German, French & Italian
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Anaerobic Chambers SHEL LAB BacBASIC
Ergonomically designed arm port doors offer maximum reach and comfort! The BacBASIC is the perfect auxiliary chamber option for overflow work, extra plate storage and emergency back-up for your primary chamber!
The SHEL LAB BacBASIC offers • An ample, ergonomic, user-friendly work station with a space-saving exterior footprint. • Excellent lighting and visibility. • A quick-entry, gloveless sleeve system. • A rapid auto-purge pass box for introducing Petri plates, specimens and supplies. Purge time is less than 50 seconds. • Incubated storage capacity for up to 150 Petri plates. • Incubation temperature range from ambient temperature to 42ºC. • Easy change anatox.
SHEL LAB BACTRON Anaerobic Chambers
The SHEL LAB BACTRON anaerobic & environmental chamber line offers multiple high-value features and essential benefits. Incubator Petri plate capacities and chamber dimensions accommodate varied laboratory needs and budgets. Ranging from 100 to 900 Petri plate incubator capacities, the BACTRON chamber line can address a myriad of anaerobic, hypoxic or other special gas environment applications.
ANAEROBIC CHAMBERS
The BacBASIC is the ideal, entry level chamber for performance of truly anaerobic microbiology. Move beyond jars and the unnecessary exposure of your anaerobes to deadly oxygen.
Included with each system • Vacuum pump with fittings and hoses • Two year limited warranty • Two catalyst cartridges • Petri plate racks • Sleeve assembly with small cuffs (Large and medium cuffs are also available)
The complete environmental microbiology workstation: anaerobic, hypoxic, & other gas environments BACTRON Models BACTRON I - Plate Capacity 150 BACTRON II - Plate Capacity 208 BACTRON III - Plate Capacity 308 BACTRON IV - Plate Capacity 600 BACTRON IV 900 - Plate Capacity 900 Bactrox Hypoxia Chamber
Applications Anaerobic microbiology assays Clinical microbiology Anaerobic tissue culture research Anaerobic bacteriology Hypoxic tissue culture research Microaerophilic / hypoxic Quality control Packaging R&D Industrial research
Bactrox Hypoxia Chamber This latest addition to the SHEL LAB Bactron line offers precise oxygen control ranging from 1% to 20% for microaerophilic bacteriology and hypoxic tissue or cell culture applications. With the additional capability of controlling carbon dioxide from 1% to 20%. The SHEL LAB Bactrox permits oxygen and carbon dioxide control in increments of 1/10th of a percent. Benefits • Ultra bright LED examination lights • Stainless steel body construction • Independent gas controls • RS232 data collection • Condensation control • Immediate access to workspace via sleeves • Standard microscope adapter accessories • PC calibration of oxygen sensor
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
2
Autoclaves
Featuring closed door drying
AUTOCLAVES
Pelton & Crane Delta Q Sterilizer • Approved for hand piece sterilization • Closed door filtered air drying ensures wet packs and pouches dry without compromising sterility of instruments by airborne contaminants • Variable timed drying cycle saves time by giving operator the flexibility to set drying time according to load size • Automatic chamber preheat maximizes productivity by shortening cycle times • Electronic temperature and time control systematically monitor sterilization conditions in chamber to ensure cycle completion • One custom and four automatic preprogrammed sterilization settings allow you to select the appropriate cycle according to type of load • Digital function display allows easy and accurate monitoring of sterilization cycle • Vent valve will open and the P-2 alarm will display if the chamber pressure exceeds 240 kPa • Safety valve opens as backup protection should the chamber pressure exceed 262 kPa • Chamber temperature is monitored by a surface sensor with overheat protection should the temperature of the heating elements reach 180°C • In case of electrical power interruption during the sterilization cycle, pressure in the chamber is automatically vented to the atmosphere and display is blank • Optional time / temperature recorder for office documentation • Designed and built to ASME specifications • Six month replacement / three year limited parts warranty
Closed Door Drying Closed door drying is essential, as it prevents the interruption of the full sterilization process. Competitive models allow open-door drying, which exposes wet instruments to potentially harmful airborne contaminants.
3
Cassette Rack Optional cassette rack accommodates up to three large and three small cassettes per load.
Specifications
Delta Q 8
Chamber Size
8 1/4" x 14" (21 x 36 cm)
9 7/8" x 17 1/2" (25.1 x 44.5 cm)
Chamber Capacity
739 cu. in. (12,110 cu. cm) Holds 2 European trays
1340 cu. in. (22,019 cu. cm) Holds 3 large or 9 small Hu-Friedy Cassettes or 3 European trays
Start-Up Time (to 134°C)
10 – 13 minutes warm
12 minutes warm
Sterilization Time
16 minutes warm (unwrapped)
16 minutes warm (unwrapped)
Drying Cycle Time
30 minutes preprogrammed, variable 0 – 99 minutes
30 minutes preprogrammed, variable 0 – 99 minute
Outside Dimensions
17 1/2" wide x 19 3/4" deep x 12 1/4" high (44 cm wide x 50 cm deep x 31 cm high)
19 1/4" wide x 23 5/8" deep x 14" high (49 cm wide x 60 cm deep x 36 cm high
Electrical
110-120 VAC, 50/60 Hz (ETL/cETL) 220-240 VAC, 50/60 Hz (ETL/cETL)
110-120 VAC, 50/60 Hz (ETL/cETL) 220-240 VAC, 50/60 Hz (ETL/cETL)
Amp Circuit
Unit requires dedicated 20 amp circuit
Unit requires dedicated 20 amp circuit
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Enhanced Ergonomics Proper ergonomics is important to the health and well being of all dental office associates. The Delta Q features an ergonomic handle and a user- friendly technology interface.
Delta Q 10
Innovative PC Cable The Delta Q features an innovative PC cable which allows the user and / or technician to download sterilization history to his or her PC, thus eliminating the need for costly printers and paper.
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Balances OHAUS Discovery Semi-Micro and Analytical Balances
Specifications
DV114C
DV214C
DV314C
DV215CD
Capacity
110 g
210 g
310 g
81*/210 g
Readability
0.1 mg
0.1 mg
0.1 mg
0.01*/0.1 mg
Repeatability (Std.dev.)
0.1 mg
0.1 mg
0.2 mg
0.02*/0.1 mg
Linearity
±0.2 mg
±0.2 mg
±0.5 mg
±0.03*/0.2 mg
BALANCES
The Professional’s Choice for Analytical Applications The OHAUS Discovery series of semi-micro and analytical balances combine unmatched weighing performance with OHAUS’ innovative SmarText™ software. The Discovery features durable glass and steel construction and advanced AutoCal™ internal calibration, performance you would expect to find only in premium-priced balances.
Milligram, Gram, Carat, Ounce, Ounce Troy, Grain, Pennyweight, Momme, Hong Kong Tael, Singapore Tael, Taiwan Tael, Custom
Weighing Units * FineRange™
OHAUS Adventurer® Pro Analytical and Precision Balances The OHAUS Adventurer Pro Series has established itself as the industry’s most versatile balance. It counts, it sums, it holds and it delivers traceable results. No other balance in its class offers as many features in a compact design.
Technical Specifications, Precision Balances Models with InCalTM Internal Calibration
Not Available
AV213C
AV313C
Models without InCalTM Internal Calibration
AV53
AV213
AV313
Capacity
51 g
210 g
Readability
0.001 g
Repeatability (Std. dev.)
0.001 g
Linearity
±0.002 g
±0.002 g
±0.002 g
±0.02 g
±0.02 g
±0.02 g
±0.02 g
±0.02 g
±0.2 g
±0.2 g
±0.2 g
Stabilization Time
2.5 sec
3 sec
3 sec
3 sec
3 sec
3 sec
3 sec
3 sec
3 sec
3 sec
3 sec
AV212C
AV412C
AV812C
AV2102C
AV3102C
AV2101C
AV4101C
AV8101C
AV212
AV412
AV812
AV2102
AV3102
AV2101
AV4101
AV8101
310 g
210 g
410 g
810 g
2100 g
3100 g
2100 g
4100 g
8100 g
0.001 g
0.001 g
0.01 g
0.01 g
0.01 g
0.01 g
0.01 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.001 g
0.001 g
0.01 g
0.01 g
0.01 g
0.01 g
0.01 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
OHAUS Scout® Pro Portable Balances Designed for use in laboratory, industrial or education applications, the OHAUS Scout Pro features easy-to-use two-button operation, a high-contrast LCD display, multiple weighing units, four application modes, and the option of either RS232 or USB connectivity, the Scout Pro is the portable balance for your needs!
Specifications
SP202
SP402
SP602
SP401
SP601
SP2001
SP4001
SP6001
SP6000
Capacity
200 g
400 g
600 g
400 g
600 g
2000 g
4000 g
6000 g
6000 g
Readability
0.01 g
0.01 g
0.01 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
1g
Repeatability (Std. Dev.)
0.01 g
0.01 g
0.01 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
1g
Linearity
±0.01 g
±0.01 g
±0.02 g
±0.1 g
±0.1 g
±0.1 g
±0.1 g
±0.2 g
±1 g
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
4
OHAUS FD Stainless Steel Compact Scales
BALANCES
The OHAUS Food Portioning Scale is a rugged, multi-use portioning scale designed for use in food service applications. Ideally suited for food portioning and checkweighing, the FD Food Portioning Scale combines an easily cleaned design, fast display and high precision loadcell. Designed for use in restaurants, bakeries, food manufacturing and other areas requiring fast operation and flexibility, the OHAUS Food Portioning Scale offers durability and cleanliness in one economical design. Specifications
FD3
FD6
FD15
Capacity x Default Readability
3 kg x 0.0005 kg 3,000 g x 0.5 g 6 lb x 0.001 lb 96 oz x 0.02 oz or 1/4 oz 6 lb:0 oz x 0.1 oz or 1/4 oz 3 kg x 0.001 kg
6 kg x 0.001 kg 6,000 g x 1 g 15 lb x 0.002 lb 240 oz x 0.05 oz or 1/4 oz 15 lb:0 oz x 0.1 oz or 1/4 oz 6 kg x 0.002 kg
15 kg x 0.002 kg 15,000 g x 2 g 30 lb x 0.005 lb 480 oz x 0.1 oz or 1/4 oz 30 lb:0 oz x 0.1 oz or 1/4 oz 15 kg x 0.005 kg
Capacity x Readability Certified / Approved
3,000 g x 1 g 6 lb x 0.002 lb 96 oz x 0.05 oz or 1/4 oz
6,000 g x 2 g 15 lb x 0.005 lb 240 oz x 0.1 oz or 1/4 oz
15,000 g x 5 g 30 lb x 0.01 lb 480 oz x 0.2 oz or 1/4 oz
Specifications
FD3H
FD6H
FD15H
Capacity x Readability Maximum Displayed Readability
3 kg x 0.0001 kg 3,000 g x 0.1 g 6 lb x 0.0002 lb 96 oz x 0.005 oz 96 oz x 1/4 oz 6 lb 0 oz x 0.1 oz 6 lb 0 oz x 1/4 oz
6 kg x 0.0002 kg 6,000 g x 0.2 g 15 lb x 0.001 lb 240 oz x 0.01 oz 240 oz x 1/4 oz 15 lb 0 oz x 0.1 oz 15 lb 0 oz x 1/4oz
15 kg x 0.001 kg 15,000 g x 1 g 30 lb x 0.001 lb 480 oz x 0.02 oz 480 oz x 1/4 oz 30 lb 0 oz x 0.1 oz 30 lb 0 oz x 1/4 oz
OHAUS Defender™ 3000 Washdown Bench Scales Basic Level Bench Scales are ideal for general industrial use and feature all stainless steel construction with NEMA 4X/IP65 protected indicator. Application modes include weighing, simple parts counting, and weighs in lb, oz, lb:oz, g or kg units.
Specifications
D32XW30VR
D32XW60VR
D32XW60VL
D32XW150VL
D32XW150VX
D32XW300VX
Capacity x Readability (d)
60 lb x 0.01 lb 960 oz x 0.2 oz 60 lb x 0.2 oz (lb:oz) 30 kg x 0.005 kg 30,000 g x 5 g
150 lb x 0.02 lb 2,400 oz x 0.5 oz 160 lb x 0.5 oz (lb:oz) 60 kg x 0.01 kg 60,000 g x 10 g
150 lb x 0.02 lb 2,400 oz x 0.5 oz 160 lb x 0.5 oz (lb:oz) 60 kg x 0.01 kg 60,000 g x 10 g
300 lb x 0.05 lb 4,800 oz x 1 oz 300 lb x 1 oz (lb:oz) 150 kg x 0.02 kg 150,000 g x 20 g
300 lb x 0.05 lb 4,800 oz x 1 oz 300 lb x 1 oz (lb:oz) 150 kg x 0.02 kg 150,000 g x 20 g
600 lb x 0.1 lb 9,600 oz x 2 oz 600 lb x 2 oz (lb:oz) 300 kg x 0.05 kg 300,000 g x 50 g
OHAUS Moisture Analyzers OHAUS MB Series Moisture Analyzers combine high quality and durable construction into sleek, compact designs. The MB Series offer dependable, accurate, results for a wide variety of applications.
5
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Specifications
MB45
MB35
MB25
Capacity
45 g
35 g
110 g
110 g
Repeatability (Std Dev) (g)
0.05% (3 g sample) 0.015% (10 g sample)
0.18% (3 g sample) 0.02% (10 g sample)
0.2% (3 g sample) 0.05% (10 g sample)
0.3% (3 g sample) 0.2% (10 g sample)
Readability
0.01% / 0.001 g
0.02% / 0.002 g
0.05% / 0.005 g
0.1% / 0.01 g
Fax : (514) 326 8961
MB23
Adam Equipment PW Analytical Balances
Ideal for pharmaceutical & laboratory work
3 Year Warranty!
Adam Equipment PGL Precision Balances
3 Year Warranty!
• Lock down mounting slot for Kensington™ type lock and cable • Dual tare keys • Color coded, sealed keypad • Splashproof to protect from accidental spills • RS-232 bi-directional interface • GLP print outs • Internal calibration • External calibration • AC adapter Applications The PW Analytical Balances are ideal for weighing, net / total, check weighing, percentage weighing, weight accumulation, parts counting, animal / dynamic weighing, density determination and below pan weighing.
Specifications
PW124
PW184
PW254
Capacity
120 g
180 g
250 g
Readability
0.0001 g
0.0001 g
0.0001 g
Pan size
3.5″ Ø / 90 mm Ø
3.5″ Ø / 90 mm Ø
3.5″ Ø / 90 mm Ø
Features • Up to 12 weighing units (including one custom unit) • Date and time • Full range tare • Zero tracking • Multilingual display • Large backlit display with dual text prompts • Capacity tracker • Large stainless steel pan • Solid metal housing • Overload protection • Lock down mounting slot for Kensington™ type lock and cable • Non-slip adjustable levelling feet • Colour coded, sealed keypad • Dual tare keys • Removable draft shield supplied on 0.001 g readabilities
• • • • • • •
Modern low profile design RS-232 bi-directional interface GLP print outs External calibration Rechargeable battery AC Adapter Auto sleep / power down function to save battery life
Applications • Lab sample weighing • Parts counting • Percentage weighing • Check weighing • Density determination • Below balance weighing
Specifications
PGL203
PGL303
PGL2002
PGL3002
PGL4001
PGL6001
PGL8001
PGL10001
PGL12001
PGL15001
PGL20001
Capacity
200 g
300 g
2000 g
3000 g
4000 g
6000 g
8000 g
10 kg
12 kg
15 kg
20 kg
Readability
0.001 g
0.001 g
0.01 g
0.01 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
0.1 g
Platform size
5.7 × 4.9″ 5.7 × 4.9″ 7.6 × 7.6″ 7.6 × 7.6″ 7.6 × 7.6″ 7.6 × 7.6″ 7.6 × 7.6″ 15.7 × 11.8″ 7.6 × 7.6″ 7.6 × 7.6″ 15.7 × 11.8″ 145 × 125 mm 145 × 125 mm 192 × 192 mm 192 × 192 mm 192 × 192 mm 192 × 192 mm 192 × 192 mm 400 × 300 mm 192 × 192 mm 192 × 192 mm 400 × 300 mm
www.ereinc.com
BALANCES
Features • 16+ weighing units (including one custom unit) • Selectable digital filtering for animal / dynamic weighing • Adjustable filters • Simple user-friendly operation • Full range tare • Zero tracking • Date and time • Multilingual display • Large backlit display with dual text prompts • Capacity tracker • Large stainless steel pan • Force restoration mechanism • Solid metal housing • Non-slip adjustable leveling feet
sales@ereinc.com
6
BALANCES
PGL Precision Balances Great for material testing applications and laboratory. Ideal for field applications with a battery!
AD-PGL203 PGL Precision Balance, Capacity: 200 g, Readability: 0.001 g, Pan Size: 5.7" x 4.9" / 145 mm x 125 mm
3 Year Warranty!
AD-PGL2002 PGL Precision Balance, Capacity: 2000 g, Readability: 0.01 g, Pan Size: 7.6" x 7.6" / 192 mm x 192 mm
Features • 9 weighing units • Date and time • Full range tare • Zero tracking • Multilingual display • Large backlit display with dual text prompts • Capacity tracker • Large stainless steel pan • Solid metal housing • Overload protection
• Lock down mounting slot for Kensington™ type lock and cable • Non-slip adjustable leveling feet • Color coded, sealed keypad • Dual tare keys • Windshield supplied as standard with models with 0.001 g readability • Modern low profile design • RS-232 bi-directional interface • GLP print outs • External calibration • Rechargeable battery • AC adapter • Auto sleep / power down function to save battery life
AD-PGL4001 PGL Precision Balance, Capacity: 4000 g, Readability: 0.1 g, Pan Size: 7.6" x 7.6" / 192 mm x 192 mm AD-PGL6001 PGL Precision Balance, Capacity: 6000 g, Readability: 0.1 g, Pan Size: 7.6" x 7.6" / 192 mm x 192 mm AD-PGL8001 PGL Precision Balance, Capacity: 8000 g, Readability: 0.1 g, Pan Size: 7.6" x 7.6" / 192 mm x 192 mm AD-PGL10001 PGL Precision Balance, Capacity: 10 kg, Readability: 0.1 g, Pan Size: 15.7" x 11.8" / 400 mm x 300 mm AD-PGL20001 PGL Precision Balance, Capacity: 20 kg, Readability: 0.1 g, Pan Size: 15.7" x 11.8"/ 400 mm x 300 mm Accessories AD-8023 Adam Printer AD-9061 AdamDU - Data Collection Program AD-9028 RS-232 Cable AD-7995 Below Balance Hanger AD-9066 USB To RS-232 Interface Cable
Applications PGL Precision Balances are ideal for weighing, parts counting, percentage weighing, check weighing, density determination and below pan weigh.
Highland™ Portable Precision Balances Ideal for quick readings in the laboratory, university and field work!
AD-HCB123 Highland™ Portable Precision Balance, Capacity: 120 g, Readability: 0.001 g, Pan Size: 4.7" / 120 mm AD-HCB153 Highland™ Portable Precision Balance, Capacity: 150 g, Readability: 0.005 g, Pan Size: 4.7" / 120 mm
2 Year Warranty! Features • 15 weighing units • Zero tracking • Backlit LCD display • Capacity tracker • ShockProtect™ overload three - point protection • Can be stacked for storage (120 mm pan size only) • Lock down mounting slot for Kensington™ type lock • Removable anti-static draft shield (120 mm pan size only) • Stainless steel pan
• • • • • • • • • • • •
Non-slip adjustable leveling feet Below balance weighing with hanger Easy access to the rechargeable battery Color coded, sealed keypad Dual tare keys RS-232 and USB interface Handical™ manual internal calibration with built-in mass External calibration Auto power off Full range tare Low battery indication AC adapter
Applications Highland™ Portable Precision Balances are ideal for weighing, percentage weighing, parts counting, below pan weighing and weight accumulation.
7
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
AD-HCB302 Highland™ Portable Precision Balance, Capacity: 300 g, Readability: 0.01 g, Pan Size: 4.7" / 120 mm AD-HCB602H Highland™ Portable Precision Balance, Capacity: 600 g, Readability: 0.01 g, Pan Size: 4.7" / 120 mm AD-HCB602 Highland™ Portable Precision Balance, Capacity: 600 g, Readability: 0.02 g, Pan Size: 4.7" / 120 mm AD-HCB1002 Highland™ Portable Precision Balance, Capacity: 1000 g, Readability: 0.01 g, Pan Size: 4.7" / 120 mm AD-HCB1502 Highland™ Portable Precision Balance, Capacity: 1500 g, Readability: 0.05 g, Pan Size: 4.7" / 120 mm AD-HCB3001 Highland™ Portable Precision Balance, Capacity: 3000 g, Readability: 0.1 g, Pan Size: 4.7" / 120 mm Accessories AD-9307 Hard Carry Case W/ Lock AD-8030 Security Lock & Cable AD-8023 Adam Printer AD-9061 AdamDU - Data Collection Program
Fax : (514) 326 8961
LBK Weighing Scales
1 Year Warranty!
Applications LBK Weighing Scales are ideal for weighing, parts counting and percentage weighing. • Auto sleep / power down function to save battery life • Low battery indication • AC adapter
AD-LBK6A LBK Weighing Scale, Capacity: 6 lbs / 3000 g, Readability: 0.001 lbs / 0.5 g, Pan Size: 9.8" x 7.1" / 250 mm x 180 mm AD-LBK12A LBK Weighing Scale, Capacity: 12 lbs / 6000 g, Readability: 0.002 lbs / 1 g, Pan Size: 9.8" x 7.1" / 250 mm x 180 mm AD-LBK25A LBK Weighing Scale, Capacity: 25 lbs / 12 kg, Readability: 0.005 lbs / 2 g, Pan Size: 9.8" x 7.1" / 250 mm x 180 mm AD-LBK65A LBK Weighing Scale, Capacity: 65 lbs / 30 kg, Readability: 0.01 lbs / 5 g, Pan Size: 9.8" x 7.1" / 250 mm x 180 mm
BALANCES
Features • 5 weigh ing units (kg, g, lb, oz, lbs:oz) • Full range tare • Zero tracking • Simple user-friendly operation • Large backlit LCD display • Non-slip adjustable leveling feet • Overload protection • Color coded, sealed keypad • Large stainless steel pan • Modern low profile design • Precision load cell technology • Splashproof to protect from accidental spills • External calibration • Rechargeable battery up to 150 hours operation
Accessory AD-9664 In-Use Cover
CPWplus Bench Scales Ideal for shipping / receiving, materials and sample testing in the field!
1 Year Warranty!
Applications CPWplus Bench Scales are ideal for weighing and animal / dynamic weighing.
Features • 4 weighing units (kg, g, lb, oz) • Simple 4 button operation • Hold function • Full range tare • Zero tracking • Large backlit LCD display • Wall mount bracket • Large stainless steel pan • Modern low profile design • Splashproof to protect from accidental spills • Precision load cell technology • Color coded, sealed keypad • RS-232 bi-directional interface • Low battery indication • Auto sleep / power down function to save battery life • Battery power (6 x "AA" batteries) • AC adapter
AD-CPWPLUS6 CPWplus Bench Scale, Capacity: 13 lbs / 6000 g, Readability: 0.005 lbs / 2 g, Pan Size: 11.8" x 11.8" / 300 mm x 300 mm AD-CPWPLUS15 CPWplus Bench Scale, Capacity: 33 lbs / 15 kg, Readability: 0.01 lbs / 5 g, Pan Size: 11.8" x 11.8" / 300 mm x 300 mm AD-CPWPLUS35 CPWplus Bench Scale, Capacity: 75 lbs / 35 kg, Readability: 0.02 lbs / 10 g, Pan Size: 11.8" x 11.8" / 300 mm x 300 mm AD-CPWPLUS75 CPWplus Bench Scale, Capacity: 165 lbs / 75 kg, Readability: 0.05 lbs / 20 g, Pan Size: 11.8" x 11.8" / 300 mm x 300 mm AD-CPWPLUS150 CPWplus Bench Scale, Capacity: 330 lbs / 150 kg, Readability: 0.1 lbs / 50 g, Pan Size: 11.8" x 11.8" / 300 mm x 300 mm AD-CPWPLUS200 CPWplus Bench Scale, Capacity: 440 lbs / 200 kg, Readability: 0.1 lbs / 50 g, Pan Size: 11.8" x 11.8" / 300 mm x 300 mm Accessory AD-7954 Hard Carry Case W/ Lock
CBCa Bench Counting Scales Features • Internal counting resolution 1:400,000 • Preset tare function • Full range tare • Zero tracking • Memory accumulation • Adjustable filters • Pre-set counting with alarm • Date and time • Large backlit LCD display • Simple user-friendly operation • Precision load cell technology • Splashproof to protect from accidental spills • Full color coded keypad with numeric entry • Large stainless steel pan • Non-slip adjustable feet • Overload protection • Easy access to the rechargeable battery • RS-232 bi-directional interface • External calibration • Rechargeable battery up to 90 hours operation • Auto sleep / power down function to save battery life
www.ereinc.com
• Low battery indication • AC adapter
2 Year Warranty!
Applications CBCa Bench Counting Scales are ideal for weighing, weight accumulation, parts counting check counting and for count accumulation.
AD-CBC8A CBCa Bench Counting Scale, Capacity: 8 lbs / 4000 g, Readability: 0.0002 lbs / 0.1 g, Pan Size: 8.9" x 10.8" / 225 mm x 275 mm AD-CBC16A CBCa Bench Counting Scale, Capacity: 16 lbs / 8000 g, Readability: 0.0005 lbs / 0.2 g, Pan Size: 8.9" x 10.8" / 225 mm x 275 mm AD-CBC35A CBCa Bench Counting Scale, Capacity: 35 lbs / 16 kg, Readability: 0.001 lbs / 0.5 g, Pan Size: 8.9" x 10.8" / 225 mm x 275 mm AD-CBC70A CBCa Bench Counting Scale, Capacity: 70 lbs / 32 kg, Readability: 0.002 lbs / 1 g, Pan Size: 8.9" x 10.8" / 225 mm x 275 mm AD-CBC100A CBCa Bench Counting Scale, Capacity: 100 lbs/48 kg, Readability: 0.005 lbs / 2 g, Pan Size: 8.9" x 10.8" / 225 mm x 275 mm
Accessories AD-5006 In-Use Cover AD-5006-10 In-Use Cover, 10/Pack
sales@ereinc.com
8
CBK Bench Scales
2 Year Warranty!
AD-CBK8A CBK Bench Scale, Capacity: 8 lbs / 4000 g, Readability: 0.0002 lbs / 0.1 g, Pan Size: 8.9" x 10.8" / 225 mm x 275 mm
BALANCES
AD-CBK16AH CBK Bench Scale, Capacity: 16 lbs / 8000 g, Readability: 0.0002 lbs / 0.1 g, Pan Size: 8.9" x 10.8" / 225 mm x 275 mm AD-CBK16A CBK Bench Scale, Capacity: 16 lbs / 8000 g, Readability: 0.0005 lbs / 0.2 g, Pan Size: 8.9" x 10.8" / 225 mm x 275 mm AD-CBK35A CBK Bench Scale, Capacity: 35 lbs / 16 kg, Readability: 0.001 lbs / 0.5 g, Pan Size: 8.9" x 10.8" / 225 mm x 275 mm AD-CBK70A CBK Bench Scale, Capacity: 70 lbs / 32 kg, Readability: 0.002 lbs / 1 g, Pan Size: 8.9" x 10.8" / 225 mm x 275 mm
Features • 5 weighing units (kg, g, lb, oz, lbs:oz) • Adjustable filters • Memory accumulation • Date and time • Full range tare • Pre-set weighing with alarm • Check-weighing with low and high limits • Check weighing LED bar graph • Large backlit LCD display • Capacity tracker • Non-slip adjustable leveling feet • Overload protection • Large stainless steel pan • Color coded, sealed keypad
• • • • • • • • •
Full color coded keypad with numeric entry Simple user-friendly operation Splashproof to protect from accidental spills Precision load cell technology Internal counting resolution 1:400,000 Easy access to the rechargeable battery RS-232 bi-directional interface External calibration Rechargeable battery up to 90 hours operation • Auto sleep / power down function to save battery life • Low battery indication • AC adapter
AD-CBK100A CBK Bench Scale, Capacity: 100 lbs / 48 kg, Readability: 0.005 lbs / 2 g, Pan Size: 8.9" x 10.8" / 225 mm x 275 mm
Accessories AD-8023 Adam Printer AD-6081 Weigh Below Hanger (Factory Fitted) AD-9028 RS-232 Cable AD-9066 USB To RS-232 Interface Cable AD-9061 AdamDU - Data Collection Program
CPWplus P Bench Scales
Ideal for Shipping / Receiving, Materials & Sample Testing in the Field! Features • 4 weighing units (kg, g, lb, oz) • Large backlit LCD display • Simple 4 button operation • Hold function • Full range tare • Zero tracking • Wall mount bracket • Large stainless steel platform • Modern low profile design • Splashproof to protect from accidental spills • Precision load cell technology • Color coded, sealed keypad • Pillar display standard on P versions • RS-232 bi-directional interface • External calibration • Low battery indication • Battery power (6 x AA batteries) • Auto sleep / power down function to save battery life • AC adapter
9
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
1 Year Warranty! AD-CPWPLUS6P CPWplus P Bench Scale, Capacity: 13 lbs / 6000 g, Readability: 0.005 lbs / 2 g, Pan Size: 11.8" x 11.8" / 300 mm x 300 mm AD-CPWPLUS15P CPWplus P Bench Scale, Capacity: 33 lbs / 15 kg, Readability: 0.01 lbs / 5 g, Pan Size: 11.8" x 11.8" / 300 mm x 300 mm AD-CPWPLUS35P CPWplus P Bench Scale, Capacity: 75 lbs / 35 kg, Readability: 0.02 lbs / 10 g, Pan Size: 11.8" x 11.8" / 300 mm x 300 mm AD-CPWPLUS75P CPWplus P Bench Scale, Capacity: 165 lbs / 75 kg, Readability: 0.05 lbs / 20 g, Pan Size: 11.8" x 11.8" / 300 mm x 300 mm AD-CPWPLUS150P CPWplus P Bench Scale, Capacity: 330 lbs / 150 kg, Readability: 0.1 lbs / 50 g, Pan Size: 11.8" x 11.8" / 300 mm x 300 mm AD-CPWPLUS200P CPWplus P Bench Scale, Capacity: 440 lbs / 200 kg, Readability: 0.1 lbs / 50 g, Pan Size: 11.8" x 11.8" / 300 mm x 300 mm
Fax : (514) 326 8961
CPWplus W Weighing Scales
Ideal for Shipping / Receiving, Materials & Sample Testing in the Field! Applications CPWplus W Weighing Scales are ideal for weighing and animal / dynamic weighing.
1 Year Warranty! AD-CPWPLUS35W CPWplus W Weighing Scale, Capacity: 75 lbs / 35 kg, Readability: 0.02 lbs / 10 g, Pan Size: 19.7" x 19.7" / 500 mm x 500 mm AD-CPWPLUS75W CPWplus W Weighing Scale, Capacity: 165 lbs / 75 kg, Readability: 0.05 lbs / 20 g, Pan Size: 19.7" x 19.7" / 500 mm x 500 mm AD-CPWPLUS150W CPWplus W Weighing Scale, Capacity: 330 lbs / 150 kg, Readability: 0.1 lbs / 50 g, Pan Size: 19.7" x 19.7" / 500 mm x 500 mm AD-CPWPLUS200W CPWplus W Weighing Scale, Capacity: 440 lbs / 200 kg, Readability: 0.1 lbs / 50 g, Pan Size: 19.7" x 19.7" / 500 mm x 500 mm
Ideal for Water Treatment & Testing
PMB Moisture Analyzers Features • Built-in memories for storing products and settings • 3 settings for heating samples • Automatic test start setting for when the lid is closed • Date and time • Full range tare • Zero tracking • Quick and easy to configure through the keypad • Multilingual display • Large backlit display with dual text prompts • Capacity tracker • Non-slip adjustable leveling feet • Color coded, sealed keypad • Large stainless steel pan • Lock down mounting slot for Kensington™ type lock and cable • Overload protection • Precision load cell technology • Splashproof to protect from accidental spills • Spirit level • Single halogen lamp 400 W • RS-232 and USB interface • GLP print outs • Calibration facilities for temperature and weight • Power Cord • Pan lifter to easily remove samples
www.ereinc.com
BALANCES
Features • 4 weighing units (kg, g, lb, oz) • Hold function • Full range tare • Zero tracking • Simple 4 button operation • External calibration • Large backlit LCD display • Large stainless steel platform • Handlebar frame and wheeled base for mobility • Splashproof to protect from accidental spills • Non-slip adjustable leveling feet • Four load cell construction • Color coded keys • Modern low profile design • RS-232 bi-directional interface • Rechargeable battery • Auto sleep / power down function to save battery life • Low battery indication • AC adapter
Application PMB Moisture Analyzers are ideal for moisture determination.
3 Year Warranty!
Accessories AD-9028 RS-232 Cable AD-PMB53 PMB Moisture Analyzer, Capacity: 50 g, Readability: 0.001 g / 0.01%, Pan Size: 3.5" / 90 mm AD-PMB202 PMB Moisture Analyzer, Capacity: 200 g, Readability: 0.01 g / 0.01%, Pan Size: 3.5" / 90 mm
AD-9304 USB Cable AD-8023 Adam Printer AD-7996 Disposable Aluminum Sample Pans, 250/Pack
sales@ereinc.com
10
Digital Moisture Balance
BALANCES
The Digital Moisture Balance is specifically designed to be used in a production environment by non-technical personnel. Can be successfully used in the laboratory and in the production area where test results are needed on the spot. With its RS-232 interface capability, the custom printer will print a hard copy of the test data with a time and date stamp, confirmation of the test parameters used, and a message of "operator interrupt" should a test be stopped prematurely. All accomplished automatically; load a sample, press a button and walk away. Rapid, no hassle results in just minutes. Features • Flexibility Simplifies sample preparation and loading, no limitations on sample size (0-100 g), measures moisture or solids from 0.0% to 100.0% • Versatile Allows fine tuning to individual testing needs with multiple testing modes, wide selection of heat settings and readout in either solids or moisture • Accuracy Increases precision and is adaptable to critical moisture and solids testing. Readable to 0.1% moisture and solids • Durability Withstands the hard knocks of day-to-day use with rugged cast aluminum construction and enclosed sample chamber Applications The Digital Moisture Balance is ideal for use of snack foods, dairy products, cereals, grains and baked goods, sand, cement, ceramics, gypsum, fiberboard, adhesives, pharmaceuticals, chemicals, sludge and slurries.
CS-26900EMB Digital Moisture Balance (110 V)
Cenco Mechanical Moisture Balance The Cenco Mechanical Moisture Balance has become world renowned for fast and accurate readings of the percent moisture content in a variety of substances. The wide selection of heat ranges allows optimum drying of diverse materials without sample damage. The Mechanical Moisture Balance eliminates error while providing direct readings of moisture content. There is no calculation or special training needed to use this dependable equipment. The Mechanical Moisture Balance is the best cost performance moisture measurement method for most materials. Its portability makes it convenient to be used in the lab, on the production line or even in the field. The Mechanical Moisture Balance rapidly determines the percentage moisture of materials ranging from food products to chemicals, plastics, and ceramics!
Features • Direct % Reading No calculation needed No special training needed • Efficient Simultaneous weighing & drying - saves time • Flexibility Wide selection of heat ranges allows optimum drying of diverse materials without sample damage • Versatility Allows fine tuning to individual testing needs. Multiple testing modes and temperature settings • Accuracy Increases precision and is adaptable to critical moisture and solids testing. Readable to 0.1% moisture and solids
CS-26900EMB Digital Moisture Balance (110 V)
ERE
Where your Opinion Matters!
11
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Baths SHEL LAB Water Baths
Lab Armor Bead Baths are durable, dependable and are available with a variety of safety and convenience features: • Microprocessor control • Overtemperature protection • Stainless body and lid • 1 year warranty
The SHEL LAB high-performance water baths are accurate, easy to use, safe and durable. The water bath design incorporates the attractive SHEL LAB appearance, a drip free cover holster, and pocket handles so users can easily transport the water bath. A microprocessor achieves precise temperature control regardless of how the unit is loaded. Calibration is performed with the convenient, front panel touch pad. • Easy-to-clean stainless steel tank • Pocket handles for easy lifting • Recessed heating element prevents "burnout". Unique SHEL LAB design eliminates "hot spots"
SHEL LAB digital Water baths are durable and dependable. Five different models are available, each with a variety of safety and convenience features.
Specifications
W2M
W6M
W14M
W20M
Electrical Specifications
110-120V (220-230V for W2M-2)
110-120V (220-230V for W6M-2)
110-120V (220-230V for W14M-2)
110-120V (220-230V for W20M-2)
Exterior Dimensions
15"W x 12"D x 6"H 38W x 29D x 14H cm
15"W x 12"D x 9"H 38W x 29D x 22H cm
14.3"W x 18.8"D x 8.3"H 36.2W x 47.7D x 21H cm
15"W x 25"D x 9"H 38.1W x 63.5D x 22.9H cm
Bath Tank Dimensions
12"W x 6"D x 3"H 29W x 15D x 6H cm
12"W x 6"D x 6"H 29W x 15D x 15H cm
11.7"W x 13"D x 6"H 29.8W x 33D x 15.2H cm
11.5"W x 19.5"D x 6.2"H 29.2W x 49.5D x 15.8H cm
Model
Capacity
Dimensions
M706
6 L bath + 5 L beads
15.9"W x 12.3"D x 8.5"H 40.5W x 31.2D x 21.6H cm
Tank Capacity
2L
6L
14 L
20 L
M714
14 L bath + 12 L beads
15.9"W x 18.5"D x 8.5"H 40.5W x 47D x 21.6H cm
Temperature Range
Ambient +5 to 80°C
Ambient +5 to 80°C
Ambient +5 to 80°C
Ambient +5 to 80°C
M720
20 L bath + 15 L beads
15.9"W x 23.255"D x 8.5"H 40.5W x 59D x 21.6H cm
Temperature Uniformity
±0.2°C at 37°C
±0.2°C at 37°C
±0.2°C at 37°C
±0.2°C at 37°C
Over Temperature Protection
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Stainless Steel Gabel Cover(s)
Yes - One Included
Yes - One Included
Yes - One Included
Yes - One Included
All models: Temperature Range: Ambient +5 ºC to 80 ºC Thermal Uniformity: ±1.0 ºC
BATHS & CIRCULATORS
Lab Armor Bead Baths
SHEL LAB Reciprocating Water Baths The Reciprocating Water Baths deliver precise temperature control and a smooth, reciprocal shaking motion. The independent over temperature safety offers backup protection should the main controller fail. Easy-to-read
LEDs display temperature and oscillation speed. An independent oscillator control allows the bath to also be used for regular constant temperature water bath applications. The stroke length can be easily adjusted to three separate Specifications
WS17
WS27
Electrical Specifications
110-120V (220-230V for WS17-2)
110-120V (220-230V for WS27-2)
Exterior Dimensions
14"W x 25"D x 13"H 36W x 63D x 32H cm
14"W x 40"D x 13"H 36W x 102D x 32H cm
12"W x 15"D x 8"H 31W x 37D x 19H cm
12"W x 27"D x 8"H 31W x 69D x 19H cm
Bath Chamber Dimensions
www.ereinc.com
settings. This allows for various agitation speeds, ranging from mild to vigorous. The unique basket support system helps eliminate tank wear while fully supporting free action of a heavily loaded basket.
Tank Capacity
16 L
27 L
Temperature Range
Ambient +5 to 90°C
Ambient +5 to 90°C
Temperature Uniformity
±0.2°C at 37°C
±0.2° at 37°C
Over Temperature Protection
Yes
Yes
Stainless Steel Gabel Cover(s)
Yes - One Included
Yes - One Included
sales@ereinc.com
Number of flasks each model can accommodate 25 mL
24
48
50 mL
24
48
125 mL
24
48
250 mL
12
24
500 mL
6
12
1 liter
4
8
2 liter
2
4
2.8 liter
1
3
4 liter
1
2
5 liter
1
2
6 liter
1
2
12
BATHS & CIRCULATORS
PolyScience Water Baths The latest generation of PolyScience Water Baths offer superior temperature control, range, and uniformity. Bath fluids can be controlled at temperatures as high as 100ºC (60ºC without cover) with 0.1ºC precision and ±0.2ºC uniformity. Bath temperature is displayed continuously on a bright, easyto-read LED panel in your choice of ºC or ºF. Set point temperature is recalled with just the touch of a button. Three user-defined temperature preset buttons allow for quick selection of often used temperature set points. Dual thermostats provide optimum protection for your work and water bath. The high limit alarm alerts you if bath temperature exceeds your pre-set limit. A secondary Safety Set thermostat guards against thermal runaway, automatically disconnecting heater power should bath temperature get too high or the liquid level drop too low.
Capacity
Overall Dimensions LxWxH
Opening Dimensions LxWxH
Shipping Weight
Volts, Hz. Amps
Cat. No.
2 Liter
8.94" x 7.90" x 8.13" 22.71 x 20.07 x 20.65 cm
5.31" x 5.88" x 5.81" 13.49 x 14.94 x 14.76 cm
11 lbs 4.99 kg
120 V, 60 Hz, 2.5 A 240 V, 50 Hz,1.25 A
WD02A11B WD02A12E
2 Liter Shallow
9.44" x 13.65" x 8.13" 23.98 x 34.67 x 20.65 cm
5.81" x 11.69" x 2.50" 14.76 x 29.69 x 6.35 cm
12 lbs 5.44 kg
120 V, 60 Hz, 2.5 A 240 V, 50 Hz, 1.25 A
WD2SA11B WD2SA12E
5 Liter
9.44" x 13.65" x 8.13" 23.98 x 34.67 x 20.65 cm
5.94" x 11.75" x 5.94" 15.09 x 29.85 x 15.09 cm
15 lbs 6.80 kg
120 V, 60 Hz, 4.2 A 240 V, 50 Hz, 2.1 A
WD05A11B WD05A12E
10 Liter
15.43" x 14.90" x 8.13" 39.19 x 37.85 x 20.65 cm
11.69" x 12.75" x 5.94" 29.69 x 32.39 x 15.09 cm
23 lbs 10.43 kg
120 V, 60 Hz, 4.2 A 240 V, 50 Hz, 2.1 A
WD10A11B WD10A12E
20 Liter
15.19" x 21.65" x 8.13" 38.58 x 54.99 x 20.65 cm
11.50" x 19.50" x 5.88" 29.21 x 49.53 x 14.94 cm
30 lbs 13.61 kg
120 V, 60 Hz, 8.3 A 240 V, 50 Hz, 4.15 A
WD20A11B WD20A12E
28 Liter
15.19" x 21.65" x 10.13" 38.58 x 54.99 x 25.73 cm
11.63" x 19.56" x 7.94" 29.54 x 49.68 x 20.17 cm
33 lbs 14.97 kg
120 V, 60 Hz, 8.3 A 240 V, 50 Hz, 4.15 A
WD28A11B WD28A12E
PolyScience Water Baths are also designed for operating convenience. The steeply gabled, polycarbonate cover accommodates glassware of varying heights and tilts out of your way when loading or removing samples, allowing condensate to drain neatly back into the bath.
Labnet Digital Dry Baths
Single and dual block models. Two Digital Dry Bath models are available. The single block unit will accept all of the standard blocks. For increased capacity, the dual block unit accepts two standard blocks or one specially designed dual block. Each Dry Bath is supplied with a block lifter. Blocks sold separately.
A broad temperature range, to 150ºC, makes Digital Dry Baths useful for a variety of applications in molecular biology, histology, clinical, environmental and industrial laboratories. Although the price of these baths is comparable to analog models, they feature microprocessor control and digital setting / display of temperature. Digital performance at analog prices. Microprocessor control. A microprocessor regulates the high wattage heaters in the baths to provide precise, accurate control. The exact desired temperature is easily set using the arrow keys on the sloped control panel while values are shown on the large digital display. No checking of a thermometer and readjusting temperature
13
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
is necessary. The user calibration feature allows for easy calibration to in house standards when required. Additionally, there is an RS232 port for recording block temperature activity. An available data-logging software package is used to link the unit to a computer. Stainless steel block chamber. The block chamber of the Digital Dry Baths is constructed of stainless steel, which acts as a heat sink and provides a uniform transfer of heat from the heating elements to the interchangeable blocks. The resulting block uniformity is excellent, ensuring that all samples receive the same temperature treatment, regardless of their position in the block.
Specifications
Digital Dry Baths
Temperature Range
Ambient + 5º to 150ºC
Temp. Resolution
0.1ºC
Temp. Uniformity
±0.2ºC
Temp. Accuracy
±0.3ºC
Block Chamber
Stainless Steel
Block Capacity: Single Block Unit
One standard block
Dual Block Unit
Two standard blocks or one dual block
Dimensions
7.9"W x 10.4"D x 3.3"H (20W x 26.5D x 8.3H cm)
Weight
5.5 lbs (2.2 kg)
Electrical
120 V~, 50/60 Hz (also available in 230 V)
Dry Bath Blocks Construction
High grade, nonporous aluminum with anodized surface
Thermometer Well
Yes (not in plate or slide blocks), required only for calibration purposes
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Immersion Circulators Specifications
7306
712
Temperature Range
Ambient +5º to 150ºC*
Ambient +5º to 100ºC* ±0.2ºC
Controller
Standard Digital
Basic
Readout
LED
Thermometer
Temperature Readout ºC or ºF
120V, 50/60Hz, 11A (7306A11B) (73A0A11B) 2400V, 50/60Hz, 7.5A (7306A12E) (73A0A12E)
Pumping Flow
5 or 12 liters / min. 6 1/2" x 4 3/4" 16.5 x 12.1 cm
Tank Occupancy, Approx.
Min. 3" / 7.6 cm Max. 7" / 17.8 cm
Immersion
12 1/4"L x 4 5/8"W x 5 3/4"H 31.2L x 11.7W x 14.6H cm
Overall Dimensions
PolyScience Standard Digital Model 7306 The PID microprocessor controller provides precise temperature control and greater temperature stability. The 2-speed pressure (simplex) pump minimizes turbulence in small tanks and provides higher flow and greater uniformity in large tanks. An adjustable flow director accepts 1/2" (13 mm) ID tubing for external circulation.
PolyScience Basic Model 712 This low-cost circulator offers good temperature control for routine lab applications. Proportional heater control combined with redundant safety backup makes this analog model an excellent value. The 2-speed pressure (simplex) pump minimizes turbulence in small tanks and it also provides higher flow and greater uniformity in large tanks. Temperature readout is via the supplied thermometer (alcohol)
PolyScience Progammable Model 7312 The full-featured PolyScience Programmable Controller, combined with circulator placement flexibility, makes this "design your own bath" circulator a great value. Microprocessor PID control assures high accuracy and stability.
The Programmable Controller features a multilanguage graphic display and time / temperature programming. Ten programs can be stored in the controller's memory; each can have up to fifty steps and can be cycled up to 99 times. An RS232 interface and remote probe capability are standard. The included software supports LabView™ drivers and Excel® macros to offer even greater programming and data logging convenience. For internal circulation or external open and closed loop applications, the 7312 has a strong pressure and suction (duplex) pump with variable speed control. The optional remote probe gives more accurate temperature control in applications where external circulation is required. The expandable mounting bridge spans openings from 15" to 25" across to allow placement on almost any bath container. Choose from PolyScience's selection of stainless steel or acrylic baths, or use your own reservoir.
www.ereinc.com
N/A
Electrical Requirements
Heater
BATHS & CIRCULATORS
Temperature Stability ±0.05ºC
60 Hz / 1100 watts, 50 Hz / 2200 W Adjustable
Over-Temperature Cutoff Low-liquid Cutoff
Yes
Shipping Weight
11 lbs / 5 kg
Pump Inlet & Outlet
1/4" FRP Rear Discharge
* Temperature range and stability vary depending on bath volume, surface area, insulation and type of fluid. Notes: Performance specifications determined at ambient temperature of 20ºC / 68ºF
Specifications
7312
Temperature Range
Ambient +5º to 200ºC*
Temperature Stability*
± 0.01ºC
Controller/RS232
Programmable/yes
Readout
Graphics LCD
Temperature Readout
ºC or ºF
Pressure Flow
30 LPM max. (60 Hz) 22 LPM max. (50 Hz)
Suction Flow
22 LPM max. (60 Hz) 15 LPM max. (50 Hz)
Tank Occupancy, Approx.
7 1/2" x 8 3/4"
Immersion
Min. 2 1/2" / 7 cm Max. 4 1/2" / 11.4 cm
Overall Dimensions
11 1/4"L x 15"W x 9 1/2"H 28.6L x 38W x 24.2H cm
Heater
60 Hz / 1 100 Watts, 50 Hz / 2200 Watts
Over-Temperature Cutoff
Adjustable
Low-Liquid Cutoff
Yes
Pump Inlet & Outlet
1/4". FPT Rear Discharge
Shipping Weight
24 lbs / 11 kg
Electrical Requirements
120V, 60Hz, 11A (7312A11B) 240V, 50/60Hz, 9.7A (7312A12E)
* Temperature range and stability vary depending on bath volume, surface area, insulation and type of fluid. Notes: Performance specifications determined at ambient temperature of 20ºC / 68ºF
sales@ereinc.com
14
BATHS & CIRCULATORS
Cooling & Heating Circulator Baths
Model 9112
Model 912
PolyScience Basic Model 912
Model 9102
demanding requirements. Frequently used for cooling electrophoresis cells, viscometers and general lab applications.
Ideal for routine applications where extreme accuracy and stability are not critical. An excellent alternative to tap water cooling for rotary evaporators and condensers at a low price. Convenient set-point dial with supplied thermometer (alcohol) readout.
PolyScience Standard Digital Model 9106 With the same cooling capacity as more expensive models, this model combines high performance with economy. It is equipped with three user-defined temperature preset buttons for rapid set point changes. The bright LED display provides read and set capability, and its stability of ±0.05°C meets all but the most
PolyScience Advanced Digital Model 9102 The digital controller has all the advanced performance as the programmable model and is your ideal choice when remote probe, time / temperature programming and communication software are not required. The LCD display also incorporates multi-language help menus that aid in setting up operation while using the Select / Set knob.
Model 9106
PolyScience Programmable Model 9112 This top-of-the-line model features a wide temperature range and time / temperature programmability. Programs can be set directly from the front panel with the aid of the Select / Set knob and multi-language display, or from a PC using the RS-232 interface. LabView™ drivers and Excel® macros offer even greater programming and data logging convenience. Remote probe capability and variable-speed pressure / suction (duplex) pump further enhance the 9112's capabilities. Heating
Specifications
9112
9102
9106
912
Temperature Range
-20º to 200ºC
-20º to 200ºC
-20º to 150ºC
-20º to 100ºC
Temperature Stability
±0.01ºC
±0.01ºC
±0.05ºC
±0.2ºC
Controller / RS232
Programmable / Yes
Advanced Digital / Yes
Standard Digital / No
Basic / No
Readout
Graphic LCD
Graphic LCD
LED
Thermometer (supplied)
Temperature Readout
ºC or ºF
ºC or ºF
ºC or ºF
N/A
Readout Accuracy
±0.25ºC
±0.25ºC
±0.5ºC
N/A
Pressure Flow Rate
Variable-Speed 30 LPM max. (60 Hz) 22 LPM max. (50 Hz)
Variable-Speed 30 LPM max. (60 Hz) 22 LPM max. (50 Hz)
2-speed 5 or 12 liters/min
2-speed 5 or 12 liters/min
Suction Flow Rate
22 LPM max. (60 Hz) 15 LPM max. (50 Hz)
22 LPM max. (60 Hz) 15 LPM max. (50 Hz)
N/A
N/A
Heater (60Hz/50Hz)
1100 / 2200 Watts
1100 / 2200 Watts
1100 / 1600 Watts
1100 / 1600 Watts
Shipping Weight
70 lbs / 32 kg
70 lbs / 32 kg
64 lbs / 29 kg
64 lbs / 29 kg
Cat. No. 120V/60Hz/12A
9112A11B
9102A11B
9106A11B
91A0A11B
Cat. No. 240V/50Hz/7A
9112A12E
9102A12E
9106A12E
91A0A12E
Specifications
9100 Series
Reservoir Capacity
6 liters
Cooling Capacity @ +20ºC 0ºC -10ºC
200 Watts 140 Watts 100 Watts
Over-Temperature Cutoff
Adjustable
Low-Liquid Cutoff
Yes
Working Access
5 1/4"L x 5 1/4"W x 5 1/2"H 13.3L x 13.3W x 14H cm
Overall Dimensions
15 3/4"L x 8 1/4"W x 22 1/2"H 40L x 21W x 57.1H
Pump Inlet & Outlet
1/4" FPT Rear Discharge
Notes: Cooling capacity, Watts x 3.41 = BTU's/hr. Performance specifications determined at ambient temperature of 20ºC/68ºF. For 50Hz units, derate cooling capacity and pump flow by 17%
15
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Cooling
A built-in RS-232 interface is standard. The variable-speed pressure / suction pump can be used in both open and closed loop applications. Great performance for those on a budget.
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Centrifuges Labnet Spectrafuge™ Mini Centrifuges and Slide Spinner
Specifications
Spectrafuge™ Mini
Slide Spinner
Maximum Speed / RCF
6,000 rpm / 2,000 x g1
4,800 rpm
Maximum Capacity
2 x 0.2 mL strips or 6 x 1.5 / 2.0 mL
2 standard slides
Dimensions
5.9"W x 5.9"D x 4.6"H (15W x 15D x 11.7H cm)
5.9"W x 5.9"D x 4.6"H (15W x 15D x 11.7H cm)
Weight
1 lb (0.45 kg)
1 lb (0.45 kg)
Electrical
230 V-, 50 Hz or 120 V-, 60 Hz
230 V-, 50 Hz or 120 V-, 60 Hz
The Spectrafuge™ Mini is supplied with rotors and adapters to accommodate 1.5 mL, 0.5 mL and 0.4 mL tubes, as well as 0.2 mL strips and individual tubes. The rotors are easily interchanged. The Slide Spinner dries two slides in as little as 10 seconds for quality imaging and screening results. The slides are placed into cassettes that catch all liquid without splashing. Cassettes are reuseable. Both centrifuges feature a translucent lid that pivots on a durable stainless steel hinge pin. A switch on the side of the centrifuge starts and stops operation. Alternatively, with the switch in the "on" position, the centrifuge can be started and stopped by closing and opening the lid. The Spectrafuge™ Mini is available in five different lid colors: gray, blue, teal, purple and red.
CENTRIFUGES
Compact in design and personal sized, the Spectrafuge™ Mini is ideal for microfiltration and quick spin downs from the walls and caps of microcentrifuge tubes. The Slide Spinner is designed for drying microarray slides before scanning.
Labnet Spectrafuge™ 6C The Spectrafuge™ 6C has been designed for quick production of PPP (platelet poor plasma) and PRP (platelet rich plasma) as well as other applications in the clinical or research laboratory. The included 6 place rotor is capable of running round or conical bottom 15 mL or 10 mL tubes. Adapters for smaller tube sizes are available separately. The control panel of the centrifuge features easy turn knobs and large digital displays for time and speed. Time can be set as low as 30 seconds and to the "On" position for a continuous run. The Spectrafuge™ 6C is the smallest centrifuge in its class. The 8" x 9" footprint makes it ideal for almost any laboratory and it can easily be transported from lab to lab.
Specifications
Spectrafuge™ 6C
Maximum Speed
6,500 rpm
Maximum RCF
4,000 x g
Maximum Capacity
6 x 15 mL
Timer
30 seconds to 30 minutes with continuous and hold features
Accel. / Decel.
14 / 27 seconds
Dimensions
8.25"W x 9.5"D x 7"H (21W x 24D x 18H cm)
Rotor Angle
30°
Electrical
120 V or 230 V, 50-60 Hz
Labnet Spectrafuge™ 24D The Spectrafuge™ 24D combines innovations such as a unique, easy access rotor, exclusive multi-flow air cooling system and high performance drive with a digital microprocessor that precisely regulates operation. Parameters are selected with two "smart" knobs and values are shown on large, easy to read, LED displays. Speed can be set and displayed in rpm or g-force, while runs may be timed, continuous or momentary. The unique design of the 24-place rotor allows easy access to the tops of the tubes. An optional StripSpin™ adapter fits onto the rotor for spinning 0.2 mL tubes and strips. A powerful, brushless motor quickly accelerates the rotor to set speed. Air enters the centrifuge through vents on the back of the housing and is circulated in multiple directions to maximize cooling. The result is a cool running microcentrifuge that keeps samples close to ambient temperature, even during extended runs at maximum speed. For samples that require below ambient temperatures, the Spectrafuge™ 24D may be used in a cold room.
www.ereinc.com
Specifications
Spectrafuge™ 24D
Speed Range
500 rpm to 13,300 rpm
Maximum RCF
16,300 x g
Maximum Capacity
24 x 1.5 / 2.0 mL
Timer
1 to 30 minutes or continuous "Quick" button for momentary operation
Ambient Operating Range
4° to 35°C
Dimensions
9.25"W x 11.5"D x 8.5"H (23.5W x 29.3D x 21.6H cm)
Weight
18 lbs (8.1 kg)
Electrical
230 V-, 50 Hz or 120 V-, 60 Hz
sales@ereinc.com
16
CENTRIFUGES
Globe Scientific Centrifuge Tubes
1.5 mL Graduated Polypropylene (PP) Microcentrifuge Tube with Attached Snap Cap Features • Maximum rpm: 26,000 • Autoclavable at 130°C • Suitable for Spectrafuge™ 24D
1.5 mL Non-Sterile, SelfStanding Polypropylene (PP) Microtube Note: Order caps separately. Features • Suitable for Spectrafuge™ 24D
0.5 mL Polypropylene (PP) Microcentrifuge Tube with Attached Click-Seal Snap Cap
17
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
15 mL Clinical Grade Polypropylene (PP) Centrifuge Tube
50 mL Clinical Grade Polypropylene (PP) Centrifuge Tube
Features • Blue screwcap • Black printed graduations • White printed writing space • Spin rate: 8,500 rpm • Autoclavable (without cap) • Temperature range: -40°C to +80°C • Cap: High Density Polyethylene (HDPE)
Features • Blue Screwcap • Black printed graduations • White printed writing space • Spin rate: 8,500 rpm • Autoclavable (without cap) • Temperature range: -40°C to +80°C • Cap: High Density Polyethylene (HDPE)
50 mL Polypropylene (PP) Centrifuge Tube with Red Screwcap (HDPE) & Printed Graduations Features • Autoclavable (without screwcap) • Tubes are Rnase / Dnase free, nonpyrogenic and non-cytotoxic • Spin rate: 10,000 rpm (12,320 x g) • White graduation marks and writing area • Temperature range: Tube: -196°C to +121°C Cap: -50°C to +100°C
15 mL Centrifuge Tube Acrylic (AC) with Red Screwcap (HDPE) & Printed Graduations Acrylic is a stronger, scratch resistant material that offers equivalent chemical resistance to polystyrene, while providing exceptional clarity. Acrylic offers a greater spin rate which is 5,000 rpm (6,160 x g) compared to polystyrene, which has a limited spin rate of 1,700 rpm (3,000 x g). Features • Spin rate: 5,000 rpm (6,160 x g) • Tubes are Rnase / Dnase free, nonpyrogenic and non-cytotoxic • White graduation marks and writing area • Temperature range: Tube: -40°C to +70°C Cap: -50°C to +100°C
1.5 mL Graduated Polypropylene (PP) Microcentrifuge Tube Without Cap, Natural
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Centurion Scientific – Centrifuges, Cytology Centrifuges & Cell Washer Standard features • Stainless steel bowl • Alloy and steel main frame with composite panels • World brand leading industrial grade inverter • High quality European brushless motor
Advantages • Clean & rust free • Strong, light & quiet • Reliable & accurate • Cool
CENTRIFUGES
C2 Series Centrifuges Models • C2012 Hematocrit & Microtube Centrifuge • C2015 Micro High Speed Centrifuge • C2004 400 mL Versatile Centrifuge • C2006 Fixed Angle up to 6000 rpm • C204 1-Litre Centrifuge • C2043 3-Litre work horse • CR2000 Multi-purpose & Versatile Rotor Recognized Centrifuge Features • Light emitting diode screen • Electric blue LED display • 10 acceleration rates • 10 deceleration rates • 10 program memory • Timer 0 - 99 minutes + constant • Pulse (short run) to 90 seconds • Run in speed or RCF (G Force) in 10 rpm steps • Sound level below 60 dBs (rotor dependant)
Accessories for Centurion Centrifuges, C2 Series: Rotors available for C2012
BR5401 Micro tube 24 x capillary tubes Max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13500G
BR5424 Micro tube 24 x 1.5 - 2.2 mL tubes Max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13500G
BR5436 Micro tube 36 x 0.5 mL tubes Max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13500G
BR5494 PCR Rotor 4 x 8 strips Max speed: 12,000 rpm Max RCF: 13,500G
BR5448 Micro tube 48 x 0.2 mL tubes Max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13500G
Rotors available for C2004 BR5431 24 x 15 mL Max speed: 4000 rpm Max RCF: 2,200G
www.ereinc.com
BR5505 4 x 100 mL Max speed: 4000 rpm Max RCF: 2,200G
BR5434 8 x 50 mL max speed: 4000 rpm Max RCF: 2,200G
sales@ereinc.com
18
CENTRIFUGES
Rotors available for C2006
Rotors available for C2015
BR5412 12 x 15 mL Max Speed: 6000 rpm Max RCF: 3,800G
BR5424 Micro tube 24 x 1.5 - 2.2 mL Max Speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22000G
BR5436 Micro tube 36 x 0.5 mL tubes Max speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22000G
BR5406 Max speed: 6000 rpm 3,800G 6 x 50 mL tube Fixed angle rotor Tube size maximum 115H x 30W mm
BR5494 PCR Rotor 4 x 8 strips Max speed: 12,000 rpm Max RCF: 13,500G
BR5448 Micro tube 48 x 0.2 mL tubes Max Speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22000G
BR5434 8 x 50 mL Max Speed: 4000 rpm Max RCF: 2,200G
BR5510 Swing out rotor Requires B5250 buckets 4 x 250 mL Max speed: 4000 rpm Max RCF: 2,600G
Rotors available for C2041 BR5431 24 x 15 mL tubes Max Speed: 4000 rpm Max RCF: 2,200G
Rotors available for C2043 BR5553 Rotor 4 x 750 mL Max Speed: 4000 rpm Max RCF: 3,600G
B3000 Buckets for above set of 4 Max speed: 4000 rpm 3,600G Sealed lids available B5319
Rotors available for CR2000 BRK5505 4 x 100 mL Max Speed: 4000 rpm Max RCF: 2,200G
BRK5434 8 x 50 mL Max speed: 4000 rpm Max RCF: 2,200G
BRK5401 24 x capillary tubes Also 12 x 2 mL Max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13,500G
BRK5436 36 x 0.5 mL tube Max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13,500G
BRK5412 12 x 15 mL tubes Max speed: 6000 rpm Max RCF: 3,800G
BRK5431 24 x 15 mL tubes Max speed: 4000 rpm Max RCF: 2,200G
BBRK5424 24 x 1.5-2.2 mL tubes Max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13,500G
BRK5448 48 x 0.2 mL tubes Max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13,500G
BRK5494 4 x PCE strips Max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13,500G
BRK5406 6 x 50 mL tubes Fixed angle rotor Tube size maximum 115H x 30W mm
19
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
K3 Series Centrifuges
CENTRIFUGES
Models • K2015 Micro Ambient • K2015R Micro Refrigerated • K241 1-Liter Ambient • K241R 1-Liter Refrigerated • K243 3-Liter Ambient • K243R 3-Liter Refrigerated • K2045 Multi-Rotor 400 mL12,000 rpm
Features • LCD display • Touch screen control • 10 acceleration rates • 10 deceleration rates • 108 program memory • Timer 0 - 999 minutes and hold • Pulse (short run) to 90 seconds • Run in speed or RCF (G Force) in 1 rpm steps • Rotor recognition • W²t plus for true repeatability • Temperature controllable, accurate to ±0.5℃ • Sound level below 60 dBs (rotor dependant)
Accessories for Centurion Centrifuges, K3 Series: Rotors available for K2015 & K2015R
BRK5424 24 x 1.5 - 2.2 mL tubes Max speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22,000G
BRK5436 36 x 0.5 mL tubes Max speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22,000G
BRK5448 48 x 0.2 mL Max speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22,000G
BRK5308 8 x 50 mL Max speed: 6000 rpm Max RCF: 4,800G
BRK5324 24 x 15 mL Max speed: 6000 rpm Max RCF: 4,800G
BRK5494 4 x PCR strips Max speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22,000G
BRK5436 36 x 0.5 mL Max speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22,000G
BRK5510 4 x 250 mL Max speed: 4000 rpm Max: RCF 2,600G
BRK5308 8 x 50 mL Max speed: 6000 rpm Max RCF: 4,800G
BRK5494 4 x PCR strips Max speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22,000G
BRK5401 Haematocrit rotor Max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13,500G
BRK5448 48 x 0.2 mL Max speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22,000G
Rotors available for K241 & K241R BRK5424 24 x 1.5 - 2.2 mL Max speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22,000G
BRK5324 24 x 15 mL Max speed: 6000 rpm Max RCF: 4,800G
BRK5530 Microtitor plate buckets Max speed: 4000 rpm Max RCF: 2,500G
BRK5100 6 x 100 mL Max speed: 6000 rpm Max RCF: 4,500G
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
20
Rotors available for K243 & K243R
CENTRIFUGES
BRK5308 8 x 50 mL Max speed: 6000 rpm Max RCF: 4,800G
BRK5424 24 x 1.5 - 2.2 mL Max speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22,000G
BRK5494 4 x PCR strips Max speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22,000G
BRK5436 36 x 0.5 mL Max speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22,000G
B5200 Microtitor plate carrier (4/pk) max speed: 4000 rpm 3,600G Requires BR5553 rotor
BRK5448 48 x 0.2 mL Max speed: 15000 rpm Max RCF: 22,000G
BRK5553 Requires B3000 buckets shown 4 x 750 mL Max speed: 4000 rpm Max RCF: 3,600G
BRK5424 24 x 1.5 - 2.2 mL max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13,500G
BRK5448 48 x 0.2 mL Max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13,500G
BRK5324 24 x 15 mL Max speed: 6000 rpm Max RCF: 4,800G
BRK5436 36 x 0.5 mL max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13,500G
BRK5494 4 x PCR strips Max speed: 12000 rpm Max RCF: 13,500G
BRK5308 8 x 50 mL Max speed: 6000 rpm Max RCF: 4,800G
BRK5100 6 x 100 mL Max speed: 6000 rpm Max RCF: 4,500G
BRK5250 4 x 250 mL Max speed: 10000 rpm Max RCF: 16,100G
BRK5324 24 x 15 mL Max speed: 6000 rpm Max RCF: 4,800G
Rotors available for K2045
BRK5505 4 x 100 mL Max speed: 4000 rpm Max RCF: 2,200G
Let our Customer Service help you find the
right products for you! Toll free:
1-888-287-3732 21
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Centurion Cytology Centrifuges CYT12 with touch screen LCD display Complete with 12 place rotor and starter pack
Features • LCD touch screen display • 10 acceleration rates • 10 deceleration rates • 108 program memory • Run is speed or RCF (G force) • W²t plus for true repeatability
CYT04 with bright blue LED display Complete with 4 place rotor and starter pack Specifications Speed: 500 - 3000 rpm Max RCF: 575G Timer: 0 - 99 Minutes Size: 27H x 33W x 46D cm Weight: 16.5 kg without rotor
Safety features for both CYT12 and CYT04 • Multi-point lid locking system containment • Imbalance vibration detector with auto reset • Lid lock detector • Over-speed sensor • Set inverter values • Barrier ring • Motor overheat sensor
CENTRIFUGES
Specifications Speed: 500 - 2000 rpm Max RCF: 525G Timer: 0 - 99 minutes + hold Size: 27H x 33W x 46D cm Weight: 16.5 kg without rotor
Advantages • Best safety for lid • Easy "eye" volume loading • Unable to run with an open lid • Safe detection of speed • Electronic safety of speed • Metal protection of chamber • Motor & samples protection
Features • LED display 10 acceleration rates • 10 deceleration rates • 10 program memory • Run is speed or RCF (G force)
Accessories available for CYT12 & CYT04 Cytology Centrifuges: 4460 12 place rotor for CYT12. High quality polypropylene & stainless steel, autoclavable
4444 Single sample disposable holder complete with white filter card (up to 1 mL samples)
4462 Our stainless steel clips hold the sample chambers (both single & double)
Shandon Clip
www.ereinc.com
4446 Double sample disposable holder complete with white filter card (up to 1 mL samples)
Showing 6 mL Holder 6 mL disposable chamber intended for single use, eliminating the need for metal clips
sales@ereinc.com
22
Centurion Cell Washing Centrifuge Model CW12
CENTRIFUGES
Complete with 12 place rotor and accessories. The centurion cell washing system can simplify work and save time in the washing of blood cells for anti-globulin reagent tests. The instrument’s 12 place rotor accepts both 10 x 75 mm and 12 x 75 mm tubes. Being a manual cell washing system means our users can be precise and sure of exact saline amounts administered by themselves. These machines are perfect for performing blood grouping, blood typing, cross matching, ABO compatibility, RH testing and the Coombs test procedure.
Accessories available for CW12 Cell Washer Centrifuge: Please note our cell washing machine is supplied complete with rotor and 2 x 12 holders. Adaptors for CW12 Our adaptors enable the rotor to handle both 10 x 75 mm and 12 x 75 mm tubes. The included rotor carries 12 tubes but can operate with any balanced load of fewer tubes and any combination of sizes as long as these are properly balanced. This offers complete flexibility for the user.
Rotor for CW12 2 sets supplied, 12 of each size. High quality polypropylene. Auto-clavable. The rotor in this device can be detached and efficiently functions as a holder in which test tubes can be filled, centrifuged transported, incubated and emptied without the necessity for individual handling.
InfoZone Equation for Calculating RCF RCF = 0.000001118 x r x N RCF = relative centrifugal force r = radius from the rotor centre to the bottom of the tube (mm) N = rotating speed (rpm)
Centrifuge tubes also available!
23
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Cryoscopes & Osmometers Advanced® 4250 Single-Sample Cryoscope Superior Accuracy And Reliability In Two Minutes
Other models available.
Specifications
Model 4250
Sample Volume
2 or 2.5 mL
Test Time
Approximately 90 seconds in the 30-second timed mode
Sample Capacity
Single Sample
Units
-m°C or -m°H
Resolution
1 m°C or m°H
Range
0 to 1000 m°C or m°H
Communications
On-board printer, DTE RS-232 serial port, and optional barcode scanner
CRYOSCOPES
Ease Of Use Microprocessor control optimizes onboard data management capability and promotes seamless instrument operation.
Advanced® Model 3320 Micro-Osmometer The Advanced® Model 3320 Micro-Osmometer is a single-sample osmometer designed to provide fast, accurate test results using a 20 μL sample. It combines proven freezing point technology with an elegant design that is both simple to operate and easy to maintain. It is ideally suited for routine osmolality testing in clinical diagnostic, pharmaceutical, and industrial laboratory settings.
Specifications
Model 3320
Sample Volume
20 μL
Test time
60 seconds
Sample Capacity
Single sample
Units
mOsm/kg H2O
Resolution
1 mOsm/kg H2O
Range
0 to 2000 mOsm/kg H2O
Linearity
Less than ±1% from a straight line over calibrated range
Fiske Associates Osmometer Model 210 The Fiske Associates Model 210 Micro Osmometer determines the osmolality of solutions using freezing point depression (FPD). Ideal for serum, urine or other bodily fluids in clinical applications; and media or formulations in pharmaceutical, biotech or industrial applications. Automated, single sample, designed to process a 20 mL sample, and 90-second test time. The Model 210 provides the best accuracy and precision in the market today.
• 20 µL sample size is ideal for applications where the sample quantity is limited • Unparalleled ease of use • Solid state cooling • Internal diagnostics • Ergonomic, compact design • On-board statistical analysis • Results recall up to the last 30 tests • Multi-language operation • Automated calibration • Hot-Line® technical service available 24/7
Also available • Calibration standards • Reference solutions • Control solutions • Sample tubes and probe wipes 250/box • Bar code scanner • 20 microliter pipette • Thermal printer
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
24
Fume Hoods & Cabinets FUME HOODS & CABINETS
Envirco Biological Safety Cabinets A NSF Listed, Class II, Type A2 Biological Safety Cabinet provides product, personnel and environmental protection. The Envirco® Biological Safety Cabinet is listed under NSF/ANSI Standard 49, which verifies cabinet integrity and performance. It is suitable for Biosafety Levels 1, 2 and 3 per CDC/NIH and NCR criteria. Preparation of chemotherapeutic drugs may also be performed in the Envirco Biohazard Cabinet per OSHA requirements. In addition, the cabinet provides an engineering control per the OSHA Bloodborne Pathogen Standard. US Standard ANSI/NSF 49:2002. Airflow System • 70% air recirculation • 30% air exhausts The unit maintains a minimum average inflow velocity of 0.65 m/s and average downflow velocity of 0.37 m/s.
Performance Features • HEPA Filter (Standard for Manual Window Series) 99.999% efficient (0.3 microns) HEPA filter is constructed of borosilicate glass fibers. • Filter Life Indicator: The pressure is displayed on the control panel to show the life of the main filter and exhaust filter. • A microprocessor control system with LED display makes it clear for all control and safety functions. • True airflow velocity (both down-flow and inflow) sensing technology, with temperature compensation for improved sensor accuracy. The velocity value shows continuous digital display on the front LED control panel for constant monitoring. • UV timer function to control the decontamination cycle and maximize lamp life. • Easy to decontaminate and disinfect. The working chamber of the safety cabinet is easy to be cleaned and disinfected. The stainless steel counter surface can be removed for autoclaving. • Weight-balanced front window.
TriviaZone
Ergonomic Features • 10° sloped front enhanced mobility and depth of reach into the work area, also provides maximum protection. • Control panel is sloped downwards to provide the operator (in a setting position) a better view of and an easier access to the controls. • Inclined, sliding sash.
Safety Features • Cabinet Leak Test: Cabinets have to pass pressure decay test as defined in the US Stand ANSI/NSF 49:2002. • KI-Discus Containment Test: Cabinets are tested using the KI-Discus method for containment and operator safety at the manufacturing site. • Filter Leak Test: Cabinets are tested using an aerosol photometer according to US Standard ANSI/NSF 49:2002. This test determines the integrity of down-flow and exhaust filters, filter housings and filter mounting frames. • Automatic self-filtering cycle at start-up requires a fixed period of warm-up period during which the cabinet work zone is purged of contaminants before use. • Intrinsically-safe negative pressure design. • The motor / blower system is able to compensate automatically to maintain the down-flow air at the speed of 0.37±0.015 without interruption to guarantee the safe performance. • Interlocked UV light only operates when blower and fluorescent light are off and sash is closed. • Front window glass (standard) or nonreflecting multi-layer safety glass (optional), which provides enhanced UV protection for operators. • Audible and visual alarms prompt the operator in case of any unsafe condition.
Contact us for complete technical specifications and pricing
Q1: In 1962, the first noble gas compound was produced. Which noble gas was used? Q2: What is the only letter that doesn’t appear on the periodic table?
For answers, turn to page 92.
25
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Air Science EDU® Series Ductless Demonstration Fume Hoods • Low airflow alarm warns of unsafe conditions • Compliant with ANSI, OSHA, AFNOR and BSI safety standards • Portable unit with transparent front, back and side walls for maximum visibility. The EDU™ Series offers personnel and environmental protection, optimal energy savings and zero toxic emissions to the room. • EDU-MOBILE (Model EDU-M), shown at right
FUME HOODS & CABINETS
The EDU™ Series Ductless Demonstration Fume Hoods are designed for individual and group applications where clear front, side and rear walls permit 360° visibility. The high efficiency carbon filtration and air management system protects both the user and the classroom environment from hazardous vapors generated on and above the work surface. The EDU™ Series units are mounted on heavy duty transfer carts and are sized to fit through standard doorways for easy transportation from lab to lab. • Offers 360° visibility for full participation • Protects the class from toxic fumes • Available in four models to meet general applications • Filters are easy to change • Improved filter clamping prevents bypass leakage
The Purair® Basic ductless fume hoods are a series of high efficiency products designed to protect the user and the environment from hazardous vapors generated on the work surface. At the heart of the Purair® fume hood product line is the innovative Air Science® Multiplex™ Filtration Technology that creates a safe work environment over the widest range of applications in the industry.
Ductless Technology: The Eco-friendly Choice Advanced carbon filtration technology offers a safe, high performance alternative to conventional ducted fume hoods for a broad range of applications. • Environmental benefits. Air Science® ductless fume hoods isolate and trap chemical vapors to prevent ecological impact through release into the environment. • Versatile. Each filtration system is selected for its specific application. The Multiplex Filter broadens the range of applications. Carbon filters are available in more than 14 configurations for use with vapors or organic solvents, acids, mercury and formaldehyde. HEPA/ULPA filters can add to biological safety. • Easy to install. The ductless fume hood is self-contained and does not require venting to the outside. Many units are portable and may be moved from one location to the next with minimal downtime and without filter changes. Set-up, operation and filter maintenance are straightforward. • Energy efficient. Because filtered air is returned to the room, no demands are required of the facility HVAC capacity for make-up air. • Cost effective. Facility ductwork, HVAC and construction costs are eliminated. • Safe to use. Cabinet airflow and face velocity protect users from incidental exposures to fumes. • Self-testing (selected models). Electronic air-flow monitoring assures continuous safety. An electronic gas sensor monitors carbon filter performance.
Purair® PCR Laminar Flow Cabinet • Excellent interior protection from particulate contamination • Multiple options for customized applications • Easy-to-change HEPA filtration • Vertical laminar airflow • Powerful built-in UV lamp • Vertical laminar air flow • Choose from 2', 3' or 4' models.
sample preparation, and sample amplification. The Purair® PCR laminar flow cabinet employs the Air Science® Multiplex™ HEPA Filtration Technology to create a safe, energy-efficient contaminant-free environment. It is ideally suited for use with non-hazardous contaminants and when flexible access to the instrumentation in the cabinet is required.
Polymerase Chain Reaction* (PCR) is a simple and inexpensive technique to make multiple copies of a targeted nucleotide sequence from a DNA sample, and to amplify sequences from small samples. This technique is widely used in genetics laboratories that work with DNA and RNA. Because PCR amplification is extremely sensitive to contamination, prevention of contamination requires good laboratory practices to minimize external or cross contamination during reagent preparation,
Many more types and models of laboratory work enclosures available. Please contact us for information regarding: Ductless fume hoods, down-flow workstations, classroom demonstration hoods, forensic evidence drying cabinets, fuming chambers, laminar flow cabinets, PCR workstations, swab dryers, chemical storage cabinets, custom products, total exhaust fume hood, vented enclosure, UV-box, and evidence benches
www.ereinc.com
* Polymerase chain reaction (PCR) is a patented process owned by Hoffman La Roche
sales@ereinc.com
26
Incubators INCUBATORSS
SHEL LAB General Purpose Incubators Five strategically placed heating elements, including one in the heated outer door, deliver superior temperature uniformity in SHEL LAB general purpose laboratory incubators. The unique SHEL LAB air jacket design eliminates hot spots. Our microprocessor controller achieves exceptional temperatures control with no overshoot. Setpoint and actual chamber temperature are digitally displayed. Temperature calibration is easily performed with the touch pad control. An independent, secondary controller provides the added safety and security of over temperature protection.
Precise temperature control Superior uniformity • • • • • • • •
Microprocessor control Interior glass door with radius corner Unique warm air jacket design Heated outer door Interior electrical outlet Access port Seam welded panels & doors 24 month warranty
General Purpose Laboratory Incubators, Bench Top, Under Counter & Stackable Available in 110-120V or 220-230V GI12
Specifications
GI2
GI6
GI7
GI11
Details
Bench Top
Floor Model
Under Counter
Double Doors
Exterior Dimensions (W x D x H)
21.25" x 22.25" x 26"
25.25" x 27.25" x 28"
30" x 31" x 32.125" 42" x 27" x 37"
25.25" x 28.25" x 75.8"
Chamber Dimensions (W x D x H)
15" x 15" x 15.25"
19.5" x 20" x 26"
23.7" x 24" x 20"
36" x 20" x 27"
19.5" x 20" x 26"
Incubator Chamber cu ft Capacity
1.9
5.8
6.6
11.3
5.8 (per chamber)
Dual / Stacked
For a complete list of product specifications, contact ERE 1-888-287-3732
SHEL LAB R128 and R140 Models RI28 and RI40 incubators provide 31 & 40 cu.ft. chamber capacities while minimizing the amount of floor space used. Both models incorporate our microprocessor controller to achieve precise temperature uniformity. An independent, secondary temperature controller offers the added security of over temperature protection. The chamber floors are reinforced to support roller apparatus or shakers. Both models are supplied with six shelves capable of supporting the weight of benchtop instruments.
27
Specifications
RI28
RI40
Details
Large Capacity
Large Capacity
Electrical Specifications
110-120V (220-230V for RI28-2)
110-120V (220-230V for RI40-2)
Exterior Dimensions
38.5"W x 33"D x 75"H 98W x 83D x 191H cm
41"W x 34"D x 87"H 104W x 86D x 221H cm
Chamber Dimensions
33"W x 26"D x 64"H 84W x 66D x 163H cm
35"W x 26"D x 76"H 89W x 66D x 193H cm
Chamber Capacity
31 cu ft 899.8 L
40 cu ft 1133.3 L
Temperature Range
Ambient +8 to 70ºC
Ambient +8 to 70ºC
Temperature Uniformity
±0.8°C at 37°C
±0.8°C at 37°C
Over Temperature Protection
Yes
Yes
Temperature Alarm
Yes
Yes
Interior Outlet
4
4
Access Port
1
1
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Optimized Floor Space • Reach-in and extra large • Horizontal air flow • Four (4) interior electrical outlets • Prewired panel for chart recorder • Tempered glass viewing window
Fax : (514) 326 8961
SHEL LAB Water Jacket CO2 Incubator 3517- Floor Model HEPA Filter with a "Bacteriostatic" copper cage to trap particulate matter and reduce potential for chamber contamination.
Infrared (IR) CO2 Sensors For the fastest CO2 recovery and most stable performance, this series features IR sensors.
3517
(IR) CO2 Sensor
110-120V (220-230V for 3517-2)
Exterior Dimensions
26"W x 26.5"D x 39"H 66W x 67D x 99H cm
Chamber Dimensions
20.5"W x 20"D x 25.5"H 52W x 51D x 65H cm
Incubator Chamber Capacity
6 cu ft 171 L
CO2 Range
0 - 20%
CO2 Sensor Accuracy ±0.1% at 5%
SHEL LAB High Heat Decontamination CO2 Incubator The model 3552 is the newest addition to the SHEL LAB 3500 series CO2 incubator line. Featuring a dry heat decontamination cycle, the model 3552 has the ability to maintain 180ºC for 120 minutes. This time / temperature relationship satisfies all global standards for decontamination. Another important and unique feature is that it is not necessary to remove the IR CO2 sensor prior to activating the decontamination process. This is a more user friendly approach and eliminates potential damage to the sensitive IR sensor. This is decontamination at its easiest and most effective. Other features include a USB interface for software communication and a pre-heated copper CO2 gas inlet. This exclusive feature prevents condensation and reduces potential sites for contamination to form. Precise temperature control is achieved via an advanced microprocessor. An independent over temperature safety controller is also integral to the design.
www.ereinc.com
CO2 Recovery Rate
< 5 minutes to 5%
Relative Humidity
Up to 95% at 37ºC
Temperature Range
+8ºC to 60ºC
Temperature Uniformity
±0.35ºC at 37ºC
Over Temperature Protection
Yes
Temperature Alarm
Yes
CO2 Alarm
Yes
Number of Shelves
3 included
Specifications
3552
Details
High Heat Decontamination
(IR) CO2 Sensor
110-120V (220-230V for 3552-2)
Exterior Dimensions
28.3"W x 31"D x 39.3"H 71.8W x 78.8D x 99.7H cm
Chamber Dimensions
20.5"W x 19.7"D x 25.2"H 52W x 50.1D x 64.1H cm
Incubator Chamber Capacity
5.9 cu ft 167.5 L
CO2 Range
0 - 20%
INCUBATORS
Specifications
CO2 Sensor Accuracy ±0.1% at 5% C02 Recovery Rate
< 5 minutes to 95% to 5% of setpoint
Relative Humidity
Up to 95% at 37ºC
Temperature Range
+8ºC to 60ºC
Temperature Uniformity
±0.35ºC at 37ºC
Over Temperature Protection
Yes
Temperature Alarm
Yes
CO2 Alarm
Yes
Number of Shelves
3 included
sales@ereinc.com
28
Labnet Mini Incubator
INCUBATORSS
The Mini Incubator is compact and economically priced, yet offers features not typically found in a basic incubator. The housing is all metal, as is the door frame. A plexi-glass window in the door offers full visibility to the interior. One shelf is included, and can be adjusted to three different levels - additional shelves can be purchased to increase storage capacity. The heating elements in the Mini Incubator are incorporated into the bottom and sides of the housing. This provides better temperature stability and uniformity than other incubators in its class. A grommet hole in the top of the unit can hold a thermometer for accurate temperature setting. In addition, the Mini Incubator has a port in the rear of the chamber which allows for an electrical cord to be routed out the back. The Mini LabRoller is a perfect fit and can be used in the Incubator with any of the available rotisseries. A combo package is available which includes the Mini Incubator and Labroller, along with the accessory rotisseries.
Specifications
Mini Incubator
Ext. Dimensions
11.2"L x 11"W x 13.2"H 28.5L x 28W x 33.5H cm
Int. Dimensions
9" x 7.9" x 7.9" (23 x 20 x 20 cm)
Weight
18.4 lbs (8.3 kg)
Capacity
0.375 cu ft (9.2 L)
Temperature Range Ambient
+5° to 60°C
Controls
Analog
Stability
±0.6°C at 37°C (N.I.S.T. traceable thermometer)
Uniformity
0.65°C at 37°C
Electrical
120 V, 50/60 Hz, 0.6 A; 230 V, 50/60 Hz, 0.3 A
Labnet 211DS Shaking Incubator A small footprint, compact, stackable design and expanded temperature range make the 211DS Incubators ideal for molecular biology and general use. Its integral orbital shaker makes it highly versatile. The exclusive SmartChek temperature control system guarantees precise temperature control. Mechanical convection maintains a stable temperature environment and provides quick recovery after opening the door. A safety thermostat is located on the back of the unit. The insulated door has a large, double glass observation panel and opens nearly 180° for easy access.
Specifications
211DS Shaking Incubator
Chamber Volume
1.7 cu ft
Temp. Range / Display
Ambient + 5° to 80°C in 0.1° increments / digital
Two full and one half shelf are supplied with each incubator. A flat platform and predrilled flask platform (clamps sold separately) are available for the 211DS. Internal electrical outlet allows using small equipment such as GyroMini or Mini LabRoller Rotator inside the chamber of the 211DS.
Temp. Uniformity / Accuracy ±0.25°C / ±0.1°C
29
Shaker Speed / Orbit
Variable, 20 to 400 rpm / 19 mm
Flask Capacity
4 x 1 L, 5 x 500 mL, 9 x 250 mL, 16 x 125 mL
Construction
Interior - mirrored stainless, Exterior - cold rolled steel
Chamber
13.5"W x 14.75"D x 15"H (34.3W x 37.5D x 38.1H cm)
Exterior
16.75"W x 21.75"D x 23"H (42.5W x 55D x 58H cm)
Weight
83 lbs (37.7 kg)
Electrical
120 V~, 60 Hz
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
SHEL LAB Bench Model SI4 Compact and Durable The SI4 has a transparent hood that lifts up via a hydraulic system, so it can function in tight places.
Each unit has an easy-to-read LED display. The rotation platform is included with each unit and is self-centering for easy installation. The SI4 features a small footprint and slim hood design to maximize space and functionality.
INCUBATORS
All of our shaking incubators feature stainless steel interiors which provide excellent durability and an easy-to-clean surface.
• Small footprint accommodates tight bench space • Transparent hood for clear visibility • Robust, temperature resistant hydraulic piston opens the hood with ease and reliability • 0.75" stroke length
SHEL LAB Large Capacity Shaking Incubator The SHEL LAB SI9 delivers all the features you appreciate in the SHEL LAB Shaking Incubator line, with even greater load capacity. The unit performs from 30-400 RPM’s with a smooth, quiet oscillation. The door of the SI9 is designed with hydraulic pistons making it easy to lift during loading and unloading. These state of the art orbital shaking incubators feature a universal shaker platform, which accommodates a wide range of flask clamps, test tube racks and micro titer plate clamps. To support the loads over many years of use, four load-bearing positions are incorporated for optimal weight distribution. For maximum load flexibility, the unique counter-balanced weighting system is adjustable to accommodate off-center loads and varying capacities. • • • • • •
Stackable for additional capacity without losing lab floor space Interior light for improved visibility Unit comes with shaking platform Easy to lift hydraulic doors Safety features and alarms throughout Exclusive SHEL LAB horizontal air flow design for superior uniformity Specifications
SI9
SI9R
Details
Standard
Refrigerated
Electrical Specifications
110-120V (220-230V for SI9-2)
110-120V (220-230V for SI9R-2)
Exterior Dimensions
55.0"W x 33.5"D x 33.5"H 139.7W x 85.1D x 85.1H cm
55.0"W x 333.5"D x 33.5"H 139.7W x 85.1D x 85.1H cm
Chamber Dimensions
35.5"W x 25.5"D x 19.7"H 90.1W x 64.7D x 50.1H cm
35.5"W x 25.5"D x 19.7"H 90.1W x 64.7D x 50.1H cm
10.3 cu ft 293 L
10.3 cu ft 293 L
Incubator Chamber Capacity Platform Dimensions
32" x 22" x 3" 81 x 56 x 7 cm
32" x 22" x 3" 81 x 56 x 7 cm
Temperature Range
8°C + ambient to 60°C*
10°C - 60°C
Temperature Uniformity
±0.5°C at 37°C
±0.5°C at 37°C
Platform Weight Capacity
45 lbs (20 kg)
45 lbs (20 kg)
Orbital-Shaking Range
30 - 400 RPM
30 - 400 RPM
Timer Functionality
1 - 999 mins
1 - 999 mins
Over Temperature Protections
Yes
Yes
Temperature Alarm
Yes
Yes
Orbital-Shaking Speed Alarm
Yes
Yes
www.ereinc.com
Specifications
SI4
Electrical Specifications
110-120V (220-230V for S14-2)
Exterior Dimensions
22.0"L x 25.5"W x 28.0"H 55.9L x 64.8W x 71.2H cm
Chamber Dimensions
19.0"L x 18.0"W x 16.5"H 48.2L x 45.7W x 41.9H cm
Incubator Chamber Capacity
3.3 cu ft 92 L
Temperature Range
8°C + Ambient to 60°C
Temperature Uniformity
±0.5°C at 37°C
Orbital-Shaking Range
30 - 400 RPM
Timer Functionality
1 - 999 mins
Shaking Incubator Flask Clamp & Test Tube Rack Capacity Part Number Description
Size
SI4
SI9
9530528
Flask Clamp
25 mL
50
107
9530529
Flask Clamp
50 mL
50
107
9530530
Flask Clamp
125 mL
25
53
9530531
Flask Clamp
250 mL
25
35
9530526
Flask Clamp
500 mL
10
23
9530532
Flask Clamp
1000 mL
6
19
9530551
Flask Clamp
2000 mL
4
12
9530554
Flask Clamp
4 liter
4
10
9530555
Flask Clamp
6 liter
2
6
9530553
Flask Style
2.8 liter
2
6
9751177 (100 Max)
Test Tube Shaking Rack
10 - 13 mm
3
7
9751178 (80 Max)
Test Tube Shaking Rack
14 - 16 mm
3
7
9751179 (60 Max)
Test Tube Shaking Rack
18 - 20 mm
3
7
9751180 (36 Max)
Test Tube Shaking Rack
22 - 25 mm
3
7
9751181 (29 Max)
Test Tube Shaking Rack
50 mm
3
7
sales@ereinc.com
30
SHEL LAB Refrigerated Incubators Refrigerated incubators are ideal for testing B.O.D of sewage and wastewater, as well as other low temperature and room temperature applications.
INCUBATORSS
• • • • •
Microprocessor control Fan assisted / forced-air circulation LED display of setpoint and chamber temperature High and low limit thermostats Interior electrical outlet
Units are equipped with a hermetically sealed compressor, a circuit breaker to protect from electrical overload, and an easy-to-clean, fully insulated chamber. Gentle, continuous forced-air circulation ensures temperature uniformity and reproducible test conditions.
Specifications
LI5
LI15 Diurnal Plant Chamber
Details
Under Counter
Diurnal Chamber
Electrical Specifications
10 - 120 V, 60 Hz
10 - 120 V, 60 Hz
Exterior Dimensions
24"W x 21.25"D x 34"H 61W x 54D x 86.4H cm
24.5"W x 24.5"D x 77.5"H 62.2W x 62.2D x 196.9H cm
Chamber Dimensions
16"W x 11.5"D x 22.5"H 40.6W x 29.2D x 57.2H cm
27"W x 20"D x 55.5"H 68.6W x 50.8D x 141H cm
Incubator Chamber Capacity
2.4 cu ft 67.8 L
16.5 cu ft 467.2 L
Temperature Range
-10ºC to 45ºC (at 20ºC ambient)
-10ºC to 45ºC (at 20ºC ambient)
Temperature Uniformity
±0.5°C at 20°C
±0.5°C at 20°C
Over Temperature Protection
Yes
Yes
Temperature Alarm
No
No
Interior Outlet
110V-1 / 220V-2
110V-1 / 220V-2
Number of Shelves
2
4
Bottle Capacity
62
317
SHEL LAB LI20P BOD Incubator
SHEL LAB brings energy efficiency to the low temperature incubator market! Model LI20P B.O.D. Thermoelectric Cooled Incubator, 20 Cu.Ft. (300 Bottle) Capacity. Using innovative thermoelectric cooling technology, the LI20P eliminates the need for a refrigeration compressor. This means that these units use 78% less power than alternative models and reduce room air conditioning loads by 75%. They also include 75 pound capacity shelves, which eliminates sagging. These incubators meet APHA specifications for Biochemical Oxygen Demand (BOD) and include a mechanical convection system to ensure even air distribution, digital temperature set controller, safety high / low limit controls, and a digital display. • Microprocessor control system • P.I.D. temperature control • LED display of set point and chamber temperature
31
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Specificiations
LI20P BOD
Capacity
20 cu.ft.
Interior Dimensions
26"W x 24"D x 59"H 66 x 61 x 150 cm
Exterior Dimensions
30"W x 31"D x 70"H 77 x 79 x 178 cm
Temperature Range
15°C to 40°C (at 20°C ambient)
Temperature Uniformity
±0.5°C at 20°C
Electrical Specifications
120 V, 50 / 60 Hz, 1300 W
Capacity of Standard B.O.D. Bottles
300
Temperature Control
0.1°C Display Increments
Shelving
5 Supplied, Adjustable
Interior Outlet
110V-1
• • • •
High and low limit thermostats Interior electrical outlet Fan assisted / forced-air circulation TUV certified
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Elite Compound Microscopes Motic BA210E Objectives N.A.
W.D (mm)
EC Plan 4x
0.10
15.90
EC Plan 10x
0.25
17.40
EC Plan 20x
0.45
0.90
EC Plan 40x
0.65
0.50
EC Plan 60x
0.80
0.35
EC Plan 100x-Oil
1.25
0.15
New EC Optics Motic’s new generation of EC Plan Achromat objectives sets a new price-performance standard in optical quality. With excellent spherical aberration correction to significantly improve field flatness and resolution, the EC optics offer superior
Convenient rackless stage! Specifications
BA210 ELITE
Optical System
Color Corrected Infinity Optical System [CCIS®]
Observation Tube
Widefield binocular 30° [F.N.20] Widefield trinocular 30° [F.N.20] - light distribution 100:0/20:80
Interpupillary Distance
55 - 75 mm (48 - 75 mm optional)
Nosepiece
Reversed quadruple
Objectives
CCIS® EC Plan 4X, 10X, 20X (optional), 40X, 60X (optional) and 100X-Oil
Rackless Stage
150 x 150 mm surface, 80 x 30 mm movement, coaxial controls
Condenser
N.A. 1.25 Abbe condenser with slider slot
Focusing Block
Brass gears. Z-Axis movement with 25 mm stroke; Fine focus with 2 μm minimum increments, coarse focus with torque adjustment.
Illumination
Built-in transmitted 6 V / 30 W Halogen Fixed Koehler illumination or
colour fidelity through new multi-layer coated lenses. A lead-free manufacturing process according to RoHS standard sets new features for these CCIS® objectives, derived from the flagship model BA410. Significantly increased working distances of the objectives reduce contamination risk when changing from oil lenses to dry lenses. To protect the system from fungus growth in high-humidity environments, an anti-fungus treatment is applied to prolong the life of both microscope and objectives.
MICROSCOPES
Description
Rackless Stage The new rackless stage enables a convenient movement of the x/y stage without prominent gear rack interference; while a new specimen holder design gives a soft but solid grip to the glass slides. These new mechanical improvements greatly enhance user safety in educational environments of schools and Universities. Halogen / LED Interchangeability The importance of LEDs as safe and long-term illumination devices has increasingly become the norm in educational and clinical microscopy environments. Nevertheless, experienced users may still prefer the "warm" Halogen illumination with a large portion of long wavelengths. To cover this situation, Motic has implemented a full interchangeability between its Halogen and LED light sources. Coming with a standard 6V/30W Halogen bulb, the BA210Elite lamp socket also accepts a new LED module, which can be inserted instead of the Halogen bulb. The choice of (2) different color temperatures (4500 K, 6000 K) enhances illumination options in a user-friendly way. LED module
Halogen bulb
3 W LED Fixed Koehler illumination (6000 K & 4500 K)
Motic BA310E Specifications
BA310 ELITE
Optical System
Color Corrected Infinity Optical System [CCIS®]
Observation Tube
Widefield binocular 30° [F.N.20] Widefield trinocular 30° [F.N.20] - light distribution 100:0/20:80 Widefield trinocular 30° [F.N.20] - light distribution 100:0/0:100
Interpupillary Distance
48 - 75 mm
Nosepiece
Reversed quadruple
Objectives
CCIS® EC Plan 4X, 10X, 20X (optional), 40X, 60X (optional) and 100X-Oil
Rackless Stage
180 x 170 mm surface, 80 x 55 mm movement, coaxial controls
Condenser
N.A. 0.9 / 1.25 Abbe condenser with slider slot
Focusing Block
Brass gears. Z-Axis movement with 25 mm stroke; Fine focus with 2 μm minimum increments, coarse focus with torque adjustment. Stage lock for high samples, free definable
Illumination
Built-in transmitted 6 V / 30 W Halogen Fixed Koehler illumination or 3 W LED Fixed Koehler illumination (6000 K & 4500 K)
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
32
Compound Microscope Motic BA210
MICROSCOPES
Objectives
The BA210 is designed for both educational and teaching environments delivering a new higher level of optical performance. The new BA210 series is setting a new standard in microscope performance through inprovements both in optical and mechanical features. Designed to be used in Educational Life Science, Medical as well as a variety of biological applications, this new microscope is built around Motic's complete understanding of the daily demands placed on the standard educational microscope. Student proof features together with a new generation of EF-N Plan Achromatic objectives provide a fully corrected intermediate image for crisp and clear visual and digital results. The BA210 is a robust student instrument that brings professional, repeatable image quality results to all of its intended applications.
Observation Tubes • Ergonomic 30 degree viewing angle • 55 - 75 mm interpupillary distance • Large field of view with 18 mm or 20 mm options • Binocular, Trinocular (with 20/80 or 0/100 light split), Digital Eyepieces • N-WF 10x / 18 mm • N-WF 10x / 20 mm • N-WF 15x / 13.3 mm • N-WF 12.5x / 16 mm
Illumination Options • 6 V / 30 W Halogen • 3 W LED • Mirror
Description
N.A.
W.D (mm)
EF-N Plan 4x
0.1
6.3
EF-N Plan 10x
0.25
4.4
EF-N Plan 20x
0.4
4.66
EF-N Plan 40x
0.65
0.35
EF-N Plan 60x
0.85
0.13
EF-N Plan 100x
1.25
0.13
EF-N Plan Phase 10x
0.25
4.4
EF-N Plan Phase 40x
0.65
0.35
Condenser • Abbe 1.25NA with slot for accessories and condenser lock available Stage • Hard coated mechanical stage with 76 x 30 mm travel range • Left or right stage drive available Other Options • Simple phase contrast 10x and 40x sliders for condenser • Darkfield slider for condenser • Simple polarisation with analyser and polarizer
Motic BA310 The new BA310 is designed for the rigors of daily routine work specifically for diverse applications in Haematology and Cytology. The demands placed on any routine microscope for daily work needs careful focus on every microscope detail. The new BA310 features a powerful adjustable light source to meet both delicate and detailed lighting requirements for all sample types while the fully featured Koehler illumination helps in highlighting even the weakest stained specimens. New CCIS EF-N Plan Achromat objectives provide optimal image contrast through newly designed multi-layer lens coatings. Objectives
33
Magnification
N.A.
W.D (mm)
EF-N Plan 4x
0.1
6.3
EF-N Plan 10x
0.25
4.4
EF-N Plan 20x
0.4
4.66
EF-N Plan 40x
0.65
0.35
EF-N Plan 60x
0.85
0.13
EF-N Plan 100x
1.25
0.13
EF-N Plan Phase 10x
0.25
4.4
EF-N Plan Phase 40x
0.65
0.35
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Illumination Options • 6 V / 30 W Halogen • 3 W LED Eyepieces • N-WF 10x / 20 mm • N-WF 15x / 13.3 mm • N-WF 12.5x / 16 mm Condenser • Full Koehler 0.9 / 1.25 NA Stage • Hard coated mechanical stage with 76 x 50 mm travel range • Left or right stage drive available Other Options • Simple phase contrast 10x and 40x sliders for condenser with EF-N Plan objectives • Full phase contrast 1.25NA Turret Condenser (BF, 10xPh, 20xPh, 40xPh, 100xPH) or (BF, DF, 10xPh, 40xPh, 100xPh) with Plan Phase Objectives • Darkfield slider for condenser • Simple polarisation with analyser and polarizer • Multi-viewing device available as side-by-side or face-to-face
Observation Tubes • Ergonomic 30 degree viewing angle • 55 - 75 mm interpupillary distance • Large field of view with 20 mm • Binocular, Trinocular (with 20/80 or 0/100 light split), Digital
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Motic BA410 Rounding out the update of our popular BA series, the BA410 is the flagship platform for expansion.
Imaging has also been improved through new CCD adapters, optimizing the use of all Motic digital cameras with CMOS and CCD sensor targets. The completely lead-free manufacturing of the microscope and its optics follow the RoHS regulations of environment and user protection.
MICROSCOPES
Motic has launched its new upright microscope, the BA410, a newly designed, modular stand especially for routine-clinical, lab, and teaching applications suitable for a wide range of transmitted light applications for the life science markets. A completely redesigned optical system ensures that the BA410 will provide the best image quality in the demanding cytology, pathology, and histology fields from both demanding amateur to professional levels. A variety of new viewing heads are also available, including a trinocular head with three light splits (100:0/20:80/0:100) and two ergonomic heads with tilting and (optional) telescopic functions.
The improved CCIS Optical system includes a variety of contrast techniques like fluorescence, dark field, polarization as well as an improved phase contrast: one condenser covers both positive as well as negative phase contrast lenses. While a solid-state quintuple nosepiece is standard, an optional sextuple nosepiece is now also available.
Motic BA210MET To meet the demands of a Basic Metallurgical Microscope, Motic introduces its entry level model, the BA210MET, for the observation of all opaque materials. Designed with educational purposes in Engineering and Material professions in mind, the newly developed BA210MET offers quality performance at a very favourable price point. The overall optical performance of the BA210MET is defined by a new generation of Metallurgical M Plan Achromatic objectives made of high-quality glass with anti-reflex coating.
New M Plan Optics Motic’s new generation of M Plan Achromat objectives for incident light samples sets a new performance standard at an affordable price level. Through new multi-layer coated lenses, the M offers improved field flatness and resolution, while maintaining sufficient working distance to avoid sample and objective contact.
Description
N.A.
W.D (mm)
M Plan 5X
0.15
14.5
M Plan 10X
0.25
16.0
M Plan 20X
0.40
10.5
M Plan 50X
0.55
5.1
Specifications
BA210MET
Optical System
Color Corrected Infinity Optical System (CCIS®)
Eyepieces
N-WF 10X / 20 mm, with diopter adjustment
Observation Tube
Widefield Binocular 30° Widefield Triocular 30° - light distribution 100:0/20:80
Interpupillary Distance
55 - 75 mm
Nosepiece
Reversed quadruple
Focus
Coaxial movement; 30 mm stroke; Fine focus with 2 μm minimum increments
Stage
159 x 135 mm surface; 75 x 50 mm movement; Coaxial movement
Incident Illumnation
6 V / 30 W Halogen Epi-Illumination, power supply built-in
Max. Specimen Thickness
30 mm
Q3: What did Galileo call his compound microscope before the term "microscope" was coined?
TriviaZone
Q4: What home appliance did Albert Einstein work to improve in the 1930s?
For answers, turn to page 92.
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
34
MICROSCOPES
Motic BA310MET
Specifications
Motic is expanding the success of its popular BA Series microscope line into the industrial market, and is pleased to introduce the new BA310MET series, an affordable and powerful metallurgical microscope line of robust incident light microscopes. Now industrial quality control can be performed for all opaque materials like minerals and metal samples with ease and efficiency. Also, the BA310MET performs well in the educational environments of engineering and material professions, where affordability and ease-ofuse are key demands.
BA310MET
Optical System
Color Corrected Infinity Optical System (CCIS®)
Eyepieces
N-WF 10X / 20 mm, with diopter adjustment
Observation Tube
Widefield Binocular 30° [F.N. 20] Widefield Triocular 30° [F.N. 20] - light distribution 100:0/20:80 Widefield Triocular 30° [F.N. 20] - light distribution 50:50 fixed, erect image
Nosepiece
Reversed quintuple
Stage
180 x 1240 mm surface; 75 x 50 mm movement; coaxial controls
Focus
Brass gears; Z-Axis movement 30 mm
Fine Focus
2 μm minimum increment
Incident Light
12 V / 50 W Halogen illuminator with external power supply Halogen bulb exchangeable with 3 W LED (4500 L, 6000 K), > 20,000 hrs lifespan
Specimen Thickness
Max. 30 mm
The Epi-Illuminator with a 12 V / 50 W Halogen illumination offers a powerful and adjustable light source ideal for all reflective samples. For increased illumination options, an easy replacement of the Halogen bulb is possible by an LED module of different color temperatures (4500 K, 60000 K). A built-in field diaphragm and aperture diaphragm helps to optimize image quality by reducing stray light and increasing control.
Two other additions are also available. The BA310MET-T model has a transmitted light option that allows easy handling and viewing also of transparent samples and greatly increases the number of industrial applications. The BA310MET-H setup contains a more flexible focusing device, dedicated to the examination of large samples with only little limitation in size.
Motic PSM-1000 and PSM-100E "All - In One" laser ready microscope for inspection, testing and corrections in the semiconductor industry.
Specifications
PSM-1000
Trinocular tube
Image
Siedentopf type, adjustment range: 55 mm - 75 mm
Interpupillary distance
24 m
Field Number Optical pass ratio Observation angle adjustment Main Unit
Tube lens [correction] Laser work Applicable laser
/
3° to 30° 1x [ultraviolet and infrared] and 2x [visible] Pull out beam splitter for laser work 1064 / 532 / 355 nm NWR laser
With coaxial coarse and fine focusing wheels [right/left] [50 mm travel range, 0.1mm/rev. for fine adjustment, 4mm/rev. for coarse adjustment]
Focus Adjustment Loading weight on optical tube
20.5 kg C-mount adapter
Camera mount Light source [optional]
150 W cold light source, light guide length 2 m
Objective nosepiece
Parcenterable, outward, rotary type for bright field lens [with 4 mounts], detachable ELWD Plan Apo ULWD Plan Apo
2x, 5x, 10x, 20x, 50x 50x,100x
ELWD Plan Apo [Parfocality Adjustable]
2x, 5x, 10x, 20x, 50x
ULWD Plan Apo [Parfocality Adjustable]
50x ,100x
NIR Apo Mass [main unit / light source]
35
Switchable [eyepiece/laser = 100/0 or 0/100]; Simultaneous observation [50:50]
20X – 2000X
Magnification range
Objectives [optional]
PSM-1000E Erect Image
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
20x, 50x 6.8 kg / 2.5 kg
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Inverted Microscopes Motic AE2000
Motic’s new AE2000 Inverted Microscope is designed for routine live cell inspection with an easy and flexible set up, ideal for university, routine-clinical, and lab environments. The model’s main applications offer superior image quality when viewing cell cultures in microbiology, living organisms and tissue culture samples.
observation position, especially useful for prolonged sample viewing. The auto on / off function of the power supply extends the lifespan of the sample and light bulb and at the same time saves energy. Another added feature, a modular interchangeable illumination concept, allows for the easy transition from halogen to LED to fulfill a wide-range of customer viewing expectations. The improved phase contrast quality of the model makes the instrument suitable for a greater range of applications that demand precision optics.
The newly designed Binocular Ergo tubes with 360° swiveling "butterfly" design and optional telescopic feature offers the most comfortable
The entire microscope including optical system is manufactured now completely lead free, following the International RoHS regulations.
Supporting all these applications and functions is the AE30/31's stable inverted "Y" designed stand. The inverted "Y" provides the necessary stability and weight distribution to handle the attachment of Epi-fluorescence and other accessories. The stand features low position focus mechanisms to alleviate wrist strain while adjusting the focus at 1 mm minimum increments throughout the 10 mm stroke range. The stage sits at a height of 207 mm for rapid sample changes. A universal mechanical stage [tilted adjustment] is available as an option plus a series of Petri dish holders.
Features • CCIS optics • Field flatness up to F.N. 22 • Centrable ELWD 0.30 N.A. condenser [WD = 72 mm] • Standard centrable Phase Contrast slider [PH 1 / PH 3] • Externally mounted and centrable 30 W / 6 V quartz halogen illumination • Epi-fluorescence attachment available
MICROSCOPES
A revolutionary design packed with features, the AE2000 sets a new benchmark in affordable inverted microscopy.
Motic AE30/31 The AE30/31 is an inverted microscope for the routine realm, but offers upscale research functions, such as fluorescence and an externally mounted and centrable 30 W / 6 V halogen Koehler illumination. Complementing the uniform illumination is the ELWD 0.30 N.A. condenser with its 72 mm working distance for large sample and carriers, which can be adjusted and centered to provide the optimum amount of illumination for each sample. Furthermore, the condenser is equipped with a slider stop for the equipped standard centrable PH 1 and PH 3 Phase slider. An optional LWD 0.50 N.A. condenser [WD = 28 mm] is available should the need arise. Driven for applications, the AE30/31 incorporates the Colour Corrected Infinity Optical System [CCIS®] to power system expansions and to produce, along with the CCIS® Plan Achromat inverted objectives, crisp, flat and high contrast images in field flatness up to F.N.22. These images can be viewed for hours upon hours in fatigue free manner thanks to the comfortable 45° observation angle and viewing height of 380 mm [400 mm – trinocular], which is the ideal height from the laboratory tabletop to the users’ eyepieces. Assisting the angle is the Siedentopf system [50 - 70 mm] for setting the correct interpupillary distance and the adjustable high eye point WF10X eyepiece, which can be adjusted ±5° for individual astigmatism and aligning reticules.
www.ereinc.com
Fluorescence – The AE-30/31 system is designed to accept an attachable EpiFluorescence illuminator capable of handling fluorescence microscopy markers FITC to GFP. The attachment inserts into the back of the AE-30/31 stand with filter selection located near the focus control mechanism.
sales@ereinc.com
36
Zoom Stereomicroscopes Motic SMZ-140 Compact Greenough zoom stereomicroscope solution for demanding applications
The SMZ140's vast assortment of accessories create a modular feel to the microscope, opening solutions to demanding applications.
MICROSCOPES
The following are some sample applications: The SMZ-140 line is the most versatile stereomicroscope manufactured by Motic. The list of applications may seem only a few, but each day presents another opportunity to incorporate this fantastic microscope into one’s system. The basic model is a zoom stereomicroscope system with a zoom ratio of 1:4 and a working distance of 80 mm based upon the Greenough optical system. The Greenough optical system displays crisp, stereoscopic images while having the ruggedness to handle harsh environments of the laboratory or machines. With three optical carrier options and numerous stands and accessories, the SMZ-140 can be configured to your requirements. The overall system produces a maximum magnification of 180X and a maximum working distance of 200 mm depending on the configuration chosen by you. In addition, the compact size of the SMZ-140 permits it into areas of limited space or the option of having several units where one could only fit with regular zoom stereomicroscopes. Another option with the SMZ-140 series is the built-in digital versions DM-143 [2-megapixal camera] and DMW-143 [3-simultaneous outputs] versions.
Motic SMZ-168 The SMZ-168 Series of stereomicroscopes incorporates a zoom ratio of 1:6.7, one of the industry's largest, with a standard working distance of 113 mm inside a Greenough optical stereo system. Moreover, the standard system provides a maximum magnification of 50X [with standard 10X eyepieces] and guaranteed parfocality throughout the magnifications. Designed for long term usage, the SMZ-168 is available in both a 35° and 60° observation angle format to fit the application and environment setup. Assisting in fatigue preventation is the high eyepoint system of the standard 10X eyepieces, which allows the user to assume a more comfortable posture when using the microscope and eyeglass wearers to observe without the fear of scratching their lenses. The standard eyepieces offer a field of view of 30.7 mm to cover more of sample in less time. Fabricated for versatility, the SMZ-168 is offered in a modular format to conform the requirements of the task and environment. Expansion is possible with a varity of accessories to handle the complex needs of today as well as tomorrow.
37
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Economic Wire Bonders: The addition of the SMZ-140 with industrial holder onto one’s economic or small-scale wire bonder gives one’s customers the optical power and performance of an upscale model at an entry level price. SMZ-140 for Die Bonders: The size and the optical performance of the SMZ-140 allows one the opportunity to add a high-performance optical microscope for inspection of one’s die bonder without reconfiguring the system. Spot Inspection: Integrating the SMZ-140 with one of the available stands and illumination provides a spot inspection site to randomly test the quality of working being performed during that particular shift. LED Inspection: Combining the optical quality of the SMZ-143 with the real-time filters of the Moticam 2000, defects or potential sources of defects can be identified before the damage [both economically and mechanically] can happen.
Features • Compact size • Available in a trinocular and 60° head versions • Two choices of built in digital camara head • 5 Achromat auxiliary objectives • Max system magnification of 180X • Wide range of arms and stands • Available in two digital versions: DM-143 and DMW-143
The following is a brief reference list of possible industrial applications for the SMZ-168: Wire Bonder: The role of the SMZ-168 60, plus industrial arm, on a wire bonder is to periodically inspect the bond head’s alignment in placing the wire. Manual Probe Station: For inspection of bonding pads and large geometrics, the SMZ168 Trinocular is the ideal choice. The trinocular version provides the option of video output for a convenient observation or digital for documentation and later analysis. Pull Tester: The SMZ-168 with an industrial arm is the optical inspection unit to view the process of pull testing a random wire bonded substrate for failure analysis. Medical Device Inspection: Using the SMZ168 on a boom stand with an exterior light source [i.e. MLC-150 with ring light guide] provides the working surface and/or space saving needed for this inspections. Using the SMZ-168 trinocular with either a Moticam or a third party camera converts the inspection station into a documentation and analysis centre.
Features • 6.7 : 1 Zoom Ratio • 6.7X - 50X standard magnification • 113 mm working distance • 35° ergonomic observation angle • 6 Achromat auxiliary objectives • Available in trinocular and 60° head versions
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Motic FBGG LED 3W LED illumination upgrade of the FBGG stand for the SMZ-168.
Elite Microscope Cameras
Features • 5500 K colour temperature • 3W Lambertian LED individual bulb for incident / transmitted • Adjustable intensity control; linear
Moticam Pro Series Microscope Cameras The Moticam Pro range consists of 12 feature rich options providing a large platform for highquality digital microscopy. A Moticam Pro is a sensitive piece of equipment designed to deliver high-quality CCD based images and yet still be affordable and flexible enough for a large variety of applications. Choose from Colored / Monochrome and Standard / Peltier Cooled options. The Moticam Pro marks an extension of Motic’s Camera solutions from the affordable high-resolution CMOS market to the scientific grade CCD range while still offering many choices. Whether your application calls for a Full Color 5.0 MP camera for documentation or a Cooled Monochrome camera with 6.45 x 6.45 micron pixels for low light microscopy, there is a Moticam Pro available for you. Designed exclusively in the new labs in Vancouver BC, and assembled under clean-room conditions in the Motic factory headquarters, these cameras are ready to be shipped at a moment’s notice. As with all Motic Digital Solutions, the Moticam Pro is shipped with a full complement of application software and tools to get you started right away.
Sensor Size
MICROSCOPES
The Motic FBGG LED stand is the LED upgrade of the existing FBGG stand for the SMZ-168 series of stereomicroscopes. The stand is equipped with individual 3W LED bulbs for incident and transmitted illumination, which can be used in conjunction or separately. Both the incident and transmitted illumination's intensity can be adjusted from 0% to 100% via the linear intensity control located on the right side of the stand.
The FBGG LED's transmitted illumination is an indirect illumination to avoid the hot spot problems of the other LED stands when used with a digital camera. While the incident illumination is able to be adjusted from an angle of 0° to 33° with a working field of 50 mm. Both operate in the 5500 K colour temperature range for smooth and comfortable usage.
Pixel Size (Micron)
Resolution (Pixel)
Features
MoticamPro
Sony Sensor
252A
ICX252AQ
1/1.8"
3.45 X 3.45
2080 X 1542
Color
252B
ICX252AQ
1/1.8"
3.45 X 3.45
2080 X 1542
Color With Peltier Cooling
282A
ICX282AQ
2/3"
3.40 X 3.40
2580 X 1944
Color
282B
ICX282AQ
2/3"
3.40 X 3.40
2580 X 1944
Color With Peltier Cooling
205A
ICX205AK
1/2"
4.65 X 4.65
1360 X 1024
Color
205B
ICX205AK
1/2"
4.65 X 4.65
1360 X 1024
Color With Peltier Cooling
205C
ICX205AL
1/2"
4.65 X 4.65
1360 X 1024
Monochrome
205D
ICX205AL
1/2"
4.65 X 4.65
1360 X 1024
Monochrome With Peltier Cooling
285A
ICX85AQ
2/3"
6.45 X 6.45
1360 X 1024
Color
285B
ICX285AQ
2/3"
6.45 X 6.45
1360 X 1024
Color With Peltier Cooling
285C
ICX285AL
2/3"
6.45 X 6.45
1360 X 1024
Monochrome
285D
ICX285AL
2/3"
6.45 X 6.45
1360 X 1024
Monochrome With Peltier Cooling
www.ereinc.com
Hardware • Sony ICX CCD imaging sensor • Motic control, processing & imaging boards • Built-in 4 frame buffer* • Built-in FPGA* • TTL trigger port* • Schott BG-40 filter • CS/C mount (C-ring provided) • USB 2.0 Data mini port (USB cable provided) • Universal power supply (for cooled cameras only) • Peltier cooling device (for cooled cameras only) • Cooling up to 10 degrees below ambient with temperature readout * Unlockable with SDK integration
Software • MOTIC IMAGES PLUS application software • MOTIC IMAGES ADVANCED application software for windows computer only* • Twain Drivers • Motic SDK • Motic direct show drivers • Motic MI devices live imaging module with live calibration, grid, scale cross and scale bars * Available through free download
Recommened Computer Specifications • Intel Centrino 1,6 GHz or better • 1 GB RAM or better (2 GB recommended if using shared memory graphics card) • USB 2.0 • Windows XP (SP3) or better • Macintosh OSX
sales@ereinc.com
38
Basic Microscope Cameras MICROSCOPES
Moticams Moticams are known around the globe for their ease-of-use and their adaptability to a number of applications. Motic strives to ensure that everything you may need to attach the Moticam to your microscope is included in one box.
Moticam 1 and 1SP
Moticam 2 and 3
Each includes: • An attachable camera • A focusable coated glass lens • Two adjustable size eyepiece adapters • A 4-dot calibration slide • The macro viewing tube • All cables • A full version of Motic Images Plus application software
Moticam 1 • Live resolution: 800 x 600 pixels • Sensor type: CMOS • Optical calculation: 1/4" • Focusable lens: 8 mm
Moticam 2 • Live resolution: 2.0 Mega pixels • Sensor type: CMOS • Optical calculation: 1/3" • Focusable lens: 12 mm
Moticam 1SP • Live resolution: 1.3 Mega pixels • Sensor type: CMOS • Optical calculation: 1/3" • Focusable lens: 12 mm
Moticam 3 • Live resolution: 3.0 Mega pixels • Sensor type: CMOS • Optical calculation: 1/2" • Focusable lens: 16 mm
Moticam 5 and 10
Moticam 580
Moticam X
Moticam 5 • Live resolution: 5.0 Mega pixels • Sensor type: CMOS • Optical calculation: 1/2.5" • Focusable lens: 12 mm
This camera does not require a computer for standard operation once it has been setup on a microscope.
The Moticam X is a next generation microscope camera that will transform almost any old conventional microscope into a wireless device capable of sending live high resolution images to your WIFI laptop or tablet devices.
Moticam 3 • Live resolution: 10.0 Mega pixels • Sensor type: CMOS • Optical calculation: 1/2.5" • Focusable lens: 12 mm
39
• • • • •
Sensor type: CMOS Sensor resolution: 5.0 MP Optical calculation: 1/2.5" Focusable lens: 12 mm Output possibilities: HDMI, Analog Video, USB, SD Card • Recording possibilities: 1080 Video and 5.0 MP onto SD Card • Remote control
• • • • • • •
Sensor type: CMOS WIFI resolution: 1280 x 1024 pixels Optical calculation: 1/3" Focusable lens: 12 mm Calibration slide Macro tube Power supply: Through provided switching power adapter
Motic Images Plus 2.0
Motic Images Advanced 3.2
• Multi-language application software • Turn images into knowledge through capture, measurement, editing, amalgamation and reporting tools • Software for Macintosh OSX included where available
• Same tools as Motic Images Plus 2.0 plus • Manual and single point segmentation • Multi focus: Assembles a single focused image from a stack • Assembly: Assembles series of x/y images • Save images in DICOM standard
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Meiji Techno Microscopes
EMZ-8TR TRINOCULAR ZOOM STEREO BODY
Features • Binocular zoom body with crisp, high resolution, precision optics provide an excellent, erect, unreversed stereoscopic image • Rugged all metal body designed to last a lifetime • Zoom Range: 0.7X to 4.5X • Zoom Ratio: 6.5:1 • Ergonomically positioned bilateral zoom controls • Binocular eyetubes inclined at 45° for fatigue free viewing • Total magnification range available with auxiliary lenses and eyepieces: 2.1X to 270X • Dual dioptric adjustments (±5 diopters) allows the specimen to remain in focus throughout the entire zoom magnification range • Interpupillary distance adjustment from 54 mm to 75 mm • Binocular body can be rotated a full 360° and locked in any position • Standard working distance: 93 mm • Working distance with optional auxiliary lenses: 34 mm to 251 mm
Features • Trinocular zoom body for use in photographic and video applications. When the beamsplitter is engaged, 100% of the light from the left optical path is directed to the phototube. The image can still be viewed through the right eyetube. • Crisp, high resolution, precision optics provide an excellent, erect, unreversed stereoscopic image • Rugged all metal body designed to last a lifetime • Zoom Range: 0.7X to 4.5X • Zoom Ratio: 6.5:1 • Ergonomically positioned bilateral zoom controls • Binocular eyetubes inclined at 45° for fatigue free viewing • Total magnification range available with auxiliary lenses and eyepieces: 2.45X to 202.5X • Dual dioptric adjustments (±5 diopters) allows the specimen to remain in focus throughout the entire zoom magnification range • Interpupillary distance adjustment from 54 mm to 75 mm • Binocular body can be rotated a full 360° and locked in any position • Standard working distance: 104 mm • Working distance with optional auxiliary lenses: 57 mm to 250 mm
MT-EMZ-5 Binocular Zoom Stereo Body, 0.7X to 4.5X, W.D. 93 mm MT-MA502 10X Super Wide Field Eyepiece MT-P-STAND Basic Pole Stand W/ "F" Focusing Holder Mounted On A Plain Base
MICROSCOPES
EMZ-5 BINOCULAR ZOOM STEREO BODY
MT-PK-STAND An Extended Working Distance Ergonomic Pole Stand W/ 250 mm Pole & "F" Focusing Holder Mounted On An Ergo Base MT-PKL2-STAND An Ergonomic Pole Type Stand W/ Dual LED Illumination System MT-PBH-STAND Pole Type Stand W/ Focusing Holder & W/ Dual Halogen Illumination System
P Stand Basic pole stand with "F" focusing holder mounted on a plain base. Supplied with one 94.5 mm diameter reversible black and white stage plate and two stage clips. (8.35" / 212 mm pillar)
PK Stand An extended working distance ergonomic pole stand with 250 mm pole and "F" focusing holder mounted on a ergo base. Supplied with one 94.5 mm diameter reversible black and white stage plate and two stage clips. The PK can be accessorized with an optional 20 watt halogen incident illuminator with stand alone power supply. Base Dimensions: 330 mm (12.99") wide x 280 mm (11") deep.
PKL-2 Stand An ergonomic pole type stand with transmitted and incident LED illumination system, coarse focusing holder, 5 watt LED incident llumination, dual variable intensity control, removable glass stage plate, two stage clips, and power cord. Transmitted light base features an extremely bright multiple LED array with milk white diffusion plate and clear glass stage plate. Automatic voltage (100 V to 240 V) sensing power supply. Optional accessories include analyzer/polarizer for transmitted light pol work, white/black stage plate, 4" pole extension, and mechanical stages. Base Dimensions: 330 mm (12.99") wide x 280 mm (11") deep
MT-EMZ-8TR Trinocular Zoom Stereo Body, 0.7X to 4.5X, W.D. 104 mm
PBH Stand
MT-PK-STAND An Extended Working Distance Ergonomic Pole Stand W/ 250 mm Pole & "F" Focusing Holder Mounted On An Ergo Base
Illuminated pole stand with "F" focusing holder. Provides both transmitted and incident halogen illumination with variable intensity control. Supplied with 94.5 mm diameter clear glass stage plate, reversible black and white stage plate and two stage clips. Illuminators may be operated independently or simultaneously. Total Height: 280 mm (11.02"). Pillar Height: 212 mm (8.35"). Base Dimensions: 160 mm (6.30") wide by 240 mm (9.44") deep.
www.ereinc.com
MT-EMZ-13TR Trinocular Zoom Stereo Body, 1X to 7X, W.D. 90 mm MT-MA502 10X Super Wide Field Eyepiece MT-P-STAND Basic Pole Stand W/ "F" Focusing Holder Mounted On A Plain Base
MT-PKL2-STAND An Ergonomic Pole Type Stand W/ Dual Led Illumination System MT-PBH-STAND Pole Type Stand W/ Focusing Holder & W/ Dual Halogen Illumination System
sales@ereinc.com
40
MICROSCOPES
RZ SERIES RZ Series CMO Stereo Microscopes are advanced, high-performance, modular, stereo microscopes specifically designed with today's demanding microscopy applications in mind. Engineered around a common main objective and parallel optical paths, the RZ Series offers crisp, distortion-free, high-resolution images at magnifications ranging from 3.75X to 300X. Browse the optical components, photo/video accessories, and stands to configure a system to meet your needs. The RZ features a 10:1 zoom ratio with built-in variable dual-iris diaphragms and 12 positive click stops through the zoom range. Two perpendicular columns of eight zoom lenses in four groups move in smooth motion controlled by ergonomically sized and positioned zoom knobs. A magnification indicator is conveniently located on the zoom control. Exterior components are painted with special anti-static finish which is especially useful when working in sensitive environments. Two types of viewing heads are available.
The body is the heart of the modular zoom stereo microscope design. It contains the objectives and prisms that capture the image of the specimen, magnify it, and direct it to the eyetubes. The body by itself cannot be used to view an object; it also needs eyepieces that further magnify the image and allow the viewer to see, and it must be mounted on a stand that has a focus mechanism for raising and lowering the body.
MT-RZ-B Zoom Body & Focus Block, 1:10 Zoom Ratio W/ Built-In Iris Diaphragm & Click Stops * MT-748 Binocular Head, 45째 Incline MT-749 Ergonomic Binocular Head, Inclination Adjustable Vertically From 10째 To 150째 * MT-730 UWF 10X Eyepiece, High Eyepoint, Focusable, Fn 24 (Each), Receives 25 mm O.D. (Reticule) * MT-742 Plan Objective, 1.0X For The MT-RZ-B, W.D. 76 mm * MT-RZP-STAND Plain Stand W/ Black Plastic Stage Plate, 12.79" (325 mm) Tall Pillar MT-RZT-STAND Transmitted Light Stand For Brightfield Illumination, 12.79" (325 mm) Tall Pillar * MT-MA-964 LED Ring Illuminator W/ Transformer, 115 V - Mounts Directly To RZ Series Objective W/O Adapter MT-MA-751 Photo / Video Attachment * As shown in picture.
Zoom stereo microscope bodies are the most flexible because they offer a wider range of magnification than turret (EMT) or fixed (EMF) bodies. Much like the zoom lens on a camera, zoom objectives increase and decrease magnification progressively, causing the specimen to grow or shrink smoothly in the eyes of the viewer.
Meiji Techno offers EM Series zoom stereo microscope bodies with a wide range of magnifications and working distances. All EM bodies come with dust covers and rubber eyeshields. Eyepieces are sold separately and we have a wide selection to offer.
Compound Biological Microscope MT4000 The Meiji MT4000 Series Biological Laboratory Microscopes include the advanced Infinity Corrected Optical System. The MT4000 series includes: Objective Lenses: DIN Infinity Corrected Optical System (ICOS) Plan brightfield 4X, 10X, s40X and s100X oil mounted in smooth-operating, ball bearing mounted, quintuple nosepiece. Viewing Heads: Siedentopf-type binocular head or trinocular head for camera integration. Each head has the eyetubes inclined at 30째 with the left eyetube having graduated diopter settings. The interpupillary distance is adjustable between 53 mm - 75 mm. An 80/20 beamsplitter for the trinocular tube can be engaged for photo work. (100% to eyetubes or 80% to phototube & 20% to the eyetube.) Eyepieces: 10X Widefield High Eyepoint eyepieces F.N.20 are standard with a 19 mm reticle mount. 15X and 20X eyepieces are available as an option. Also avilable - Widefield High Eyepoint 10X focusable eyepiece that accept 25 mm reticles. Total Magnification: 40X, 100X, 400X and 1000X Specimen Stage: Ceramic coated right-handed (left-handed avilable upon request), flat top stage measures 171 mm x 115 mm and travels 78 mm(X) x 52 mm(Y). Ergonomically positioned coaxial drop down controls. Illumination: Powerful white LED or 30 watt halogen illumination provides enhanced image quality and brightness for the observation of specimens and photomicroscopy. Light Focusing: Abbe 1.25 NA Condenser in quick change dovetail mount. Size & Weight: Binocular - 390 mm (15.4") D x 410 mm (16.1") H x 210 mm (8.3") W, 8 kg (17.6 lbs) Trinocular - 390 mm (15.4") D x 465 mm (18.3") H x 210 mm (8.3") W, 8.7 kg (19.2 lbs)
41
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
MT-4200L Binocular Compound Biological Microscope W/ LED Illuminator MT-4200H Binocular Compound Biological Microscope W/ 30 W Halogen MT-4300L Trinocular Compound Biological Microscope W/ LED Illuminator MT-4300H Trinocular Compound Biological Microscope W/ 30 W Halogen
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Metallurgical MT7000
Made in Japan MICROSCOPES
The MT7000 Metallurgical Reflected Light Microscope includes: Objective Lenses: DIN Infinity Corrected Optical System (ICOS) Plan Epi 5X, 10X, 20X and 50X mounted in smooth-operating, ball bearing mounted, quintuple nosepiece. Viewing Heads: Siedentopf-type binocular head or trinocular head for camera integration. Each head has the eyetubes inclined at 30° with the left eyetube having graduated diopter settings. The interpupillary distance is adjustable between 53 mm - 75 mm. An 80/20 beamsplitter for the trinocular tube can be engaged for photo work. (100% to eyetubes or 80% to phototube & 20% to the eyetube.) 30 mm I.D. eyetube. Eyepieces: SWH10X Widefield High Eyepoint eyepieces F.N.22 are standard with a 25 mm reticle mount. 15X and 20X eyepieces are available as an option. Also available - Widefield High Eyepoint 10X focusable eyepiece that accept 25 mm reticles. Total Magnification: 50X, 100X, 200X and 500X Specimen Stage: Ceramic-coated flat-top stage 191 mm x 126 mm, with 100 mm x 100 mm of travel. Equipped with precision ball bearing guides and low position drop down coaxial controls for X-Y movement. Illumination: Vertical illuminator with full Koehler design equipped with high intensity 6 V, 30 Watt halogen light source, field iris, aperture iris and filter slots. Capable of brightfield or simple reflected light polarization techniques. Includes blue clear, green clear, polarizing and neutral density (ND 50) filters in mounts. Automatic voltage (100 V~240 V) sensing power supply and variable rheostat control are built into the microscope base. Focusing: Ergonomically low positioned coaxial focusing controls allow the operator to work with their forearms relaxed on the working surface. Range of travel is 23 mm. Rotation of fine focus is 0.2 mm per revolution. Size & Weight: Binocular - MT7000 424.5 mm (16.7") D x 471 mm (18.5") H x 210 mm (8.3") W, 8.5 kg (18.7 lbs) Trinocular - MT7100 424.5 mm (16.7") D x 526 mm (20.7") H x 210 mm (8.3") W, 9.2 kg (20.3 lbs)
MT-7000 Binocular Metallurgical Microscope MT-7100 Trinocular Metallurgical Microscope
Asbestos Combo PLM - PCM Microscopes The MT6800 Series Combo PLM - PCM (Polarized Light and Phase Contrast) Microscopes for Asbestos fiber identification applications are manufactured pursuant to NIOSH 9002 Reference methods and NIOSH 7400 and OSHA ID 160 Reference methods. Each model comes with Strain free Plan DIN brightfield POL objectives, rotatable stage with 360 degree graduations, POL / PHASE / Dispersion Staining Abbe condenser and builtin Koehler illuminator as standard equipment. Viewing Heads: Model MA952 is the Siedentopf-type binocular head and Model MA953 is the trinocular head for camera integration. Each head has the 23.2 mm eyetubes inclined at 30 degrees with the left eyetube having graduated diopter settings. The interpupillary distance is adjustable between 53 mm - 75 mm. An 80/20 beamsplitter for the trinocular tube can be engaged for photo work. Each head has the new integrated reticle angle compensation system. When the IP distance or number is changed, the crossline reticle remains perpendicular in the FOV. Eyepieces: 10X Widefield High Eyepoint eyepiece F.N.20, 10X Widefield High Eyepoint
www.ereinc.com
focusable eyepiece that has a 21 mm crossline reticule and guide pin, and 10X Widefield High Eyepoint Compensating Focusing eyepiece, F.N.20 with Walton & Beckett reticle are standard.
Objective Changer: The smooth-operating, ball bearing mounted, quadruple nosepiece provides effortless objective changes. Objectives: Assortment of U. Planachromat Phase and S. Planachromat Polarizing Infinity Corrected objectives are available. Stage: Ceramic coated 360 degree rotatable fully indexed stage with vernier and stage clips. Condenser: Strain free Abbe condenser, N.A. 1.25 with centerable annuli for 10X, 20X, 40X phase or 10X, 20X, 40X dispersion staining objectives in sliding mount, with iris diaphragm and dovetail mount. Illumination: Powerful 30 watt transmitted light Koehler halogen illumination provides enhanced image quality and brightness for the observation of specimens. Accessories: All MT6800 series models come with a first order red compensating plate (also called gypsum or sensitive tint plate), an analyzer in sliding mount, bertrand lens, blue clear and green interference filters, centering telescope, and stage micrometer. MT-6820 Binocular PLM-PCM Microscope MT-6830 Trinocular PLM-PCM Microscope
sales@ereinc.com
42
MICROSCOPES
MT-9900 The MT9900 series incident and transmitted light polarizing microscopes include the following: Objective Lenses: DIN Infinity Corrected Optical System (ICOS) Strain Free Plan 4X, 10X and s40X mounted in smooth-operating, ball bearing mounted, quintuple nosepiece. Viewing Heads: Siedentopf-type binocular head or trinocular head for camera integration. Each head has the eyetubes inclined at 30° with the left eyetube having graduated diopter settings. The interpupillary distance is adjustable between 53 mm - 75 mm. An 80/20 beamsplitter for the trinocular tube can be engaged for photo work. (100% to eyetubes or 80% to phototube & 20% to the eyetube.) Eyepieces: One KHW10X Focusing eyepiece with guide pin and crossline reticle and one widefield compensating eyepiece F.N.20 are standard with a 21 mm reticle mount. Tube O.D. 23.2 mm. Total Magnification: 40X, 100X, 400X Specimen Stage: Ceramic-coated 360 degree rotatable fully indexed stage with vernier and stage clips. Stage is 175 mm in diameter. Illumination: Transmitted Koehler 6V, 30W halogen illumination and reflected 6 V, 30 W Koehler halogen illumination. Condenser: Strain Free Abbe N.A. 1.25 condenser with iris in dovetail mount with swing-out top lens for lower power objectives Focusing: Ergonomically low positioned coaxial focusing controls allow the operator to work with their forearms relaxed on the working surface. Range of travel is 23 mm. Rotation of fine focus is 0.2 mm per revolution. Included: MT-9900 series incident and transmitted brightfield models with focusable bertrand lens, rotatable analyzer, and 3-position slider with 1st order red, 1/4 wave plate, brightfield position.
MT-9920 MT-9930
Note: C-mount adapter and digital camera are optional items and are not included in the price below. MT-9920 Binocular Polarizing Microscope W/ Incident & Transmitted Illumination MT-9930 Trinocular Polarizing Microscope W/ Incident & Transmitted Illumination
Microscope Accessories Plain Microscope Slides
Superfrost / Colorfrost Microscope Slides
Made from the highest purity, corrosion-resistant glass. Slides are packed in airtight wrapper to keep out dust and moisture that can cause sticking.
Slides have a raised printed writing surface that eliminates the need for tedious relabeling of slides. The unique opaque coating provides a bright background for excellent contrast and smooth surface makes it easier to write on. The durable, opaque tab is inert to common laboratory, chemicals and reagents.
Features • Autoclavable • Durable, opaque tab • Available in an array of tab colors
43
Coverglass
Superslip Cover Glass
Made of the finest optical borosilicate glass. The coverglass is corrosion resistant, and ready for use. Manufactured of glass which is stickresistant. It is available in squares, circles and rectangles. Packed in 1 oz plastic boxes with custom-molded bases for easy one-at-a-time dispensing. Available in all standard and non-standard sizes.
Superslip® Cover Glass is uniquely manufactured to eliminate sticking and reduce waste. Our processing techniques result in superior quality. This product combines specialized production methods and moisture resistant packaging to prevent sticking. Superslip Cover Glass is the product you need to make your coverslipper run smoothly.
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Jaw Crushers
Retsch Jaw Crushers BB 100/BB and 200/BB 300
RETSCH Jaw Crushers are primarily used in laboratories and pilot plants, often under rough conditions. For applications such as the quality control of raw materials the BB 200 and BB 300 can be integrated into the process line for continuous operation.
Features • Powerful size reduction with high throughput • High final fineness (down to d90 < 2 mm) • Wear compensation due to zero point adjustment • Batch-wise and continuous operation • Wide selection of breaking jaw materials • Safe and simple handling and cleaning
Rotor Mills
Retsch Jaw Crusher BB 51
Retsch Ultra Centrifugal Mill ZM 200
The BB 51 jaw crusher is particularly useful in reducing small laboratory samples with a large feed size down to < 0.5 mm in one easy step. Samples such as stone, minerals, ores, glass, synthetic resins and many other hard or brittle substances are ground without contamination, using grinding tools of manganese steel, stainless steel, wear-resistant tungsten carbide, zirconium oxide or heavy metal-free steel. The grind size is controlled through a digital gap width setting. The BB 51 features a zero-point-adjustment to compensate for wear and assure reproducible samples at all times. With its small footprint and dust-tight housing, this unique jaw crusher easily fits on any laboratory bench.
The powerful and versatile ZM 200 offers the ultimate in performance and operating comfort. This widely used mill pulverizes a great variety of substances extremely fast, thus allowing for a high sample throughput without degradation of sample properties. The grinding sets can be cleaned easily without any tools which helps to avoid cross contamination from frequently changing samples.
BB 51
BB 100
BB 200
Medium-hard, hard, brittle, tough
Type of Material:
Specifications
ZM 200
Application:
Fine grinding
Feed Material:
Soft, medium-hard, brittle, fibrous
Feed Size*:
< 10 mm
Final Fineness*:
< 40 μm
BB 300
Coarse and pre-crushing
Application:
Thanks to the vast range of accessories with different rotors, ring sieves and collecting systems, the ZM 200 can be easily adapted to suit a wide range of applications.
Features • Robust high torque motor with speed range from 6,000 to 18,000 rpm • Rapid and gentle size reduction by 2step rotor / screen system • Easy to operate and clean • Automatic feeding system for sample volumes of up to 4.5 liters
Features • High final fineness (d90 < 0.5 mm) • Digital gap width setting • Breaking jaws in 5 different materials • No-rebound feed hopper • Dust-tight, no maintenance required
Specifications
MILLS & GRINDERS
The powerful RETSCH Jaw Crushers are designed for the rapid, gentle coarse and primary crushing of hard, brittle and tough materials. The breaking jaws are available in a variety of materials which include heavy-metalfree steel. Their efficiency and safety makes these pulverizers ideal for sample preparation in laboratories and industrial plants. Four basic models are available: from the compact benchtop model BB 51 to the biggest floor model, BB 300 which allows for feed sizes up to 130 mm. RETSCH jaw crushers combine increased operating convenience with maximum working safety.
Feed Size*:
< 35 mm
< 50 mm
< 90 mm
< 130 mm
Final Fineness*:
< 0.5 mm
< 4 mm
< 2 mm
< 5 mm
* Depending on feed material and instrument configuration/settings
* Depending on feed material and instrument configuration/settings
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
44
MILLS & GRINDERS
Retsch Rotor Beater Mills SR 200 and SR 300 Due to their robust design and their ability to process large amounts of sample, the Rotor Beater Mills SR 200 and SR 300 are ideal for smallscale production and are also suitable for installation into automated preparation systems. The SR 300 is the leader among the Rotor Beater Mills. Its high speed allows a high sample throughput. Grinding chamber, feed hopper and material inlet and outlet are completely made from highquality stainless steel.
Specifications
SR 200 / SR 300
Application:
Size reduction, deagglomeration
Feed Material:
Soft, medium-hard
Feed Size*:
< 15 mm
Final Fineness*:
< 80 μm / < 50 μm
* Depending on feed material and instrument configuration / settings
High final fineness Features • High throughput • Final fineness down to 50 μm • Easy handling and cleaning • Exchangeable grinding and sieve inserts • Distance rotor for thermally sensitive samples • Quick-action door lock and motor brake
Size reduction and deagglomeration in the SR 200 and SR 300 are achieved by impact and shear effects. The feed material passes from the hopper into the center of the grinding chamber where it is crushed between the rotor, sieve and grinding inserts.
Retsch Cyclone Mill TWISTER
Retsch Cross Beater Mill SK 100
The cyclone mill TWISTER is used for the sample preparation prior to NIR analysis. It is suitable for the quick and gentle grinding of fibrous and soft products down to analytical fineness. Typical applications include feeds, forage and grain. The high speed and the optimized form of the rotor and the grinding chamber generate an air jet which carries the sample through the cyclone into the sample bottle and also has a cooling effect on the material.
Like the Rotor Beater Mills, the Cross Beater Mill SK 100 is suitable for coarse and fine size reduction, either in batches or continuously. This robust mill is used in the laboratory as well as under rough conditions in production facilities. Due to its powerful drive, it is often possible to achieve a fineness < 100 μm in a single working step. Moreover, the SK 100 offers the highest possible degree of operating safety.
Features • 3 controlled speeds • Cyclone separator with 250 mL collecting bottle for quick sample extraction • No cross contamination thanks to easy cleaning
Specifications
TWISTER
Application:
Sample preparation for NIR analysis
As soon as the material is smaller than the aperture size of the sieve it enters the collecting receptacle. The quick-acting door lock ensures easy access to the grinding chamber for quick cleaning. With their motor brake (braking time 0.5 s), safety switch, splashback and access barrier in the inlet and outlet areas, the SR 200 offers the highest degree of operating safety.
Features • High throughput • Final fineness down to 100 μm • Easy handling and cleaning • Wide range of accessories including various collection and feeding systems, rotors and sieves Specifications
SK 100
Application:
Size reduction
Feed Material:
Medium-hard, brittle
Feed Size*:
< 15 mm
Final Fineness*:
< 100 μm
* Depending on feed material and instrument configuration / settings Feed Material:
Fibrous, soft
Feed Size*:
< 10 mm
Final Fineness*:
< 500 μm
* Depending on feed material and instrument configuration / settings
45
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Cutting Mills
Retsch Cutting mills SM 100, SM 200 and SM 300
The RETSCH Cutting Mills SM 200 and SM 300 excel especially in the tough jobs where other cutting mills fail. They provide highly efficient primary size reduction of such heterogeneous materials as waste or electronic components but are also suitable for many other types of samples. The mills offer a high level of operational safety and a long service life of the grinding tools. A wide selection of screens, hoppers, collection systems as well as a cyclone-suction-combination allow for easy adaptation to the individual application task. All units are also available in a special version for heavy-metal-free size reduction.
Specifications
SM 100 / SM 200 / SM 300
Application:
Size reduction
Feed Material:
Soft, medium-hard, tough, elastic, fibrous
Feed Size*:
Max. 60 x 80 mm
Final Fineness*:
0.25 - 20 mm
MILLS & GRINDERS
The cutting mill SM 100 processes soft, medium-hard, elastic and fibrous products which can be comminuted without requiring extremely high forces. The mill is particularly suited for routine applications. It is easy to operate and can be mounted on a solid table or on the optional base frame.
Features • Powerful size reduction, including heterogeneous materials • SM 300 with variable speed • Defined final fineness • Low heat build-up • Quick and easy cleaning • Wide range of accessories
* Depending on feed material and instrument configuration / settings
Knife Mills Features • Perfect homogenization • Results with minimum standard deviation • Variable speed • For sample volumes up to 700 mL or 4,500 mL • Autoclavable grinding tools • Unique lids for volume adaptation of grinding chamber • Accessories for heavy-metal-free grinding
Retsch Knife Mills Grindomix GM 200 and GM 300 The Grindomix Knife Mills set new standards in food sample preparation. The cutting effect produced by the steel blades in conjunction with the patented gravity lid results in the size reduction and perfect homogenization of samples high in water or oil content. It is possible to take a random, yet representative sub-sample from any location in the grinding chamber and still obtain a meaningful analysis result. The GM 200 and GM 300 produce representative samples with a minimum standard deviation in as little as 30 seconds. With its sturdy design, industrial motor, high safety standard and digital parameter settings including memory the Grindomix mills are truly professional laboratory devices that easily outperform any household mixer or conventional knife mill. A wide range of containers and lids makes it easy to adapt the mill to various applications. The GM 300 is suitable for the fast and reproducible grinding and homogenizing of sample volumes up to 4,500 mL.
Grinding jar in plastic, stainless steel and glass available www.ereinc.com
Specifications
GM 200 / GM 300
Application:
Size reduction and homogenization
Feed Material:
Soft, medium-hard, elastic, high water, oil or fat content, dry
Feed Size*:
< 40 mm / < 130 mm
Final Fineness*: < 0.3 mm * Depending on feed material and instrument configuration / settings
sales@ereinc.com
46
MILLS & GRINDERS
Disc Mills
Mortar Grinders
Retsch Vibratory Disc Mill RS 200
Retsch Mortar Grinder RM 200
No grinder can beat the speed of a Vibratory Disc Mill when it comes to preparing samples for spectral analyses. The RETSCH RS 200 with its powerful stabilized plane drive achieves grind sizes between 40 and 100 microns within seconds and with excellent reproducibility. The powerful instrument runs steadily and smoothly, even with heavy grinding sets and at maximum speed. Thanks to grinding sets in various materials and sizes, this mill can be used for a wide range of sample materials.
The RM 200 is the latest generation of the classic "RETSCH Mill" which replaced manual mortars and pestles more than 80 years ago. It is widely used for reproducible sample preparation in R&D, materials testing and especially in pharmaceutics and homeopathy. Many different materials can be easily and efficiently processed in wet or dry condition. The grinding sets of the RM 200 can be selected out of 7 different materials which allows for neutral-to-analysis sample preparation. The new generation of mortar grinders is exceptionally powerful, safe and easy to operate.
Features • Analytical fineness in seconds • Excellent reproducibility • Powerful stabilized-plane-drive • Easy 1-button operation with graphics display • 10 parameter combinations can be stored
Features • Reproducible dry and wet grinding • Easy exchange of pestle and mortar without tools • Closed, dust-tight grinding chamber with windows • Grinding sets in 7 different materials • High-performance drive with electronic control
Specifications
RS 200
Application:
Size reduction, mixing, triturating
Feed Material:
Medium-hard, hard, brittle, fibrous
Feed Size*:
< 15 mm
Specifications
RM 200
Final Fineness*:
< 40 μm
Application:
Size reduction, mixing, triturating
Feed Material:
Soft, hard, brittle, pasty, dry and wet
Feed Size*:
< 8 mm
* Depending on feed material and instrument configuration / settings
Final Fineness*: < 10 μm
* Depending on feed material and instrument configuration / settings
Mixer Mills
Retsch Disc Mill DM 200 The Disc Mill DM 200 allows for the fine grinding of larger batches of hard, abrasive substances. The rugged design permits use under rough conditions in laboratories and pilot plants as well as in-line for quality control of raw materials. The Disc Mill achieves an average final fineness of approximately 100 microns often in a single grinding process. Features • Short grinding times, high final fineness • Accurate gap setting ensures reproducible grinding • Grinding discs made of 4 different materials
Specifications
DM 200s
Application:
Size reduction, pre-crushing
Feed Material:
Medium-hard, hard, brittle
Feed Size*:
< 20 mm
Final Fineness*:
< 100 μm
* Depending on feed material and instrument configuration / settings
47
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Excellent crushing performance
Retsch Mixer Mill MM 400 The RETSCH Mixer Mill MM 400 is a true laboratory "all-rounder". It has been developed specially for dry, wet and cryogenic grinding of small sample amounts. This high-performance ball mill usually grinds and homogenizes powders and suspensions in only a few seconds and achieves grind sizes down to the nano range. It is also perfectly suitable for the disruption of biological cells as well as for DNA / RNA recovery. Due to its great versatility, the MM 400 is used in many different industries ranging from pharmaceutics and biology to mineralogy, environment or plastics.
Features • Rapid and efficient pulverization and homogenization • Reproducible results due to digital parameter setting • Grinding jars in various sizes and materials • 9 parameter combinations can be stored • Simultaneous preparation of up to 20 samples
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Retsch CryoMill
The Mixer Mill MM 200 is also used for efficient size reduction and homogenization of 2 samples simultaneously. It works with the same functional principle as the MM 400. This mill is highly suitable for grinding dry samples in small quantities and offers a favourably priced alternative to the MM 400 for routine applications. The grinding jars for the MM 200 have a push-fit lid.
The CryoMill has been specially designed for cryogenic grinding. It features an integrated cooling system which continually cools the grinding jar with liquid nitrogen before and during the grinding process. Thus the sample is embrittled and volatile components are preserved. The liquid nitrogen circulates through the system and is continually replenished from an autofill system in the exact amount which is required to keep the temperature at -196°C. The automatic cooling system guarantees that the grinding process is not started before the sample is thoroughly cooled. This results in reduced consumption and guarantees reproducible grinding results. The size reduction principle is the same as that of the MM 400. With a vibrational frequency of 25 Hz the CryoMill grinds most materials very effectively in a few minutes. The combination of impact and friction leads to substantially finer grind sizes compared to other cryogenic mills. The CryoMill is equipped with one grinding station for grinding jar volumes of 25 mL, 35 mL and 50 mL. It is also possible to use adapters for 4 grinding jars of 5 mL each as well as for reaction vials.
Planetary Ball Mills
Features • Fast, efficient cryogenic grinding at -196°C • Ideal for plastics, temperature-sensitive materials and samples with volatile components • Particularly safe due to autofill system for liquid nitrogen • Highly reproducible grinding results • Programmable cooling and grinding cycles • Also suitable for dry and wet grinding Specifications
The innovative Planetary Ball Mills meet and exceed all requirements for fast and reproducible grinding down to the nano range. They are used for the most demanding tasks, from routine sample processing to colloidal grinding and mechanical alloying. The grinding parameters are easily selected and stored with one single button. All planetary mills feature programmable starting time, power failure backup with storage of remaining grinding time and a built-in fan which cools the grinding jars during operation. The comfort grinding jars are dust-tight and unusually simple and safe to handle. Features • Extreme speed, final fineness down to the nano range • Reproducible results due to energy and speed control • 1-button operation with graphics display • 10 parameter combinations can be stored • Smooth and stable operation • Automatic grinding chamber ventilation • Suitable for long-term trials and continuous use
Retsch Planetary Ball Mill PM 100 This single station ball mill pulverizes and mixes a wide range of materials and can be operated with grinding jars from 12 mL to 500 mL. It is especially safe to operate on a laboratory bench thanks to the new FFCS technology which helps to compensate vibrations.
MM 200
Application:
MM 400
MILLS & GRINDERS
Retsch Mixer Mill MM 200
CryoMill
Size reduction, mixing, homogenization, cell disruption
Feed Material:
Soft, medium-hard, hard, brittle, elastic, fibrous
Feed Size*:
< 6 mm
< 8 mm
< 8 mm
Final Fineness*:
< 10 μm
< 5 μm
< 5 μm
* Depending on feed material and instrument configuration / settings
Retsch Planetary Ball Mill PM 100 CM
Powerful and quick grinding down to nano range This ball mill offers all the performance and convenience of the classic PM 100, only the speed ratio of sun wheel to grinding jar is 1:-1 instead of 1:2. This results in a different ball movement so that the sample is not so much crushed by impact effects but more gently ground by pressure and friction. This not only leads to less abrasion but also reduces the heat build-up inside the jar.
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
48
Retsch Planetary Ball Mill PM 400
The PM 200 is equipped with two grinding stations and accepts grinding jars up to 125 mL. It is used for the pulverization and mixing of smaller sample volumes.
The robust floor model features four grinding stations and accepts jars from 12 mL to 500 mL. It can process up to 8 samples simultaneously thus generating a high sample throughput. The PM 400 is also available with 2 grinding stations and different speed ratios. The model "MA-type" was especially developed for mechanical alloying of hardbrittle materials.
MILLS & GRINDERS
Retsch Planetary Ball Mill PM 200
Automatic grinding chamber ventilation Specifications
PM 100
PM 100 CM
PM 200
PM 400
Size reduction, mixing, homogenization, colloidal grinding, mechanical alloying
Application:
Soft, medium-hard, hard, brittle, fibrous, dry and wet
Feed Material: Feed Size*:
< 10 mm
< 10 mm
< 4 mm
< 10 mm
Final Fineness*:
< 0.1 μm
< 0.1 μm
< 0.1 μm
< 0.1 μm
* Depending on feed material and instrument configuration / settings
Jaw Crushers
Rotor Mills
Knife/Cutting Mills
BB BB BB BB ZM TWISTER SK SR SR GM 51 100 200 300 200 100 200 300 200
Disc Mills
Mortar Grinders
GM SM SM SM RS DM 300 100 200 300 200 200
RM 200
Feed size* approx. (mm)
35 50
90 130 10
10
15 15 15 10-40 130
80x60
15 20
8
Final fineness* approx. (mm)
0.5 4
2
5
0.04
0,5
0.1 0.08 0.05 0.3
0.3
0.25-20
0.04 0.1
0.01
o ✓
✓ ✓
Chemicals products Coal, coke
o ✓
o ✓
o ✓
Construction materials
✓
✓
✓ ✓
Electronic scrap, circuit boards
✓ ✓
Food
✓ ✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
o
o o
Plants, hay, straw
✓
✓
Plastics, cables, rubber
✓
Secondary fuels Soils, sewage sludge Wood, bones, paper
o o o
o
o
o o
o o
o o
o
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓ ✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
o
o
✓
✓ ✓
PM PM 100 200
10
4
PM MM MM Cryo400 200 400 Mill
10
6
8
o ✓
✓ ✓
✓ ✓
✓ ✓
✓ ✓
✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
✓ ✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
o o ✓ ✓
✓
o
✓
✓
o
✓
✓
✓
o
o
o
o
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
o
o
o
✓
✓
✓
o
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
o
o
o
o
✓
✓
✓
✓
o
✓
✓
o
o
o
o
✓
✓
✓
✓
o
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
o
✓ ✓
o
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓ ✓ o
✓
o
o ✓
o o
✓
✓
✓ o
✓ o o
✓
✓
✓ o
✓
✓ o
o
o
o
o
✓
✓ ✓
✓ ✓
✓ ✓
✓ ✓
✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
✔ Suitable o Suitable to a limited extent *Depending on sample and grinding time This chart serves only for orientation purposes. The selection of the appropriate mill depends on a variety of parameters of the actual application. Please contact us to discuss the best solution.
49
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
8
0.001 0.001 0.001 0.01 0.005 0.005
o ✓
✓
o
✓
Pharmaceutical products
o
✓
✓
Minerals, ores, stones
o
o ✓
✓
Leather, textiles
o
o
Feed
Glass, ceramics
o ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ o
Ball/Mixer Mills
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Electrophoresis Systems & Transilluminators UVP Transilluminators
Chromato-Vue Viewing Cabinets from UVP provide a darkroom environment for viewing materials.
All UVP transilluminators carry a two year warranty. All UV transilluminators are equipped with a UV blocking cover, adjustable to different angles for access to the work surface. Select transilluminators can be used with UVP's BioImaging Systems as well as selected Chromato-Vue Cabinets.
The comfortable soft rubber viewport utilizes a contrast control viewing filter. This filter protects the eyes from harmful shortwave radiation and blocks the "blue haze" associated with longwave UV. Viewport has adequate space for eyeglasses. A lightweight access curtain allows for easy entry and blocks out external light. A variety of cabinets are available to choose from including mini cabinets for viewing minerals and education uses to larger cabinets for applications such as chromatography.
MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
UVP UV Viewing Cabinets
Many models available! Labnet Enduro™ Gel Systems and Power Supplies
Two Enduro models are available to meet your needs. The Model 300V can produce output to 300 V or 500 mA, while the Model 250V produces a maximum output of 250 V or 3,000 mA. Both are compact in design and require a minimal amount of valuable benchspace. Units are stackable to save space. For easy viewing and setting of parameters on the bench or shelf, the front of the power supply can be raised with the integral folding feet.
www.ereinc.com
Enduro™ Horizontal Gel Boxes
Enduro Horizontal Gel Boxes have been designed for ease of use, safety and durability. A variety of sizes are available, from a mini gel system to a large maxi gel system that can accommodate as many as 450 samples in a single run. A wide range of accessories are available to customize your system, including multichannel compatible gel combs. Available sizes from 7 x 7 cm to 20 x 20 cm.
Enduro™ Modular Vertical PAGE System Modular System
The Enduro System is based on three operational inserts and a common buffer tank. All three inserts, PAGE, electroblotting and 2D electrophoresis, have their own electrode assembly that connects into the lid of the buffer tank.
sales@ereinc.com
50
Labnet MultiGene™ OptiMax Thermal Cycler
Labnet MultiGene™ Mini Personal Thermal Cycler
The new MultiGene™ OptiMax replaces our successful and reliable MultiGene™ Gradient thermal cycler and brings new speed and advanced features to our Labnet Thermal Cycler line providing premium performance at an affordable price.
MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
Thermal Cyclers
Labnet’s MultiGene Mini is a compact and lightweight thermal cycler, but do not let its small size fool you. This cycler is packed with features typically found only on larger thermal cyclers. The OptiMax’s heated lid is fully adjustable to provide optimum pressure for use with a broad range of tubes and microplates. For optimum performance, the lid can also be programmed to hold different temperatures between 60° to 65°C and 100° to 115°C. The OptiMax lid prevents condensation and slides away and back from the user to provide full access to samples and reduce the risk of coming in contact with a hot surface.
Features . • Fast ramping - up to 5°C/second • Intuitive graphic programming • Lightweight and compact • Interchangeable blocks - 24 x 0.2 mL and 18 x 0.5 mL • Economical - half the price of a full size unit • Easy to read graphic interface • Slip gear lid won’t crush tubes • Reliable Peltier technology • Simple programming • Heated lid Specifications
MultiGene™ Mini
Block Capacity
51
24 x 0.2 mL or 18 x 0.5 mL tubes
The MultiGene™ OptiMax employs a new protocol optimization process improving on older gradient features. The OptiMax utilizes FlexTemp™ technology that effectively separates the 96 well plate into 6 – (4 x 4) temperature regions that allow you to pick the temperatures you want to test against. These regions are easily identified by the blue and black squares visible on the microplate platen, Instead of having the thermal cycler choose temperatures for you, you can choose any temperatures you want within a 24°C range. The MultiGene™ OptiMax has a heating rate of 4°C/sec and a cooling rate of 3°C/sec. We have minimized overshooting and undershooting so that your reactions only see the temperatures they are supposed to see. This also leads to faster runs time.
The OptiMax’s heated lid is fully adjustable to provide optimum pressure for use with a broad range of tubes and microplates. For optimum performance, the lid can also be programmed to hold different temperatures between 60° to 65°C and 100° to 115°C. The OptiMax lid prevents condensation and slides away and back from the user to provide full access to samples and reduce the risk of coming in contact with a hot surface.
Features . • Unique flexible programming with FlexTemp™ technology • Fast run times • PC viewer • Simple user interface • No condensation after overnight cooling at 4°C • 3 year warranty
Specifications
MultiGene™ OptiMax
Sample Capacity
1 x 96 well plate, 12 8 x 0.2 mL strip tubes, 96 x 0.2 mL tubes
Programmable Temperature Range
4°C to 99.9°C
Temperature Control
Calculated or block
Temperature Accuracy / Uniformity
±0.5°C / ±0.5°C
Heating / Cooling Method
Peltier
Gradient Temperature Range
30°C to 99°C. Temperature of 6-segment blocks can be set independently. 24°C
Temp. Control Range
4° to 99°
Maximum Temperature Difference between 6-segment Temperature Blocks
Max. Heat / Cool Rate
5°C per sec / 4°C per sec
6-segment Temperature Blocks
6 temperature blocks in 4 x 4 well format
Accuracy / Uniformity
±0.3°C / ±0.5°C at 55°C
Programmable Lid Temperature
60° to 65°C, 100° to 115°C
Heated Lid Temperature
105°C
Program Memory
200 complete programs
Max. Number of Cycles
99
Temp. Increments / Decrements
Yes
Gradient Temperature Range
30°C to 99°C
Time Increments / Decrements
Yes
Max. Number Segments
9
User Program Folders
50 sets
Max. Holding Time / Step
99 minutes 59 seconds
Password Protected Programs
Yes
Program Memory
Up to 100 programs
Communication
USB and RS232 ports
Dimensions
21.8W x 28.5D x 17.8H cm
Dimensions
24W x 42D x 25H cm
Weight
7.1 lb / 3.2 kg
Weight
9 kg
Electrical
230 V~ or 120 V~, 50/60 Hz
Electrical
240 V or 120 V, 50/60 Hz
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
3 Year Warranty!
O2 and CO2 Testing Quantek Instruments Oxygen Analyzers
The pump is electronically timed to draw in the precise amount of sample required for the analysis, and then turns itself off after the preset sampling time (5 to 10 seconds). The oxygen concentration is read on the display within 15 - 20 seconds.
Model 901 The Quantek Model 901 is a battery-operated, portable headspace oxygen analyzer used primarily for the measurement of residual oxygen in gas-flushed (CAP/MAP) food packages. This hand-held unit can be used by nontechnical personnel where you need it, in the lab or at the packaging line, or at less than 3 pounds, it can be easily transported to other locations.
Model 905 The Quantek Model 905 is a benchtop, portable oxygen analyzer used primarily for the measurement of residual oxygen in gas-flushed (CAP/MAP) food packages.
The expected oxygen sensor life is typically 5 years, unlike other analyzers with a sensor that last 1 - 2 years, reducing total cost of ownership, and analyzer downtime. The sensor is unaffected by high levels of background gases such as nitrogen or carbon dioxide. The Model 901 oxygen analyzer can also be used for applications where the oxygen level is very high (50 to 100%), without overloading the sensor. It is unaffected by trace hydrocarbons or high levels of CO2, which can poison other types of sensors.
Ideal for package testing: • Meats • Dairy products • Produce • Snack foods • Baked foods • Prepared meals • Coffee • Pet foods • Dessert foods • and many more!
Features • Economically priced • Internal pump & sample probe included • Range 0.1% - 100% • Results in 15 - 20 seconds • Rechargeable battery operation • Liquid blocking filters • Requires very little headspace (> 10 cc in a flexible package) • Adjustable pump time • Optional 5 second response sensor • Includes starter pack of foam septas, needles & filters, and international compatible 100-240 V charger
OXYGEN & CARBON DIOXIDE TESTING
Easy Sampling and Analysis The Quantek headspace oxygen analyzer sample probes are tipped with a particulate filter and luer fit syringe needle with side-port holes to prevent plugging. When the pump is activated, sample is drawn through the probe and tubing and then to the oxygen sensor.
Features • Economically priced • Internal pump & sample probe included • Range 0.1% - 100% • Results in 15 - 20 seconds • AC or battery operation • Liquid blocking filters • Rugged enclosure • Requires very little headspace (> 10 cc) • Adjustable pump time • Optional fast responding sensor for 5 second response time
Q5: Why did miners choose canaries to accompany them into mines?
TriviaZone
Q6: What are the symptoms of carbon monoxide poisoning?
For answers, turn to page 92.
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
52
OXYGEN & CARBON DIOXIDE TESTING
Quantek Instruments Oxygen and Carbon Dioxide Analyzers Research Applications • Bioreactors • Gas blending systems • Fruit storage areas • Fermentation • Biofuel experiments • Algae offgas analysis • Welding gases • Controlled atmosphere rooms • Carbon capture and storage • Incubation experiments • and many more!
Model 902D The Quantek Model 902D is a benchtop, portable oxygen analyzer used primarily for the measurement of residual oxygen and carbon dioxide in gas-flushed (CAP/MAP) food packages.
Give us a call for complete technical information Sensor The solid-state infrared CO2 sensor has no moving parts, a compact optical cell, and microprocessor-based calibration factors using a 6th order polynomial equation and 32 bit processor to linearize the full range measurement up to 100%.
The expected oxygen sensor life is typically 5 years, unlike other analyzers with a sensor that last 1 - 2 years, reducing total cost of ownership, and analyzer downtime. This O2 CO2 Analyzer contains an internal pump to draw in sample from your package and display results in 30 seconds.
Model 907 The Quantek Model 907 is a highly portable oxygen and CO2 analyzer used for the measurement of oxygen and carbon dioxide in gas-flushed (CAP/MAP) food packages and process applications (such as sampling chambers). Highly portable The Model 907 weighs only 2 lbs and comes with a nylon protective case and internal rechargeable battery pack. Ultra fast The Model 907 incorporates the latest fast response O2 and CO2 sensors, which allows results to be obtained in 5 - 7 seconds for rapid spot checks.
53
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Features • Economically priced • Internal pump & sample probe included • Range 0.1% - 100% • Results in 15 - 20 seconds • AC or battery operation • Liquid blocking filters • Rugged enclosure • Requires very little headspace (> 10 cc) • Adjustable pump time • Optional fast responding sensor for 5 second response time • Includes starter pack of foam septas, needles & filters, and international compatible 100 240 V charger / power supply
Features • 0 - 100% Carbon Dioxide • 0 - 100% Oxygen • Less than 2 lbs • 10 - 12 hour runtime on full charge • Sample results in 5 - 7 seconds • Economically priced • Two year warranty Includes • Durable nylon bag with removable shoulder carry strap • Internal rechargeable battery pack • 100 - 240 V DC, 47 - 63 Hz charger • Internal sampling pump • Sampling probe • Starter pack of accessories (200 foam septa, 2 needles, 2 particulate filters) • Starter pack of 2 moisture block filters
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Hanna ORP Tester
pH
This new micro-processor based tester provides the most advanced solution in ORP and temperature measurement. Further, the HA-98121 provides pH measurement.
Hanna pHep®4 & pHep®5
pHep®4, pHep®5 includes protective cap, electrode removal tool, 4 x 1.5 V batteries and instructions.
Features • Replenishable junction • Dual level LCD • Battery life percentage indication • Stability indicator • Floating and waterproof body HA-98120 & HA-98121 includes protective cap, electrode removal tool, 4 x 1.5 V batteries and instructions. Specifications
Specifications
pHep®4
pHep®5
Model
HA-98127
HA-98128
Range
-2.0 to 16.0 pH
-2.00 to 16.00 pH
Accuracy Calibration
±0.1 pH
Dimensions
-5.0 to 60°C, ±0.5°C accuracy
Temp. Range pH Range
Automatic at 1 or 2 points with 2 sets of memorized buffer values
HA-98121
±1000 mV, ±2 mV accuracy
ORP Range
±0.05 pH
Temp. Compensation
HA-98120
-2 to 16.00 pH, ±0.05 accuracy
n/a Factory calibrated
Calibration (ORP) Calibration (pH)
Automatic
Automatic 1 or 2 points with 2 sets of memorized buffers
n/a
6.4" x 1.6" x 1.0", 3.5 oz
Dimensions
6.4" x 1.6" x 1.0", 3.5 oz
Hanna Combo pH/EC/Temp/TDS Testers in One Unit!
Hanna Dist® 5 & Dist® 6 EC/Temp/TDS Testers Unmatched 3-in-1 tester measuring electrical conductivity, temperature and total dissolved solids in one small compact unit. Features • Floating waterproof casing • Dual level LCD displays • Replaceable graphite probe Dist® 5 & Dist® 6 includes protective cap, electrode removal tool, 4 x 1.5 V batteries and instructions.
Unmatched 4-in-1 tester measuring pH, electrical conductivity, temperature and total dissolved solids in one small compact unit. Features • Floating waterproof casing • Dual level LCD displays • Replaceable pH probe HA-98129 & HA-98130 includes protective cap, electrode removal tool, 4 x 1.5 V batteries and instructions. Specifications
HA-98129
HA-98130 0.00 to 14.00 pH
Specifications
Dist® 5
Dist® 6
pH Range
Model
HA-98311
HA-98312
EC Range
0 to 3999 µS/cm
0.00 to 20.00 mS/cm
EC Range
0.00 to 20.00 mS/cm
0 to 3999 µS/cm
TDS Range
0 to 2000 ppm
0.00 to 10.00 ppt
TDS Range
0.00 to 10.00 ppt
0 to 2000 ppm
Temp. Range
Temp. Range
0.0 to 60°C, ±0.5°C accuracy
Calibration
Automatic, 1 point
Temp. Compensation
Automatic, with ß adjustable from 0.0 to 2.4%/°C 6.4" x 1.6" x 1.0", 3.5 oz
Dimensions
pH
These testers use the exclusive replaceable pull-out cartridge pH electrode. Its exposed temperature sensor provides fast response time and its proximity to the pH electrode guarantees much more accurate temperature compensated readings.
0.0 to 60°C, ±0.5°C accuracy
Calibration (EC/TDS) Calibration (pH) Temp. Compensation
Automatic, 1 point Automatic, at 1 or 2 points with 2 sets of memorized buffers pH: automatic, EC/TDS: automatic, with ß adjustable from 0.0 to 2.4%/°C
Dimensions
6.4" x 1.6" x 1.0", 3.5 oz
We offer buffer solutions, conductivity solutions, and other calibration solutions for all Hanna handheld meters. HA-7061L Electrode Cleaning Solution, 500 mL Bottle
HA-7031L 1413 µS/cm Conductivity Calibration Solution, 500 mL Bottle
HA-70300L Electrode Storage Solution, 500 mL Bottle
HA-7032L 1382 ppm TDS Calibration Solution, 500 mL Bottle
HA-7004L pH 4.01 Buffer Solution, 500 mL Bottle
HA-7021L 240 mV Test Solution, 500 mL Bottle
HA-7007L pH 7.01 Buffer Solution, 500 mL Bottle
HA-7091L Reducing Solution, 500 mL Bottle
HA-7010L pH 10.01 Buffer Solution, 500 mL Bottle
HA-7092L Oxidizing Solution, 500 mL Bottle
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
54
Hanna Research Grade Combination Meters
pH
Features • 240 x 320 dot matrix color display • Logging and graphing capabilities • USB and RS232 for computer compatibility • Auto recognition of probe type (2 or 4 ring, and nominal cell constant) • Stages 1, 2 and 3 USP mode • 3 salinity scales: Practical Salinity, Natural Sea Water, Percent • Linear and natural water temperature compensation • Exclusive HANNA Calibration Check™
Specifications
HA-4521
HA-4522
-2.000 to 20.000 pH 0.1 pH; 0.01 pH; 0.001 pH ±0.1 pH; ±0.01 pH; ±0.002 pH
mV Range Resolution Accuracy
±2000 mV 0.1 mV ±0.2 mV
ISE Range Resolution Accuracy Conductivity Range
Resolution Accuracy Resistivity Range
Resolution Accuracy TDS Range Resolution Accuracy Salinity Range Practical Salinity Percent Resolution Accuracy
1 x 10-7 to 9.99 x 1010 concentration 1; 0.1; 0.01 concentration ±0.5% (monovalent ions); ±1%
Calibration pH ISE Conductivity Salinity
N/A N/A N/A
0.000 to 9.999 μS/cm; 10.00 to 99.99 μS/cm; 100.0 to 999.9 μS/cm; 1.000 to 9.999 mS/cm; 10.00 to 99.99 mS/cm; 100.0 to 999.9 mS/cm; 1000 mS/cm 0.001 μS/cm; 0.01 μS/cm; 0.1 μS/cm; 0.001 mS/cm; 0.01 mS/cm; 0.1 mS/cm; 1 mS/cm ±1% of reading (±0.01 μS/cm)
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
1.00 to 99.99 Ohm•cm; 100.0 to 999.9 Ohm•cm; 1.000 to 9.999 kOhm•cm; 10.00 to 99.99 kOhm•cm; 100.0 to 999.9 kOhm•cm; 1.00 to 9.99 MOhm•cm; 10.0 to 100.0 MOhm•cm 0.01 Ohm•cm; 0.1 Ohm•cm; 0.001 kOhm•cm; 0.01 kOhm•cm; 0.1 kOhm•cm; 0.01 MOhm•cm; 0.1 MOhm•cm ±2% of reading (±1 Ohm•cm)
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A N/A N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
0.000 to 9.999 ppm; 10.00 to 99.99 ppm; 100.0 to 999.9 ppm; 1.000 to 9.999 ppt; 10.00 to 99.99 ppt; 100.0 to 400.0 ppt 0.001 ppm; 0.01 ppm; 0.1 ppm; 0.001 ppt; 0.01 ppt; 0.1 ppt ±1% of reading (±0.01 ppm)
N/A N/A N/A
N/A N/A N/A
0.00 to 42.00; Natural seawater: 0.00 to 80.00 ppt; 0.0 to 400.0% 0.01 for practical salinity/natural sea water; 0.1% for percent scale ±1% of reading
N/A N/A N/A N/A
N/A N/A N/A N/A
-20.0 to 120°C; -4.0 to 248.0°F; 253.15 to 393.15K 0.1°C; 0.1°F; 0.1K ±0.2°C; ±0.4°F; ±0.2K Automatic, up to 5 points with 8 memorized values (pH 1.68, 3.00, 4.01, 6.86, 7.01, 9.18, 10.01, 12.45) + 5 custom buffers Automatic, up to 5 points with 5 standard N/A Automatic, up to 5 points with 5 standard + 5 custom values + 5 custom values auto standard recognition, user standard single Auto standard recognition, user N/A point / multi-point standard single point / multi-point Percent scale—1 point (with HA-7037 buffer) N/A
Relative mV Offset Range Input Channel(s)
N/A N/A N/A
±2000 mV 1 pH/mV/ISE + 1 EC
1 pH/mV + 1 EC
Calibration Check Temperature Compensation
HA-4221
1 x 10-6 to 9.99 x 1010 concentration 1; 0.1; 0.01; 0.001 concentration ±0.5% (monovalent ions); ±1%
Temperature Range Resolution Accuracy
pH: Automatic or manual from -20.0 to 120.0°C (-4.0 to 248.0°F) EC: Disabled, linear and non-linear
2 pH/mV/ISE pH electrode and buffer condition pH: Automatic or manual from -20.0 to 120.0°C (-4.0 to 248.0°F)
Log-On-Demand
100 lots with 10,000 record / lot
PC Connection
Opto-isolated USB and RS232
Power
12 V DC adapter (included)
Dimensions / Weight
55
HA-4222
pH Range Resolution Accuracy
160 x 231 x 94 mm (6.3" x 9.1" x 3.7"), 1.2 kg (2.64 lbs)
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
1 pH/mV
N/A
Hanna Laboratory pH Meters with Backlit, Graphic LCD HA-3220 • HA-3221 • HA-3222
pH
Specifications
Features • Single (HA-3220 & HA-3221) or dual (HA-3222) input channels • Backlit, graphic LCD • Exclusive Calibration Check™, electrode diagnostics • Prompts and messages on the graphic LCD • Stability, interval and log-on-demand logging • 5 point calibration with 7 standard and 5 custom buffers • Relative mV measurements • Up to 400 samples memory capacity • Auto HOLD to freeze readings on the display • GLP to view last calibration data for pH, Rel mV or ISE • User selectable "Outside Calibration Range" warning • User-selectable "Calibration Timeout" to remind when a new calibration is necesary • PC compatible via USB
HA-3220
Range pH mV ISE
HA-3221 -2.0 to 20.0; -2.00 to 20.00; -2.000 to 20.000 pH ±2000 mV From 1.00 x 10-3 to 1.00 x 105 ppm
N/A
Temperature
0.1; 0.01; 0.001 pH 0.1 mV 3 digits 0.01; 0.1; 1; 10 concentration
N/A 0.1°C (0.1°F)
Accuracy pH mV ISE Temperature
±0.01; ±0.002 pH ±0.2 mV ±0.5% of reading (monovalent ions), ±1% of reading (divalent ions) ±0.2°C (±0.4°F) (excluding probe error)
N/A
Calibration pH
Up to 5 point calibration, 7 standard buffers available (1.68, 4.01, 6.86, 7.01, 9.18, 10.01, 12.45) + 5 Custom Buffers Up to 2 point calibration, Up to 5 point calibration, 6 6 standard solutions Standard solutions (in units (0.1, 1, 10, 100, 1000, 10000 ppm) selected) From 80 to 110%
N/A
ISE
Slope
Manual or automatic from -20.0 to 120.0°C (-4.0 to 248.0°F)
Temperature Compensation (pH) Logging
From 1.00 x 10-7 to 9.99 x 1010 concentration (choice of units)
-20.0 to 120.0°C (-4.0 to 248.0°F)
Resolution pH mV ISE Temperature
Probes
HA-3222
HA-1131B pH with BNC connector and HA-7662-T stainless steel temperature probe (included) Log-on-demand 200 samples
Lot Logging
Log-on-demand 300 samples
Log-on-demand 400 samples
5, 10, 30 sec 1, 2, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60, 120, 180 min (max 600 samples)
PC Connectivit
Opto-isolated USB (with HA-92000 software)
Input Impedance
1012 Ohms
Power Supply
12 V DC
Environment
0 - 50°C (32 to 122°F) Max. RH 55% non-condensing
Dimensions / Weight
235 x 207 x 110 mm (9.2" x 8.14" x 4.33"), 1.8 kg (4.1 lbs)
Hanna pH Meters with Large LCD HA-2210 • HA-2211 Features • New benchtop design • Extra wide LCD (6.25" x 1.5") • Automatic calibration • 5 standard buffers • Simultaneous display of pH and temperature • Automatic temperature compensation • Extended mV range (HA-2211)
Specifications Range pH mV Temperature Resolution pH mV Temperature Accuracy (@20°C) pH mV Temperature pH Calibration Temperature Compensation pH Electrode Temperature Probe Input Impedance Power Supply Environment Dimensions / Weight
www.ereinc.com
HA-2210
HA-2211 -2.00 to 16.00 pH
N/A
± 399.9 mV ; ± 2000 mV -20 to 120.0°C 0.01 pH
N/A
0.1 mV; 1 mV 0.1°C ± 0.01 pH
N/A
± 0.2 mV (± 399.9 mV); ± 1 mV (± 2000 mV) ± 0.4°C (0.0 to 100.0°C); ± 1°C (outside) (excluding probe error) Automatic, 1 or 2 points with 5 automatically recognized buffers (pH 4.01, 6.86, 7.01, 9.18, 10.01) Automatic (with HA-7669/2W probe) or manual from -9.9 to 120°C HA-1131B, glass-body, single junction, refillable, BNC connector, 1 m cable (included) HA-7662 with 1 m (3.3') cable (included) 1012 Ohms 12 V DC adapter (included) 0 to 50°C (32 to 122°F); RH max 95% 235 x 222 x 109 mm (9.2" x 8.7" x 4.3"), 1.3 kg (2.9 lbs)
sales@ereinc.com
56
Hanna pH & ORP Electrodes
Accuracy at its best!
pH
Includes electrode with 1 m (3.3') coaxial cable with BNC connection (some models are available with a screw cap or BNC + PIN connection)
HA-1043B
HA-1053B
HA-1131B
HA-1144B
HA-1230B
HA-3131B
HA-FC200
HA-FC210
HA-1332B
Part Number
Recommended Use
Description
Range
Length & Dia.
Reference Cell
HA-1043B
Hydrocarbon, Paints, Solvents, Sea Water, Strong Acid & Base, High Conductivity Samples, Tris Buffer
Refillable, Combination pH Electrode With Double Junction
pH: 0 to 14 T: 0 to 100°C (32 to 212°F)
120 x 12 mm
Double, Ag/AgCl
HA-1053B
Fats & Creams, Soil Samples, Potable Water, Semi Solid Products Low Conductivity Solutions, Emulsions
Refillable, Combination pH Electrode With Conical Bulb
pH: 0 to 12 T: -5 to 100°C (23 to 212°F)
120 x 12 mm
Single, Ag/AgCl
HA-1131B
Laboratory General Purpose, Beer
Refillable, Combination pH Electrode
pH: 0 to 13 T: -5 to 100°C (23 to 212°F)
120 x 12 mm
Single, Ag/AgCl
HA-1144B
Tris Buffer
Refillable, Combination pH Electrode With Calomel References
pH: 0 to 14 T: 0 to 60°C (32 to 140°F)
120 x 12 mm
Single, Hg/Hg2Cl2
HA-1230B
Field Applications
Combination pH Electrode
pH: 0 to 13 T: 0 to 80°C (32 to 176°F)
120 x 12 mm
Double, Ag/AgCl
HA-3131B
Laboratory General Use, ORP Titrations
Refillable Combination ORP Electrode
ORP T: -5 to 100°C (23 to 212°F)
150 x 12 mm
Single, Ag/AgCl
HA-FC200
Milk, Yogurt, Dairy Products, Semi Solid Foods
pH Electrode
pH: 0 to 12 T: 0 to 50°C (32 to 122°F)
75 x 10 mm
Single, Ag/AgCl
HA-FC210
Milk, Yogurt, Creams
pH Electrode
pH: 0 to 12 0 to 50°C
120 x 12 mm
Double, Ag/AgCl
(32 To 122°F)
57
HA-3230B
HA-1332B
Chemicals, Field Applications, Quality Control
pH Electrode
pH: 0 to 13 T: 0 to 80°C (32 to 176°F)
120 x 12 mm
Double, Ag/AgCl
HA-3230B
Municipal Water, Quality Control
ORP Electrode
ORP: ±2000 mV T: 0 to 80°C (32 to 176°F)
120 x 12 mm
Single, Ag/AgCl
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Hanna Ion Selective Electrodes HANNA’s Ion Selective Electrodes can be grouped into three general categories based upon construction: • Solid state electrodes • Liquid membrane electrodes • Gas sensors Includes BNC Connection, 12 mm O.D., 120 mm length & 1 m coxial cable
The new generation! pH
HA-4101
HA-4004
HA-4104
HA-4007
HA-4107
HA-4010
HA-4110
Part Number
Ion Selective
Application
Type
Range
pH & Temp.
HA-4101
Ammonia
Determination Of Ammonium, Ammonia In Wine, Beer, Water, Waste Water & Soil
Gas-Sensing; Combination (Delrin)
1M To 1X 10-6M 17000 to 0.02 ppm
>11 0 to 40°C
HA-4004
Calcium
Determination Of Free Calcium In Beverages, Water & Seawater
Polymer Membrane; Half-Cell (PVC)
1M To 3X 10-6M 40080 to 0.12 ppm
4 to 10 0 to 40°C
HA-4104
Calcium
Determination Of Free Calcium In Beverages, Water & Seawater
Polymer Membrane; Combination (PEI/PVC)
1M to 3X 10-6M 40080 to 0.12 ppm
4 to 10 0 to 40°C
HA-4007
Chloride
Determination Of Free Chloride Ions In Emulsified Food Products, Beverages, Plants, Soils & As An Indicator For Titration
Solid-State; Half-Cell (Epoxy)
1M to 5X 10-5M 35000 to 1.8 ppm
2 to 11 0 to 80°C
HA-4107
Chloride
Determination Of Free Chloride Ions In Emulsified Food Products, Beverages, Plants, Soils & As An Indicator For Titration
Solid-State; Combination (PEI)
1M to 5X 10-5M 35000 to 1.8 ppm
2 to 11 0 to 80°C
HA-4010
Fluoride
Determination Of Free Fluoride In Potable Water, Soft Drinks, Wine, Plants, Emulsified Food Products, Plating & Pickling Acids
Solid-State; Half-Cell (Epoxy)
1M to 1X 10-6M Sat. to 0.02 ppm
5 to 8 0 to 80°C
HA-4110
Fluoride
Determination Of Free Fluoride In Potable Water, Soft Drinks, Wine, Plants, Emulsified Food Products, Plating & Pickling Acids
Solid-State; Combination (PEI/Epoxy)
1M to 1X 10-6M Sat. to 0.02 ppm
5 to 8 0 to 80°C
HA-5315
Reference
To Complete The Electrical Circuit & To Provide A Stable Reference Voltage For ISE Half-Cells
PEI
0 to 80°C
HA-5315
Other ion selective electrodes available upon request: Bromide • Cadmium • Carbon Dioxide • Cupric • Cyanide • Iodide • Lead / Sulfate • Nitrate • Potassium • Silver / Sulfide • Sodium
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
58
pH
pH Technical Calibration Solutions
ISE Standards ISE Standards are required for direct and incremental measurement techniques and are available with a Certificate of Analysis.
Features • (±0.01 pH) for each point of the pH scale • pH Value @ 25°C • Available in sachets, liters and gallons upon request
HA-4001-01 0.1 M Ammonia Std., 500 mL HA-5001 1.00 pH, 500 mL
HA-5007-01 7.01 pH, 1 L
HA-4001-02 100 ppm Ammonia Std. (As N), 500 mL
HA-5016 1.68 pH, 500 mL
HA-5007-G 7.01 pH, Green, 500 mL
HA-4001-03 1000 ppm Ammonia Std. (As N), 500 mL
HA-5002 2.00 pH, 500 mL
HA-5074 7.41 pH, 500 mL
HA-4004-01 0.1 M Calcium Std., 500 mL
HA-5003 3.00 pH, 1 L
HA-5008 8.00 pH, 500 mL
HA-4007-01 0.1 M Chloride Std., 500 mL
HA-5037 3.79 pH, 500 mL
HA-5009 9.00 pH, 500 mL
HA-4007-02 100 ppm Chloride Std., 500 mL
HA-5004 4.01 pH, 500 mL
HA-5091 9.18 pH, 500 mL
HA-4007-03 1000 ppm Chloride Std., 500 mL
HA-5004-01 4.01 pH, 1 L
HA-5010 10.01 pH, 500 mL
HA-4010-01 0.1 M Fluoride Std., 500 mL
HA-5004-R 4.01 pH, Red, 500 mL
HA-5010-01 10.01 pH, 1 L
HA-4010-02 100 ppm Fluoride Std., 500 mL
HA-5046 4.63 pH, 500 mL
HA-5010-V 10.01 pH, Violet, 500 mL
HA-4010-03 1000 ppm Fluoride Std., 500 mL
HA-5005 5.00 pH, 500 mL
HA-5011 11.00 pH, 500 mL
HA-4010-10 10 ppm Fluoride Std. Premixed W/ TISAB II, 500 mL
HA-5006 6.00 pH, 500 mL
HA-5012 12.00 pH, 500 mL
HA-4010-11 1 ppm Fluoride Std. Premixed W/ TISAB II, 500 mL
HA-5068 6.86 pH, 500 mL
HA-5124 12.45 pH, 500 mL
HA-4010-12 2 ppm Fluoride Std. Premixed W/ TISAB II, 500 mL
HA-5007 7.01 pH, 500 mL
HA-5013 13.00 pH, 500 mL
HA-4010-30 (4) 1, (4) 10 ppm Fluoride Std. W/ (4) TISAB II, 500 mL Other ISE solutions available upon request.
pH Millesimal Calibration Solutions with ±0.002 pH Accuracy Features • HA-60XX has been prepared to meet the increasing need for assured accuracy in pH measurements. Each bottle of the series HA-60XX is provided with a certificate of analysis, prepared by comparison with NIST standards.
59
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
• pH Value @ 25°C • Also available in 1 Liter bottles add -01 to the end of the part number HA-6001 1.000 pH, 500 mL
HA-6007 7.010 pH, 500 mL
HA-6016 1.679 pH, 500 mL
HA-6074 7.413 pH, 500 mL
HA-6002 2.000 pH, 500 mL
HA-6008 8.000 pH, 500 mL
HA-6003 3.000 pH, 500 mL
HA-6009 9.000 pH, 500 mL
HA-6037 3.788 pH, 500 mL
HA-6091 9.177 pH, 500 mL
HA-6004 4.010 pH, 500 mL
HA-6010 10.010 pH, 500 mL
HA-6046 4.630 pH, 500 mL
HA-6011 11.000 pH, 500 mL
HA-6005 5.000 pH, 500 mL
HA-6012 12.000 pH, 500 mL
HA-6006 6.000 pH, 500 mL
HA-6124 12.450 pH, 500 mL
HA-6068 6.862 pH, 500 mL
HA-6013 13.000 pH, 500 mL
Fax : (514) 326 8961
pH, Conductivity, TDS, ORP, Turbidity, Storage, Cleaning & Sample Preperation Solutions
pH
Features • Excellent quality • Complete range of solutions and sizes • Certificates of analysis available upon request • FDA approved bottles available upon request • Temperature reference chart on each solution
Numerous Solutions to Choose From ... Which One is Best for You? pH 4.01 Buffer Solutions HA-70004P 4.01, 20 mL Sachet, 25/Box Continuation Of Conductivity Standards
HA-7004L 4.01, 500 mL HA-7004/1L 4.01, 1 Liter HA-7004/1G 4.01, 1 US Gallon
HA-7031L 1413 µS/cm (µmho/cm), 500 mL
Cleaning Solutions For General Use
HA-70030P 12880 µS/cm (µmho/cm), 20 mL Sachet 25/Box
HA-7061L General Purpose, 500 mL
HA-7030L 12880 µS/cm (µmho/cm), 500 mL
HA-7073L Proteins, 500 mL HA-7074L Inorganic Substances, 500 mL
pH 7.01 Buffer Solutions
TDS Standards
HA-70007P 7.01, 20 mL Sachet, 25/Box
HA-70080P 800 ppm (mg/L), 20 mL Sachet, 25/Box
HA-7007L 7.01, 500 mL
HA-70032P 1382 ppm (mg/L), 20 mL Sachet, 25/Box
HA-7007/1L 7.01, 1 Liter
HA-7032L 1382 ppm (mg/L), 500 mL
HA-7007/1G 7.01, 1 US Gallon
HA-70442P 1500 ppm (mg/L), 20 mL Sachet, 25/Box
HA-7077L Oil & Fats, 500 mL HA-8061L General Purpose, FDA, 500 mL HA-8073L Proteins, FDA, 500 mL HA-8077L Oil & Fats, FDA, 500 mL
HA-70442L 1500 ppm (mg/L), 500 mL
Specific Application Cleaning Solutions
HA-70038P 6.44 ppt (g/L), 20 mL Sachet, 25/Box
HA-70620L Cleaning & Disinfection Solution For Skin Residuals (Cosmetic Industry), 500 mL
HA-7010L 10.01, 500 mL
Turbidity Standard Solutions
HA-70621L Cleaning Solution For Skin Grease & Sebum (Cosmetic Industry), 500 mL
HA-7010/1L 10.01, 1 Liter
HA-93102-0 AMCO-AEPA-1 Calibration Solution At 0 NTU, 30 mL
HA-7010/1G 10.01, 1 US Gallon
HA-93102-20 AMCO-AEPA-1 Calibration Solution At 20 NTU, 30 mL
pH 10.01 Buffer Solutions HA-70010P 10.01, 20 mL Sachet, 25/Box
HA-70630L Acid Cleaning Solution For Meat Grease & Fats (Food Industry), 500 mL
HA-93703-0 AMCO-AEPA-1 Calibration Solution At 0 FTU, 30 mL
HA-70631L Alkaline Cleaning Solution For Meat Grease & Fats (Food Industry), 500 mL
HA-93703-05 AMCO-AEPA-1 Calibration Solution At 500 FTU, 30 mL
HA-70640L Cleaning Solution For Milk Deposits (Food Industry), 500 mL
HA-93703-10 AMCO-AEPA-1 Calibration Solution At 10 FTU, 30 mL
HA-70641L Cleaning & Disinfection Solution For Dairy Products (Food Industry), 500 mL
ORP Test & Pretreatment Solutions HA-7020L ORP Test Solution At 200/275 mV (@ 20°C), 500 mL HA-7021L ORP Test Solution At 240 mV (@ 20°C), 500 mL HA-7022L ORP Test Solution At 470 mV (@ 20°C), 500 mL
Electrode Storage Solutions
HA-70642L Cleaning Solution For Cheese Deposits (Food Industry), 500 mL
HA-7091L Reducing Pretreatment Solution, 500 mL
HA-70300L Electrode Storage Solution, 500 mL
HA-70663L Cleaning Solution For Soil Deposits (Agriculture), 500 mL
HA-7092L Oxidizing Pretreatment Solution, 500 mL
HA-80300L Electrode Storage Solution, FDA, 500 mL
HA-70664L Cleaning Solution For Humus Deposits (Agriculture), 500 mL
Conductivity Standards
Sample Preparation Solutions
HA-70033P 84 S/cm (µmho/cm), 20 mL Sachet, 25/Box
HA-7051M Soil Sample Preparation Solution, 250 mL
HA-70671L Cleaning & Disinfection Solution For Algae, Fungi & Bacteria (Industrial Processes), 500 mL
HA-7033L 84 S/cm (µmho/cm), 500 mL
HA-7051L Soil Sample Preparation Solution, 500 mL
HA-70680L Cleaning Solution For Cellulose Deposits, 500 mL
HA-70031P 1413 µS/cm (µmho/cm), 20 mL Sachet, 25/Box
HA-70960 Preparation Solution for Solid Or Semi Solid Samples, 30 mL
HA-70681L Cleaning Solution For Ink Stains, 500 mL
www.ereinc.com
HA-70670L Cleaning Solution For Salt Deposits (Industrial Processes), 500 mL
sales@ereinc.com
60
Plant Physiology PLANT PHYSIOLOGY
CID Bio-Science Digital Plant Canopy Imager CI-110 and CI-120 The CI-110’s digital platform enables you to simultaneously capture wide-angle plant canopy images and estimate Leaf Area Index (LAI) and Photosynthetically Active Radiation (PAR) levels from a single canopy scan. No more taking multiple scans above and below the canopy… leave your tree-climbing equipment at home! One measurement provides a full complement of data, unlike systems which require the user take multiple measurements and attach various masking devices to obtain meaningful data. • Instant Data: Captures Canopy image and calculates Leaf Area Index (LAI) and Photosynthetic Active Radiation (PAR) levels • Onsite Evaluation: The CI-110 digital process needs only one scan beneath the canopy, allowing on-site evaluation under any daylight conditions • User-Defined: User-selected number of zenith divisions (rings) and azimuthal divisions allows investigation of any canopy sectors desired • Lightweight: 0.5 kg instrument is handheld and simple to use • Lightweight and fast, the CI-110 revolutionizes data collection for forest management, crop science and environmental research!
CID Bio-Science Miniature Leaf Spectrometer CI-710 Numerous analyses are possible with the CI710, including color measurement, pigment concentration estimation, and physical properties: • Chlorophyll concentration • Leaf surface characterization, such as reflectance properties of leaf hairs • Proportional light absorbance by leaves to calculate electron transport rates in chlorophyll fluorescence • Concentration of plant pigments, including anthocyanins and carotenoids • Truly portable, field-ready unit with built-in leaf probe
Specifications
CI-110
CI-120
Single Measurement for LAI, PAR and Sunflecks
X
X
Ideal for Environmental, Forestry, and Crop Science Applications
X
X
Viewing Angle
180°
150°
User Selected Azimuthal and Zenith Divisions
X
X
On-site Gap Fraction Analysis
X
X
Calculation of Diffuse Radiation Transmission Coefficients
X
X
Calculation of Mean Foliage Inclination
X
X
Calculation of Canopy Extinction Coefficients
X
X
On Image Plotting of Sun Paths
X
X
Non-Destructive LAI and PAR Measurement
X
X
Integrated Self-Leveling CCD
X
Integrated Array Style Wand to Measure PAR / Sunflecks
X
Ideal for Measuring Low-Lying Crops and Grasses
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
X
X
• Wide-range spectrum (400 nm - 950 nm) covering PAR and NIR • High-resolution (~1.5 nm) • Real-time display of measured spectrum • Lightweight - 290 g • Measures: Transmittance, absorbance and reflectance Introducing SpectraSnap! Part of the power of the CI-710 Miniature Leaf Spectrometer is its ability to scan and record across a wide spectrum, from 400 - 1000 nm. Many researchers wish to analyze multiple, discrete peaks or integrate across wavelength bands. These functions are readily accomplished with the SpectraSnap! software that ships with the CI-710. Other users of the CI-710 have expressed a need to rapidly estimate vegetation properties using published and accepted indices. These indices include: estimates of greenness like the widely-used Normalized Difference Vegetation Index (NDVI); plant stress, such as the Plant Senescence Reflectance Index (PRSI); pigment concentrations, including carotenoids and anthocyaninst; and leaf water status estimated by the Water Band Index (WBI).
61
CI-120
CI-110
Why SpectraSnap? SpectraSnap! simplifies data analysis by offering several real time computations in an intuitive and easy-to-operate system. Researchers can choose from a convenient selection of popular vegetation indices (NDVI, PRI, CRI, ARI, etc) or simply add their own algorithms. These indices can be easily and simultaneously monitored and recorded. In essence, SpectraSnap! gives the CI-710 user the power of many single-measurement instruments in one package.
Fax : (514) 326 8961
CID Bio-Science Laser Leaf Area Meter CI-202 Includes • Laser scanner with built-in control unit • Scan board • Internal batteries • Battery charger • Communication software • One additional transparent film • Operation manual • Hard shell carrying case
PLANT PHYSIOLOGY
The CI-202 collects length, width, perimeter, and area measurements directly using a combination of a sweeping laser beam and an optical motion sensor. After activating the device by pressing the <start> key, a low energy laser beam sweeps across the laser window 500 times per second at a rate of 150 m/s. As the user moves the CI-202 control unit down the pallet, an optical sensor records the motion along the specially textured aluminum rail. The onboard processing unit collects the data from each laser sweep and uses the optical sensor data to correctly accumulate the area and perimeter measurements. Specifications
CI-202
Measuring Thickness
15 mm maximum
Measuring Width
150 mm maximum
Measuring Length
3 m maximum
Resolution
0.01 mm²
Accuracy
±1% for samples >10 cm²
Interface
USB 2.0
Scanner
675 nm Laser Diode
Memory Size
8,000 measurements
Display
16 characters × 2 lines LCD
Scanning Speed
200 mm/second
Battery
7.2 volt rechargeable NiMH
Battery Capacity
Over 250 scans per charge
Operating Temperature
0 - 50°C
CID Bio-Science Laser Leaf Area Meter CI-203 To measure leaf area, simply sweep the leaf through the instrument, and the CI-203 instantly scans and calculates the leaf area, width, length, perimeter, shape factor and aspect ratio. The CI-203 is flexible as well as fast: use in the field to measure living leaves on plants one-byone, or add the conveyor attachment to perform high-throughput measurements of whole plant leaf area. The CI-203 has virtually unlimited data storage, and displays the leaf image on its LCD screen. You can easily download data sets into a spreadsheet for analysis via the USB 2.0.
www.ereinc.com
Includes • Laser leaf area meter main unit • Internal battery • Battery charger • USB cable • Communication software • Operating manual • Hard-shell instrument carrying case
Portable, lightweight devices!
Specifications
CI-203
Measuring Thickness
15 mm maximum
Measuring Width
150 mm maximum
Measuring Length
3 m maximum
Resolution
0.01 mm²
Accuracy
±1% for samples > 10 cm²
Interface
USB serial interface
Measuring Units
cm² (area), cm (length, width, and perimeter)
Memory Size
4 GB SD card; virtually unlimited measurements
Display
Transflective Graphic display
Scanning Speed
200 mm/second
Battery
7.2 volt rechargeable NiMH
Battery Capacity
250 scans on single charge
Operating Temperature
0 - 50°C
Dimensions
35.5L × 4.5W × 5H cm
Weight
750 g
sales@ereinc.com
62
PLANT PHYSIOLOGY
CID Bio-Science Handheld Photosynthesis System CI-340 The CI-340 Handheld Photosynthesis System is a much improved version of the first lightweight, hand-held photosynthesis system introduced by CID in 1997. The latest version, the CI-340, features a new design concept and compact solid-state structure. The entire system: the display, key pad, computer, data memory, CO2 / H2O gas analyzer, flow control system and battery are contained in a single, hand-held chassis. Everything required to measure photosynthesis, transpiration, stomatal conductance, PAR and internal CO2 is conveniently included in one easy to operate instrument. Because the chamber is connected to the CO2 / H2O gas analyzer, there is virtually no delay when measuring CO2 / H2O in the chamber. These features make the CI-340 not only the smallest, but the quickest Handheld Photosynthesis System available for field or laboratory applications.
Lightweight Complete system in one handheld package that weighs only 1.5 kg.
Control Optional modules enable you to control CO2, H2O, temperature, light intensity and measure chlorophyll florescence and photosynthesis simultaneously.
Flexiblity Nine custom leaf chambers and a soil respiration chamber enable a multitude of measurement possibilities.
The CI-340 can also control temperature and light intensity with the optional temperature and light control modules. Furthermore, a chlorophyll fluorescence module can be attached to the CI-340 to simultaneously measure photosynthesis and chlorophyll fluorescence.
Temperature Control Module CI-510CS Type
Thermoelectric cooler
Range
-25 - +25°C from ambient temperature
Cooling Head Dimensions
55 × 43 × 14 mm
Dimensions
64 × 100 × 160 mm
Adjustable H2O and CO2 Control Module CI-301AD CO2 Supply
CO2 cartridge
CO2 Range
0 - 2000 ppm optional
H2O Supply
Water vapor generator
H2O Range
0 - 100% RH
Dimensions
64 × 100 × 160 mm
Chlorophyll Fluorescence Module CI-510CF
63
Modulated Light Intensity
0.25 uE at 12 mm
Flash Light Intensity
3000 uE at 12 mm
Modulation Frequency
8 - 80 Hz
Fiber Optic Probe
Bifurcated light guide
Dimensions
64 × 100 × 160 mm
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Soil Respiration Chamber CI-301SR Because soil respiration is the major pathway of carbon transfer from soil to atmosphere, understanding soil respiration is crucial for the study of carbon balance in terrestrial ecosystems. The CI-340 Handheld Photosynthesis System coupled with the CI301SR soil respiration chamber enables researchers to collect soil surface CO2 efflux data. The amount of soil respiration that occurs in an ecosystem is controlled by several factors: soil temperature, soil moisture, root nitrogen concentrations, soil texture, substrate quantity and quality, among which soil temperature and moisture dominate. The CI-301SR soil respiration chamber comes equipped with internal fans for proper air mixing and its small geometry aids in rendering more accurate CO2 flux measurements that are less affected by excess humidity. The CI-310SR is light (180 g), practical and versatile. Its rugged stainless steel frame can be used on uneven terrain, and in small spaces between rocks, vegetation or tree roots.
Fax : (514) 326 8961
CID Bio-Science Portable Ethylene Gas Analyzer CI-900 Engineering and design of the instrument provides: High C2H4 sensitivity down to 1 ppb CO2 and 1-MCP sensing capability (optional) Compact and portable form factor (2.43 kg) Real-time, continuous monitoring Internal data logging and storage (4 GB SD card) • User adjustable sampling rate • Transflective display enables easy viewing in direct sunlight • Rechargeable Li-Ion battery provides 8 hours of uninterrupted field use
Features • Lightweight: The CI-900 weighs just 2.43 kg • Portable: Performs non-destructive in vivo measurements in the field • Precise: The CI-900 sets the standard for portable measurements of ethylene in the field.
The CI-900 Portable Ethylene Analyzer provides accurate real-time measurement of ethylene gas concentrations, in a compact package suitable for field and laboratory use. At the core of the instrument, the CI-900 uses an electrochemical sensor technology that offers extraordinary sensitivity to ethylene, with accurate readings as low as 10 ppbv in air. Ethylene production is known to increase in response to plant stress and during ripening and maturity (ethylene is a plant hormone produced by trees, plants, fruits, and vegetables). Until recently, sensitive ethylene measurements were available only through elaborate and expensive gas sampling and gas chromatography analysis. The intent of the CI-900’s portable design is to aid the research community in developing real-world ethylene management applications for the benefit of growers, processors, and consumers. Why CI-900? Ethylene production rates have traditionally required elaborate and expensive sample collection and gas chromatography procedures. The CI-900 eliminates the need to fill syringes and travel back to the lab or outsource samples. The challenge of measuring ethylene production of in-vivo fruits, vegetables and flowers has resulted in a limited understanding of the phenological correlation of ethylene production over the life-cycle of most plants. The CI-900 Portable Ethylene Analyzer provides the accuracy, real-time response, and portability necessary to provide ethylene production measurements in the field or in a laboratory environment. The CI-900 chamber allows a single fruit (apple, pear, avocado, etc.) to be left intact on the plant/vine while performing measurements in continuous mode. Therefore, taking ethylene samples with the CI-900 is non-detrimental to plant growth or fruit ripening. In addition to ethylene sensing the CI-900 has been designed to carry two additional sensors; one for measuring 1-Methylcyclopropene (1-MCP), and the second Carbon Dioxide (CO2). Measurements of 1-MCP can help the research community understand and develop protocols to delay ripening, maturation and the sprouting of plants. Measurements of CO2 gas exchange offer researchers vital information regarding respiration and photosynthesis.
Specifications
C2H4 and 1-MCP Sensor
Sensor Type
Electrochemical
Air Sampling Rate
0.4 liters/min
Sampling Rate
Closed-loop < 3 min / Open loop monitoring @ 5 sec interval
Nominal Range
0 - 10 ppm
Resolution
1 ppb
Accuracy
±5% adjusted for temperature and humidity
Display
Sunlight visible transflective graphic LCD
Operating Environment
5°C - 45°C (10 - 90% humidity non-condensing)
Battery Capacity
4 Hours - rechargeable LiIon (5000 mAh)
Dimensions
183.5 x 111 x 120 mm
Weight
2.43 kg
Enclosure
Anodized aluminum
Warm-up Time
< 5 minutes
Specifications
CO2 Sensor
Sensor Type
Low power Non-Dispersive Infrared Gas Analyzer
Chopping Frequency
1 Hz
Source Life
5000 hours
Measuring Range
0 to 2000 ppm (Standard) 0 to 3000 ppm (Optional)
Resolution
0.1 ppm
Repeatability
±0.1 ppm (short term)
Accuracy
< ±2% up to 3000 ppm
Sample Cell
100 x 10.2 mm (3.94" L x 0.40" Dia)
Warm-up Time
< 3 minutes
CI-900 Package
CI-900FK Package
The base model includes ethylene (C2H4) gas sensor and operations manual.
The Field Kit includes ethylene (C2H4) gas sensor, GPS chip, 1 liter chamber, pump and flexible tubing assembly, syringe and sampling bags, hydrocarbon scrubber, hard-shell carrying case and operation manual.
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
PLANT PHYSIOLOGY
• • • • •
64
CID Bio-Science In-Situ Root Imager CI-600
PLANT PHYSIOLOGY
• Provides a high-resolution underground color image of living roots in the soil • Enables observation of root system architecture and soil profile over time • Portable and field ready for fast, accurate root and soil images
The study of fine root dynamics (production, turnover, and lifespan) and root system architecture (RSA) is at the forefront in the fields of ecology and agronomy / plant breeding. Future gains in plant productivity will be driven by selection for traits that optimize acquisition of resources such as water and mineral nutrients under limiting conditions. The CI-600 leads the fine root-imaging field by offering researchers the ability to acquire high-resolution images of roots over time. The CI-600 allows researchers the ability to scan multiple tubes in the field with one handheld unit.
Features • High-resolution image - up to 88 million pixels • Quick image capture - 5 to 15 seconds per scan • Linear scanning with no distortion • Each scan generates a near 360-degree image (21.59 × 19.56 cm) at up to 1200 dpi resolution • Very portable and quick operation • Enables observation of root system architecture and behavior during the entire growth season • USB interface for laptop computer image storage How to use The CI-600 is designed for long-term root studies on living plants in the field. Install clear acrylic tubes within the study area prior to the growing season. When the plant begins to build a network of roots, simply slide the CI-600 scanner head within the tube at the desired depth and download images to your computer via USB connection. The images collected by the CI-600 can be imported and analyzed with RootSnap! root image analysis software.
Includes • Root imaging unit • Three 105 cm clear tubes with end caps (custom length tubes available) • Calibration tube • Scanning software and operating manual • Hard shell instrument case • Optional hand-held computer • Optional RootSnap! root image analysis software
Specifications
CI-600
Scanner Resolution
Maximum 1200 dpi - up to 88 million pixels
Image Size
21.6W × 19.6L cm 8.5"W × 7.7"L
Scan Speed
5 to 15 seconds - depending on scanning resolutions
Interface
USB port
Power Supply
Computer USB port
Scan Head Dimensions
34.3 cm long × 6.4 cm diameter
Standard Clear Tube Dimensions
6.4 cm inner diameter × 105 cm length (2.5 inches × 3.4 feet); custom lengths available upon request
Scanner Unit Weight
750 g
CID Bio-Science RootSnap! Automated Root Image Analysis CI-690 RootSnap! removes hours of tedious tracing by offering a revolutionary user interface that employs a multi-touch screen which enables users to more quickly and easily trace roots using a finger. The software has tracing enhancements like the "Snap-to-Root" function which automatically moves root tracing points to the center of the root. Additionally, RootSnap! has integrated image enhancement features which enables users to optimize each scanned image for more accurate processing. Monitor root growth, dynamics, taxonomy, morphology, and behavior over time with RootSnap! Simplify root mapping using the multi-touch screen and our proprietary "Snap-to-Root" functionality. The superior RootSnap! user interface is intuitive and efficient. It uses familiar commands to manipulate images and files and stores information in common file formats (XML) and supports exporting data to Excel.
65
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Features • Intuitive user interface • Multi-touch screen functionality • Measures root length, area, volume, & diameter • Integrated image enhancement • Automated "Snap-to-Root" functionality • Comprehensive data analysis package • Time series analysis • Files stored in common formats
Benefits • Easy to use • Map roots in a fraction of the time! • Trace roots with a finger • Easily manipulate images (colors, sharpness, contrast, etc.) • Designed to work with Excel • Monitor root growth, disease, and behavior over time
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Refractometers Hanna Sugar Refractometers Analyze: fruits, energy drinks, puddings, soy milk, juices, jam, marmalade, honey, soups, jelly, tofu, condiments.
Specifications
HA-96801
HA-96802
Range Sugar Content Temperature
0 - 85% Brix
0 - 85% (by weight)
Resolution Sugar Content Temperature
±0.1% Brix
Accuracy (@ 20°C) Sugar Content
HA-96803
HA-96804
0 - 85% (by weight)
0 - 85% (by weight)
±0.1
±0.1
±0.2%
±0.2%
REFREACTOMETERS
Sugar Refractometers meet the requirements of the food industry. The HA-96801 Sucrose, HA-96802 Fructose, HA-96803 Glucose and HA96804 Invert Sugar Digital Refractometers are rugged, portable and water resistant for measurements in the lab or field. Each instrument offers a specific analysis to determine accurate sugar concentration. The actual measurement of refractive index is simple and quick and provides the operator a standard accepted method for sugar content analysis. Samples are measured after a simple user calibration with deionized or distilled water. Within seconds these instruments measure the refractive index of the sample and convert it to % by weight concentration units (or % Brix for HA-96801). These digital refractometers eliminate the uncertainity associated with mechanical refractometers and are easily portable for measurements in the field.
0 - 80°C (32 to 176°F)
±0.1 ±0.1°C (0.1°F)
±0.2% Brix
±0.2%
Temperature
±0.3°C (0.5°F)
Temperature Compensation
Automatic between 10 and 40°C (50 to 104°F)
Measurement Time
Approximately 1.5 seconds
Minimum Sample Volume
100 μL (to cover prism totally)
Light Source
Yellow LED
Sample Cell
Stainless Steel ring and flint glass prism
Auto-Off
After 3 a of non-use
Enclosure Rating
IP 65
Battery Type / Battery Life
9 V / Approx. 5000 readings
Dimensions / Weight
192 x 102 x 67 mm (7.6" x 4" x 2.6"), 420 g
Hanna Sodium Chloride Refractometer
Specifications
HA-96821
Analyze: salad dressings, cheeses, pickles, canned foods, jarred foods, condiments, energy drinks, milk, juices, soups, brines, whey.
Range g/100 g & g/100 mL Specific Gravity °Baumé Temperature
0 - 28 & 0 - 34 1.000 - 1.216 0 - 26 0 - 80°C (32 - 176°F)
Resolution g/100 g & g/100 mL Specific Gravity °Baumé Temperature
0.1 & 0.1 0.001 0.1 ±0.1°C (0.1°F)
Accuracy (@ 20°C) g/100 g & g/100 mL Specific Gravity °Baumé Temperature
±0.2 & ±0.2 ±0.002 ±0.2 ±0.3°C (0.5°F)
HA-96821 Digital Sodium Chloride Refractometer meets the requirements of the food industry. This optical instrument employs the measurement of the refractive index to determine sodium chloride concentration in aqueous solutions used in food preparation. It is not intended for sea water salinity measurements. The measurement of refractive index is simple and quick and provides the user an accepted method for NaCl analysis. Samples are measured after a simple user calibration with deionized or distilled water. Within seconds the instrument measures the refractive index of the solution. The digital refractometer eliminates the uncertainty associated with mechanical refractometers and is easily portable for measurements where you need them.
www.ereinc.com
Temperature Compensation
Automatic between 10 and 40°C (50 to 104°F)
Measurement Time
Approximately 1.5 seconds
Minimum Sample Volume
100 μL (to cover prism totally)
Light Source
Yellow LED
Sample Cell
Stainless Steel ring and flint glass prism
Enclosure Rating
IP 65
Battery Type / Battery Life
9 V / Approx. 5000 readings
Dimensions / Weight
192 x 102 x 67 mm (7.6" x 4" x 2.6"), 420 g
sales@ereinc.com
66
Hanna Seawater Refractometer
REFRACTOMETERS
HA-96822 Digital Seawater Refractometer is a rugged portable, water resistant device that utilizes the measurement of the refractive index to determine the salinity of natural and artificial seawater, ocean water or brackish intermediates. Within seconds, the refractive index and temperature are measured and converted into one of 3 popular measurement units: Practical Salinity Units (PSU), Salinity In Parts Per Thousand (ppt), or Specific Gravity (S.G. (20/20)). All conversion algorithms are based upon respected scientific publications using the physical properties of seawater (not sodium chloride). Specifications
HA-96822
Range PSU ppt Specific Gravity (20/20) Temperature
0 - 50 0 - 150 1.000 - 1.114 0 - 80°C (32 to 176°F)
Resolution PSU ppt Specific Gravity (20/20) Temperature
1 1 0.001 ±0.1°C (0.1°F)
Accuracy (@ 20°C) PSU ppt Specific Gravity (20/20) Temperature
±2 ±2 ±0.002 ±0.3°C (0.5°F)
Temperature Compensation
Automatic between 10 and 40°C (50 to 104°F)
Measurement Time
Approximately 1.5 seconds
Minimum Sample Volume
100 μL (to cover prism totally)
Light Source
Yellow LED
Sample Cell
Stainless steel ring and flint glass prism
Auto-Off
After 3 minutes of non-use
Enclosure Rating
IP 65
Battery Type / Battery Life
9 V / Approx. 5000 readings
Dimensions / Weight
192 x 102 x 67 mm (7.6" x 4" x 2.6"), 420 g
Extech Portable Refractometers Measure the concentration of sugar, salt, lubricants, antifreeze, cutting fluids & more. Available with or without Automatic Temperature Compensation. Features • Easy to operate, provides accurate and repeatable measurements on easy to read scales • Requires only 2 or 3 drops of solution • The prism and lens with a simple focus adjustment provides repeatable results • Complete with case, calibration screwdriver, and calibration solution
Part Number
Type
Ranges
Resolution
Accuracy
EX-RF16
Sucrose
0 - 10% Brix
0.1
±0.1%
EX-RF11
Sucrose (ATC)
0 - 10% (10 to 30°C)
0.1
±0.1%
EX-RF18
Lubricants / Cutting Fluids
0 - 18% Brix
0.2
±0.2%
EX-RF12
Lubricants / Cutting Fluids (ATC)
0 - 18% Brix (10 to 30°C)
0.2
±0.2%
EX-RF10
Sucrose
0 - 32% Brix
0.2
±0.2%
EX-RF15
Sucrose (ATC)
0 - 32% Brix (10 to 30°C)
0.2
±0.2%
EX-RF20
Salt (ATC)
0 - 100 ppt (10 to 30°C)
0.001
±0.1%
2°F
±2%
2°F
±2%
1.000 - 1.070 Refractive Index EX-RF40
Coolant (ATC)
-60 - 32°F Propylene Glycol Freeze Point -60 - 25°F Ethylene Glycol Freeze Point 1.15 - 1.30 Specific Gravity
0.01
of Battery Acid EX-RF41
Coolant (ATC)
-50 - 0°C Propylene
1°C
±2%
1°C
±2%
Glycol Freeze Point 50 - 0°C Ethylene Glycol Freeze Point 1.15 - 1.30 Specific
0.01
Gravity of Battery Acid EX-RF30
67
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Triple Range
0 - 41% Brix
0.2
±0.2%
General Service
42 - 71% Brix
0.2
±0.2%
72 - 90% Brix
0.2
±0.2%
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Bellingham + Stanley OPTi Digital Range
Features • Ergonomic design • Wide application scope • Single and Duo scale models • Zero calibrate with water • Shallow prism dish • Small hand print
Specifications
OPTI Digital
Resolution (°Brix / Refractive Index)*
0.1 / 0.0001
Accuracy (°Brix / Refractive Index)*
±0.2 / ±0.0003
Automatic Temperature Compensation*
ICUMSA / App. Specific / None
Ambient Temperature Range
Single Scale Models
5 – 40°C
Measurement Time
2 seconds
Battery Life
10,000 readings
Battery Type
3 V 2 x AAA (LR03)
REFREACTOMETERS
Bellingham + Stanley designed OPTi digital hand held refractometers are manufactured in the UK as highly reliable premium quality instruments suitable for use in the harshest of environments across a wide application scope. OPTi refractometers are constructed using the latest manufacturing techniques including stainless steel injection molding to construct the easy clean prism dish, ultrasonic welding to bond the housings and a rubberized switch membrane to further protect against moisture ingress and excess wear. The OPTi refractometer may be used to control the dissolved solids or blend ratios of numerous products from fresh fruit to industrial chemicals.
Code
Range
38-02
0 - 54 % Sugar (°Brix)
38-20
1.33 - 1.42 RI
38-22
0 - 30 % Starch
38-23
0 - 40 % Urea
38-28
0 - 28 % Salinity (NaCl)
Also available in Dual Scale Models!
* Call for model specific details.
Bellingham + Stanley Eclipse Professional Range Manufactured in the UK using only the highest quality optical components and the most modern manufacturing practices, the Eclipse refractometer is the ultimate optical hand held refractometer on the market today. A comprehensive choice of scale types offers versatility across a wide application scope from testing fruit ripeness in the field to monitoring industrial fluids in harsh machine shop environments. Eclipse refractometers have a number of unique features not available on many other brands of refractometer. Code
Food, Beverage, Sugar & General Models
Range
Scale Division
45-01
Sugar % (°Brix)
0 - 15
0.1
45-02
Sugar % (°Brix)
0 - 30
0.2
45-07
Sugar % (°Brix)
0 - 32
0.2
45-03
Sugar % (°Brix)
0 - 50
0.5
45-08
Sugar % (°Brix)
28 - 65
0.2
45-05
Sugar % (°Brix)
45 - 80
0.2
45-06
Sugar % (°Brix)
72 - 95
0.2
45-22
Wine - °Zeiss (ABV)
10 - 135
1
45-27
Water-in-Honey (%)
10 - 30
0.2
45-81
Low Volume (Nectar <1-micro-litre)
0 - 50
0.5
45-82
Low Volume (Nectar <1-micro-litre)
45 - 80
0.2
Special features make measurement easy and reliable • All metal construction • Rubber handgrip for insulation • Robust ergonomics for easy handling • Anti-roll supports • High precision, clear scale • Sample "dribble" feed • Zero adjust with lock • Push on prism flap • Ideal for hot & cold samples • Serial numbered • Certificate of conformity
Industrial Models 45-26
Starch (%)
0 - 30
0.2
45-41
Refractive Index
1.330 - 1.420
0.001
45-44
Antifreeze
- °C Protection - Battery acid SG
45-45
Antifreeze
- °F Protection - Battery acid SG
45-46
Antifreeze
- % Ethylene Glycol - % Propylene Glycol
0 to -40 1.1 - 1.35 30 to -40 1.1 - 1.35 0-6 0 - 60
5 0.05 5 0.05 2.5 2.5
45-65
Salinity (% NaCl)
0 - 28
0.2
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
68
Bellingham + Stanley Abbe 60 Direct Reading Refractometer More stringent requirements of quality control and, in some cases, legislation, mean that greater accuracy is being demanded of refractometers. The Abbe 60 Direct Reading models, available in two measuring ranges, have been designed to meet these requirements.
REFRACTOMETERS
The latest designs incorporate an externally mounted LED light source for sample illumination. A wavelength compensation device is used to 'achromatise' to the mean sodium wavelength (589.3 nm). Refractive Index can be read directly from a scale divided to 0.001 allowing for estimation to ±0.0001. Temperature control can be achieved by circulation of water; prism temperature is displayed in digital form. Direct reading models are particularly suitable for the measurement of sugar solutions and sugar content of food and drink products. They can also be used to determine the refractive index of pure liquids, solutions and formulated products including; flavourings, fragrances, oils and fats, solvents, plastics, resins, adhesives and many other industrial chemicals. Instruments come complete with external power supply, standardisation plate, contact liquid, and instructions for use. Scale and scale division Code
Model
Sugar % (Brix)* Refractive Index
10-99
60/DR
0 - 95 x 0.5
1.30 - 1.74 x 0.001
10-03
60/95
0 - 50 x 0.2 50 - 95 x 0.1
1.30 - 1.535 x 0.001
Features • Integral LED light source • Direct reading of RI & Brix • Extremely robust
Abbe 60/95
Bellingham + Stanley High Accuracy Range of Abbe 60 Refractometers The high accuracy models are designed for use with monochromatic light sources such as the sodium and spectral range available from Bellingham+Stanley. A PC program for conversion of scale readings to refractive index (RI) or Brix (Sugar%) and spectral line identification is available through free download. With good temperature control and use of the micrometer Vernier Scale, an average accuracy of ±0.00004 RI can be achieved across the specified measuring range. Temperature can be controlled by use of a water bath and circulator; prism temperature can be read from the digital display on the instrument. High Accuracy Abbe 60 Refractometers are ideal for use in academic, research and development, quality control and other industrial laboratories where the highest accuracy and precision is often sought. The Abbe 60/ED Refractometer conforms to the requirements of ASTM D1218 and is used widely throughout the petroleum industry. The Abbe 60/LR is uniquely ideal for measuring liquid anaesthetic. Instruments come complete with external power supply, digital thermometer, traceable standardisation plate, contact liquid, sodium D line calibration tables, and instructions for use.
Code
Model
Refractive Index Range
10-04
60/ED
1.30 - 1.74 approximately
10-06
60/LR
1.20 - 1.70 approximately
Features • High accuracy • Dispersion measurement • Conforms to ASTM D1218, 1747 & 5006 • Free software from internet
Abbe 60/LR
69
General Specifications
Abbe 60
Operating Temperature
5 - 75°C
Temperature Resolution
0.1°C
Temperature Accuracy
±0.2 °C (15 to 30 °C) ±0.5 °C (rest of range)
Temperature Stability
±0.1
Storage / Ambient Temperature
5 - 40 °C
Power Source
90 - 250 v~, 50 / 60 Hz. Supplied with instrument
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Bellingham + Stanley RFM700 Refractometers RFM700 series refractometers are robust, low cost, fully automatic instruments that are ideally suited to the food, sugar and beverage industries but can also be used in many other non-food applications where temperature control is not required. The instruments are configured to operate in the °Brix scale with results temperature-compensated to 20°C in accordance with ICUMSA. Additionally, two standard user scales may be installed from an extensive online library, or product specific custom scales and temperature compensation may be created using PC software available free of charge from the Bellingham+Stanley website prior to downloading to the instrument.
Other software features include special AG temperature compensation that facilitates a SPAN calibration when using AG calibration fluids and a time delay before reading, thus ensuring reliable results every time.
RFM745
Specifications
RFM712
RFM732
RFM742
Order Code
29-12
29-32
29-42
29-45
Scales: °Brix User Defined (RI equivalent)
0 - 50 2 (1.33 - 1.42)
0 - 100 2 (1.33 - 1.54)
0 - 100 2 (1.33-1.54)
0 - 100 No
Resolution (°Brix/RI equivalent)
0.1 (0.0001)
0.1 (0.0001)
0.01 (0.00001)
0.01 (NO)
Accuracy (°Brix/RI equivalent)
±0.1 (±0.0001)
±0.1 (±0.0001)
±0.04 (±0.00005)
±0.04 (NO)
Other Scales
User Defined – RI, Oechsle, Probable Alcohol (A.P.), Báume, Babo, Sodium Chloride, HFCS, Butyro, FSII2 etc. or custom scales, all loaded by PC software.
42% HFCS 55% HFCS 90% HFCS
REFREACTOMETERS
Inherent to the robust design is a sapphire prism mounted in an easy-clean stainless steel dish and an outer casing that is sealed and shaped to withstand sample spillage and moisture ingress. This, together with the external power supply and bright LED display, makes the RFM700 ideal for use in busy laboratories or harsh factory environments. The instrument can also be connected to a printer or laboratory PC, with results being output in standard or CSV formats.
5 - 40°C
Temperature Range
ICUMSA, AG, None or User Defined
Temperature Compensation
ICUMSA, AG, None
None – Temperature Compensation (ATC)
Temperature Control Temperature Sensor Accuracy
±0.05°C
Temperature Stability Checks
Delay time (programmable in seconds)
Interface
RS232
Bellingham + Stanley RFM300+ Refractometers RFM300+ series refractometers are considered by many leading companies as the ultimate instrument for installation in demanding factory environments, as well as for use as a primary quality control tool. A shallow, easy-to-clean prism dish houses a single sapphire prism optical system protected by a sample presser that may also be used to instigate a measurement without the need to press the read button.
Specifications
RFM330+
RFM340+
Order Code
22-30
22-40
Scales: Refractive Index Sugar (°Brix) User Defined
1.32 - 1.58 0 - 100 100
1.32 - 1.58 0 - 100 100
Resolution: Refractive Index Sugar (°Brix)
0.0001 0.1
0.00001 0.01
Accuracy: Refractive Index
±0.0001
±0.00002 (1.32 - 1.36 RI) ±0.00004 (1.36 - 1.58 RI) ±0.01 (0 - 20 °Brix) ±0.03 (20 - 100 °Brix)
Sugar (°Brix)
±0.1
User Scale Library on-board
20+ preprogrammed scales including HFCS (3), wine (5), sugar (4), urine SG (3), Urea, sucrose SG (3), FSSI, NaCl, Butyro etc. Plus customer programmable scales by PC software.
Presser Type
Polyacetal
Reading Time
Minimum 4 seconds
Measuring Temperature Range
10°C below ambient to 70°C
Temperature Sensor Accuracy
±0.03°C
Sample Temperature Stability
±0.05°C
Temperature Compensation: Sucrose (Brix°) AG Fluids User Defined Temperature Stability Checks
5 - 70 °C 5 - 40 °C Simple coefficient (units/°C) or polynomial function None / delay time / repeatability / Smart (independently selectable by Method)
Ambient Humidity Range
A large sampling area on the prism surface allows measurement of not only homogenous fluids like juices, sodas, sauces and edible oils, but also difficult to read samples like fruit pulps and industrial resins. The instrument is available in two formats, the most popular being the 2decimal place RFM340+ refractometer, which, following improvements to the thermodynamic control system, now has an increased measurement performance between 0 - 20°Brix. This reduces potential measurement error in the critical range covering finished products like the aforementioned juices and sodas. By improving the performance at the low end of the scale, users may now trim syrup dilution to the absolute minimum without the risk of breaching manufacturing specifications. SG scales for sucrose are also common to the series. These scales may be used to express the relative density of pure sucrose solutions and, when used in conjunction with a product offset from within the Methods system, can express finished beverages as an equivalent SG. By doing so, contract packers of beverage products may now use a refractometer in situations where density °Brix or SG is dictated as the method of analysis, whilst retaining all the measurement advantages held by a refractometer.
< 90% RH
Interfaces
1 Parallel (printer), 2 x Serial (RS232)
Prism Seal
Silicon / Resin
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
70
Bellingham + Stanley RFM900 Refractometers
REFRACTOMETERS
The new RFM900 series of refractometers combine the latest opto-electronic principles with durability and ease of use. RFM900 refractometers feature RFID (Radio Frequency Identification) that allows users to identify themselves by simply swiping a tag across the top of the instrument to enable measurement and, in certain cases, access to the configuration menu. A new low-profile sample dish and non-contact presser makes sample application and cleaning much easier. Readings can be taken automatically on the replacement of the presser, and up to 700 stored results can be easily viewed in tabular form on the instrument display. Peltier temperature control and intelligent temperature management ensures readings are only taken when the sample and refractometer temperatures are both stable. The instruments conform to a number of industry measurement standards and offer operational features that allow use in an environment controlled by FDA regulation 21 CFR Part 11.
RFM970
The use of a Kalrez® gasket and sapphire prism facilitates placement in the harshest measurement environments including those in the pharmaceutical, petrochemical, aroma, flavour, fragrance and other high RI sectors. Flowcell versions are also available.
Easy clean prism! Specifications
RFM960
RFM970
RFM990-Flow
Order Code
22-60
22-70
22-90
Scales: Refractive Index Sugar (°Brix) User Defined
1.30 - 1.70 0 - 100 100
1.30 - 1.70 0 - 100 100
1.30 - 1.70 0 - 100 100
Resolution: Refractive Index Sugar (°Brix)
0.0001 0.1
0.00001 0.01
0.00001 0.01
Accuracy: Refractive Index Sugar (°Brix)
±0.0001 ±0.1
±0.00002 ±0.02
±0.00002 ±0.02
Presser Type
Polyacetal
Polyacetal
Flowcell
Temperature Compensation: Sucrose (Brix°) AG Fluids User Defined
5 - 80 °C 5 - 40 °C Simple coefficient (units/°C) or polynomial function
Temperature Control
Peltier
Temperature Stability Checks
None / delay time / repeatability / Smart (independently selectable by Method)
Measuring Temperature Range
0°C or 10°C below ambient whichever is the greater to 80°C
Temperature Sensor Accuracy
±0.03°C
Sample Temperature Stability
±0.02°C
Prism Seal
Kalrez®
Interfaces
1 Parallel (printer), 2 x Serial (RS232)
Kalrez® is a registered trademark of DuPont.
71
RFM900 series prism profile
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
RFID (Radio Frequency Identification) allows users to identify themselves by simply swiping a tag across the top of the instrument.
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Polarimeters
Bellingham + Stanley ADP410 Polarimeter The ADP410 is a dual scale, fully automatic polarimeter designed for use in many applications that require measurement of optical rotation. The instrument is housed in a rugged chemical-resistant case, making it suitable for use in factory environments as well as in the laboratory. Standard, jacketed and flow type tubes may be used, possibly requiring the use of specially suited slotted lids. Operation is very simple by way of four graphically identified push buttons including scale and compensation selection, zero calibration and the display of
Bellingham + Stanley ADP440+ Polarimeter The ADP440+ is a single wavelength, high accuracy polarimeter suitable for use in many applications, and is especially suited for use in pharmaceutical laboratories where compliance with Pharmacopoeia is required. New optics featuring a 'no maintenance' yellow LED and interference filter together with a photodiode detector allows reading of samples of up to 3.0 OD. The instrument has both angular and sugar scales (ISS) and can be programmed with user scales as well as industry standard methods for displaying concentration and specific rotation directly. When used in the sugar industry, the ADP440+ may also form the central hub of a purity system, providing the measurement of a Saccharimeter. In the 'purity mode' the instrument will calculate and display 'sugar purity' with Brix values being input automatically from an RFM refractometer or via the simple keypad. For rapid measurements, funnel and flow-through cells are available and require the use of specially suited slotted lids.
www.ereinc.com
REFREACTOMETERS
ADP410
ADP440+
optical density and temperature. Results are shown on a bright LED display and may be printed via an RS232 interface. Temperature compensation can be achieved from a single sensor, which can measure either the temperature within the sample chamber or, when placed in the centre-filling arm of the measurement tube, the temperature of the actual sample. The sample reading value and optical density are alternately displayed by repeatedly pressing the READ key. The instrument can be checked and calibrated using quartz control plates by accessing the span facility in the setup menu. If a sample is too dark, the instrument will display an error message.
Data handling is in accordance with GLP providing a record of measurement date, time, batch and operator numbers. A calibration record is also available to be displayed or printed. Data handling may also be configured in accordance with the technical requirements of FDA regulation – 21CFR Part 11 with users being identified and cleared by swiping an RFID tag across the instrument surface or by traditional keypad PIN entry.
Specifications
Angular (°A)
ISS (°Z)
Range
-90 to +90
-225 to +225
Resolution
0.01
0.01
Reproducibility
0.01
0.02
Accuracy
±0.02
Order Code
±0.05 37-10
Specifications
Angular (°A)
Range
-355 to +355 selectable
-225 to +225
Resolution
0.01/0.001
0.01/0.001
Reproducibility
0.002
0.005
Accuracy
±0.01
Interfaces
ISS (°Z)
±0.03 2 x RS232, parallel printer port
Code
Description
37-40
ADP440+ digital polarimeter supplied with one centre filling tube (200 mm), pack of three RFID tags, instruction manual and certificate of conformity.
Operation is very simple by way of four push buttons including scale and compensation selection, zero calibration and the displaying of optical density and temperature.
Common Specifications for Bellingham + Stanley Polarimeters Sample Illumination
Light Emitting Diode (100,000 hrs). Interference Filter 589 nm (except ADS480: 850 nm)
Beam Diameter
4 mm
Optical Path Length
10 to 200 mm
Optical Density Range
0.0 to 3.0 OD (except ADS480)
Temperature
Range: 5 - 40°C Compensation: sugar / quartz / none (ADP440+: additional user defined)
Reading Type
Continuous measurement and display
Reading Time (seconds)
4 (ADP410) 20 (ADS) 4-30 (ADP440+: selectable by Method)
Instrument Housing
Polyurethane foam with aluminum base
Power
Instrument: 24 V DC, ±5%, < 2A Power Supply Unit: 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz (supplied with instrument)
Humidity Range
< 90% RH (non condensing)
sales@ereinc.com
72
REFRACTOMETERS
Bellingham + Stanley Saccharimeters A Saccharimeter is a polarimeter that has been configured to display the optical rotation in the International Sugar Scale (ISS – °Z) for operation in the sugar processing industry as defined by the International Commission for Uniform Methods of Sugar Analysis (ICUMSA). Two single wavelength Saccharimeters are available from Bellingham + Stanley, differentiated only by the frequency of the low maintenance LED light source used as part of the analysis. Latest specification optoelectronics allows measurement of samples with low transmittance even at sodium wavelength; however, for applications where the use of lead acetate is prohibited, the near infrared ADS480 Saccharimeter and Celite® filtrate offers supreme performance. Commonly, operation is made easy by way of four graphically presented push button keys and the continuous reading mode that updates the bright LED display, gives the user total confidence in the instrument’s performance. A single temperature sensor provides the measurement for sugar compensation, whilst quartz compensation facilitates accurate verification and calibration using a Quartz Control Plate.
Specifications
ADS420
Range
ADS480 –225 to +225 °Z
Resolution
0.01 °Z
Reproducibility
0.02 °Z
Accuracy
±0.03 °Z
Interfaces
0.03 °Z ±0.06 °Z 1 x RS232
ADS420 ADS480
Saccharimeter Package
37-20
37-80
Standard Saccharimeter, 200 mm centre filling glass sample tube and standard lid
37-21
37-81
Flow-100 Saccharimeter, 100 mm water jacketed funnel flow tube and slotted lid
37-22
37-82
Flow-200 Saccharimeter, 200 mm water jacketed funnel flow tube and slotted lid
55-31
PC software is included with all Saccharimeter packages, providing simultaneous measurement of Brix by refractometer to calculate PURITY. A robust touch sensitive LCD screen is available as an optional extra for use with any PC1. A number of different flow packages are available making the ADS Saccharimeter ideal for use in any busy Tare House or refinery laboratory.
Touch sensitive LCD VDU for purity system
Polarimeter tubes, accessories, and parts also available.
InfoZone
Quick Sugar Facts • Brazil produces the most sugar of any country in the world, followed by India. • Sugar was a rare luxury in Europe until the 18th century, before which the main sweetener in use was honey. • Cats lack a gene responsible for tasting sweetness. They're the only mammals known to be unable to taste it.
73
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Sieves & Sieve Shakers
Mesh Certified Test Sieves (MCTS) 3", 8" Brass Frame & Stainless Steel Mesh
Also available in: 12", 18", 100 mm, 200 mm, 300 mm & 450 mm diameter frame Stainless steel frames Both Certified & Mid-Point Seives are also available in half-height frame depth Other mesh sizes are available, along with receiving pans & lids Part Number 3"
Part Number 8"
Opening
N/A
CSC-008BAW106.0
106.0 mm or 4.24"
N/A
CSC-008BAW100.0
100.0 mm or 4"
N/A
CSC-008BAW90.0
90.0 mm or 3 1/2"
N/A
CSC-008BAW75.0
75.0 mm or 3"
N/A
CSC-008BAW63.0
63.0 mm or 2 1/2"
CSC-003BAW37.5
CSC-008BAW37.5
37.5 mm or 1 1/2"
CSC-003BAW31.5
CSC-008BAW31.5
31.5 mm or 1 1/4"
CSC-003BAW26.5
CSC-008BAW26.5
26.5 mm or 1.06"
CSC-003BAW25.0
CSC-008BAW25.0
25.0 mm or 1"
CSC-003BAW22.4
CSC-008BAW22.4
22.4 mm or 7/8"
CSC-003BAW19.0
CSC-008BAW19.0
19.0 mm or 3/4"
CSC-003BAW16.0
CSC-008BAW16.0
16.0 mm or 5/8"
CSC-003BAW13.2
CSC-008BAW13.2
13.2 mm or 0.530"
CSC-003BAW12.5
CSC-008BAW12.5
12.5 mm or 1/2"
CSC-003BAW11.2
CSC-008BAW11.2
11.2 mm or 7/16"
CSC-003BAW9.50
CSC-008BAW9.50
9.5 mm or 3/8"
CSC-003BAW8.00
CSC-008BAW8.00
8.0 mm or 5/16"
CSC-003BAW6.70
CSC-008BAW6.70
6.7 mm or 0.265"
CSC-003BAW6.30
CSC-008BAW6.30
6.3 mm or 1/4"
CSC-003BAW5.60
CSC-008BAW5.60
5.6 mm or 3 1/2"
CSC-003BAW4.75
CSC-008BAW4.75
4.75 mm or No.4
CSC-003BAW4.00
CSC-008BAW4.00
4.0 mm or No.5
CSC-003BAW3.35
CSC-008BAW3.35
3.35 mm or No.6
CSC-003BAW2.80
CSC-008BAW2.80
2.8 mm or No.7
CSC-003BAW2.36
CSC-008BAW2.36
2.36 mm or No.8
CSC-003BAW2.00
CSC-008BAW2.00
2.0 mm or No.10
CSC-003BAW1.70
CSC-008BAW1.70
1.7 mm or No.12
CSC-003BAW1.40
CSC-008BAW1.40
1.4 mm or No.14
CSC-003BAW1.18
CSC-008BAW1.18
1.18 mm or No.16
CSC-003BAW1.00
CSC-008BAW1.00
1.0 mm or No.18
CSC-003BAW.850
CSC-008BAW.850
850 microns or No.20
CSC-003BAW.710
CSC-008BAW.710
710 microns or No.25
CSC-003BAW.600
CSC-008BAW.600
600 microns or No.30
CSC-003BAW.500
CSC-008BAW.500
500 microns or No.35
CSC-003BAW.425
CSC-008BAW.425
425 microns or No.40
CSC-003BAW.355
CSC-008BAW.355
355 microns or No.45
CSC-003BAW.300
CSC-008BAW.300
300 microns or No.50
CSC-003BAW.250
CSC-008BAW.250
250 microns or No.60
CSC-003BAW.212
CSC-008BAW.212
212 microns or No.70
CSC-003BAW.180
CSC-008BAW.180
180 microns or No.80
CSC-003BAW.150
CSC-008BAW.150
150 microns or No.100
CSC-003BAW.125
CSC-008BAW.125
125 microns or No.120
CSC-003BAW.106
CSC-008BAW.106
106 microns or No.140
CSC-003BAW.090
CSC-008BAW.090
90 microns or No.170
CSC-003BAW.075
CSC-008BAW.075
75 microns or No.200
CSC-003BAW.063
CSC-008BAW.063
63 microns or No.230
Working Sieves do not require special inspection but need to conform to the basic standards of ASTM E-11. The Working Sieves are available in brass frames with brass or stainless steel mesh. We also supply stainless steel frames with stainless steel mesh. Working Sieves are available with 8" and 12" diameter frames. The frames are full height and one half height depths. These sieves are constructed using ASTM standard wire cloth (mesh) and are supplied with a Certificate of Conformance. The mesh has not been individually inspected. Each sieve has a serial number which is related to a lot number. Working Sieves are used in a diverse range of industries that include construction, mining, food, soil testing and pharmaceuticals. They can be checked against master stacks, master samples or calibration spheres (beads) to test for wear or mesh damage.
CSC-003BAW.053
CSC-008BAW.053
53 microns or No.270
Calibration samples also available.
www.ereinc.com
Many different options to choose from! Also available:
SIEVES & SIEVE SHAKERS
The Mesh Certified Test Sieves include a serial number that ties down the traceability to each sieve. One of the special benefits of the sieve construction is a fillet. The fillet covers the solder connection between the mesh to the frame. This keeps particles from being caught in the crevices and makes cleaning easier. Supplied with Certificate of Compliance. Inspection Certificate states the average aperture values. Full traceability is achieved with an individual serial number on each sieve. They meet ASTM - E11, BS, and ISO Standards.
Mid-Point Sieves A Mid-Point Sieve has had the mesh inspected. The sieve is then selected as a mid-point if the results give tolerances that are in the middle of the ASTM Standard. One of the special benefits of the sieve construction is a fillet. The fillet covers the solder connection between the the mesh to the frame. This keeps particles from being caught in the crevices and makes cleaning easier. Used for everyday testing of supercritical processes. When a process requires a high level of repeatability, Mid-Point Sieves can be used on all sieve tests. However, the predominant application for the Mid-Point Sieves is master stacks. A master stack is used to check and recalibrate sieves used in everyday testing.
Working Sieves
sales@ereinc.com
74
Meinzer II Sieve Shaker
SIEVES & SIEVE SHAKERS
The Meinzer II Sieve Shaker separates different size components in ground, granular or particulate mixtures by rapid machine sieving. The newly developed clamping system is very easy to use. The Meinzer II accepts up to 10 full-height 8" sieves or 21 half-height sieves, plus a lid and receiver. Applications The Meinzer II is ideal for use on aggregates, cements, chemicals, pharmaceuticals, cosmetics, grains, seeds, coal, soils, tobacco blends, or any dry material requiring size analysis. Features • Quiet Operation Acceptable noise level for the plant or lab • Compact Size Only 10" diameter footprint • Two Way Sieving Action Simultaneous vertical and horizontal motion
• Built-In Timer Adjustable 60 minute timer with automatic shutoff • Portable Light-weight, 36 lbs • Maintenance-Free No internal moving parts
CS-18480100 Meinzer II Sieve Shaker (110 V)
Is this Sieve Shaker the right one for you? ERE is just a phone call away
1-888-287-3732
EFL 2000/2 Sieve Shaker The EFL 2000/2 is a rugged no nonsense shaker ideal for on-site and heavy-duty applications. It is equipped with a dynamic power source to ensure the sieves and sample are provided the right vibration for fast, accurate, and reproducible tests, time after time. Vertical movement is fixed to ensure samples spend a maximum amount of time seeking apertures, instead of being suspended mid-air. Applications The EFL 2000/2 is perfect for use in the field or in the production area. Features • Rugged Designed specifically for large, cumbersome samples like concrete, rock, sand and asphalt
• Easy to Use 60 minute timer and unique clamping system allows user to set up sieve tests in seconds • Maintenance-Free Non-corrodible, non-metallic springs, and a durable motor offers maintenance free testing • Flexibility Low noise level makes shaker ideal for onsite, production, and laboratory testing • Capacity 8" Sieves - 12 full height or 24 half height 12" Sieves - 6 full height or 12 half height
CS-18490012 EFL 2000/2 Sieve Shaker
Powermatic Sieve Shaker The Powermatic Sieve Shaker is rugged nononsense shaker, ideal for heavy-duty applications. It is equipped with two maintenance free sealed motors to transmit the exact vibrations and movement to the sample for optimum performance. The low voltage removable control unit allows the unit to be controlled from a bench wall, or other convenient locations. Applications The Powermatic is perfect for use in the field or production area. Features • Quiet Virtually silent in operation, ideal for on-site, production, or lab testing
75
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
• Maintenance-Free Two sealed motors offset at strategic angles transmitting the exact vibration frequency and movement for optimum performance • Easy to Use 60-minute timer and uniquely designed clamping system allows user to change sieve stacks in seconds • Flexibility Detachable control unit for convenient use Now available: Screening sieves for continuous small scale screening operations • Capacity 18" Sieves - 5 full height sieves
CS-18490018 Powermatic Sieve Shaker
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Octagon 2000 Sieve Shaker
Applications The Octagon 2000 Sieve Shaker provides precise particle size analysis for laboratory or on-site use. Features • Whisper-Quiet Ideal noise level for use in the plant, lab, or even at your desk
• Maintenance-Free Powered by electromagnets, offering no moving parts to replace • Easy to Use Digital controller allows user to control time, amplitude and continuous or intermittent vibrations • Flexibility Uniquely designed clamping system allows user to change sieve stacks in seconds • Capacity 3" Sieves - 12 full height or 24 half height 8" Sieves - 8 full height or 18 half height • Accurate Exacting horizontal and vertical sieving motion created offers paicles maximum time seeking apertures
SIEVES & SIEVE SHAKERS
The Octagon 2000 Sieve Shaker provides precise particle size analysis, all within safe and acceptable sound limits. Digital controls – time, vibration, and amplitude – allow you to duplicate test results from your current shaker with ease, from 3" to 20 um. The unit is powered by an electromagnetic drive that has no rotating parts, eliminating maintenance and virtually all noise. The rapid vertical and side to side motion created prevents apertures from blinding and offers accurate, repeatable results test after test.
CS-18490000 Octagon 2000 Sieve Shaker
An Item Worth Having! Sieve Cleaning Brushes Sieve cleaning brushes are ideal to keep your sieves working optimally. They are simple to use and are shaped to make cleaning fast and spotless.
CS-1810000NB Nylon Sieve Brush CS-1810000BB Brass Sieve Brush CS-1810000B Nylon Sieve Brush Double Ended
Can't find what you`re looking for? Our friendly Customer Service can help. Toll free:
1-888-287-3732
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
76
Distinctive, Compact Magnetic Mini-Stirrers HA-180
Shakers & Stirrers SHAKERS & STIRRERS
The HA-180 series is compact, lightweight, low-cost and designed in a special round shape without any sharp corners. Lack of laboratory bench space is no longer a concern. These stirrers incorporate electronic controls that allow the user to regulate the speed with greater precision. In addition to speed control, a Speedsafe mechanism will assure that the maximum speed will never be exceeded. Often, in the lab, a sample is removed from the stirrer before reducing the speed. This would cause the motor to accelerate until it is destroyed. Available in nine colors, light yellow, light sea-green, light blue, yellow, green, dark blue, red, grey and ivory, several HA-180 stirrers can be placed on a laboratory bench with their colors helping to identify the different samples.
HA-180A-1 Light Yellow Mini-Stirrer, 110/115 V AC HA-180B-1 Light Sea-Green Mini-Stirrer, 110/115 V AC HA-180C-1 Light Blue Mini-Stirrer, 110/115 V AC HA-180D-1 Yellow Mini-Stirrer, 110/115 V AC HA-180E-1 Green Mini-Stirrer, 110/115 V AC HA-180F-1 Blue Mini-Stirrer, 110/115 V AC Specifications
HA-180
Maximum Stirring Capacity Speed Range Min. Speed Range Max. Power Supply Cover Material Environment Dimensions Weight
1 Liter 100 rpm 1000 rpm 110/115 V AC or 230/240 V AC, 50/60 Hz ABS plastic 0 to 50째C (32 to 122째F) RH max 95% 137 mm (Dia.) x 51 mm (H) 640 g (1.4 lbs)
HA-180G-1 Red Mini-Stirrer, 110/115 V AC HA-180H-1 Grey Mini-Stirrer, 110/115 V AC HA-180I-1 Ivory Mini-Stirrer, 110/115 V AC HA-731319 Micro Stir Bar (10 Pieces) Add -2 instead of -1 to the part number for a 230/240 V AC. All models are supplied complete with micro stir bar and instructions.
Magnetic Mini-Stirrers HA-190M-1 and HA-190M-0 come supplied with an ABS cover that will resist the harmful effects of chemicals that are accidentally spilled. HA-200M is supplied with an AISI 316 stainless steel cover. This model is ideal for applications that create exothermic reactions.
Specifications
HA-190M-1
Max. Stirring Capacity Speed Range Min. Speed Range Max. Power Supply Installation Category Cover Material Environment Dimensions Weight
1 Liter (0.26 Gal) 100 rpm 1000 rpm 110/115 V AC 12 V DC 110/115 V AC II ABS plastic ABS plastic AISI 316 Stainless Steel 0 to 50째C (32 to 122째F); RH max 95% 120 x 120 x 45 mm (4.8" x 4.8" x 1.8") 640 g (1.4 lbs) 610 g (1.3 lbs) 710 g (1.6 lbs)
HA-190M-0
HA-200
HA-190M-1, HA-190M-0 & HA-200M Are Supplied Complete W/ Micro Stir Bar & Instructions HA-190M-1 Mini-Stirrer W/ ABS Cover, 110/115 V AC (Add -2 Instead Of -1 For The 230/240 V AC, 50/60 Hz Version) HA-190M-0 Mini-Stirrer W/ ABS Cover, 12 V DC HA-200M-1 Stainless Steel Cover, 100/115 V AC (Add -2 Instead Of -1 For The 230/240 V AC, 50/60 Hz Version)
77
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Auto-Reverse Magnetic Stirrers with Tachometer
Specifications
HA-304N
Max. Stirring Capacity Speed Range Tachometer Reverse Interval Installation Category Cover Material Environment Dimensions / Weight
2.5 Liters Low 100 rpm / High 800 to 1000 rpm 4-digit LCD from 30 seconds to 3 minutes II AISI 316 Stainless Steel 0 to 50°C (32 to 122°F); RH max 95% 180 x 180 x 70 mm (7.1″ x 7.1″ x 2.8″), 1.4 kg (3.1 lbs)
SHAKERS & STIRRERS
When stirring a solution, to work with a constant speed (Revolutions Per Minute) is an important factor in ensuring that the best repeatability in tests and processes is achieved. Without a tachometer, there is no way of knowing the RPM’s. HA-304N is a heavy-duty stirrer with a built-in tachometer. It is often desirable to stir in two directions in order to achieve maximum homogeneity. An advanced circuit allows HA-304N to reverse the direction of the stir at a user selected interval. The interval can be adjusted from 30 seconds up to 3 minutes. In addition to precision speed control, a limiter will also assure that the maximum speed will never be exceeded (Speedsafe).
HA-304N-1 (100/115 V AC) HA-304N-2 (220/240 V AC) Magnetic Stirrer, Stainless Steel Cover, Micro Stir Bar & Instructions
Air-Operated Turbine Magnetic Stirrer Low pressure air supply drives the magnetic stirrer. Eliminates sparking hazard from electrical sources. Ideal for use where potentially explosive solvent vapors are present. This compact, small-footprint stirrer only uses 3 to 8 psi (21-55kPa) air pressure and is ideal for stirring vessels up to 1 liter. Tubing is supplied to connect to an air supply. All parts are made from high impact polystyrene to ensure long life and easy clean up in case of spills. Dimensions: 102 mm (4") diameter x 19 mm (3/4") high.
BEL-F37002-0000 Air-Operated Turbine Magnetic Stirrer
InfoZone Why use a Magnetic Stirrer versus a Motorized Stirrer? 1. They are quieter 2. More efficient 3. No moving external parts that can break 4. A stirring bar is easy to clean 5. No lubricants are required
Pick up your Magnetic Stirrer & Bars TODAY!
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
78
Octagon Spinbar® Magnetic Stirring Bars
BEL-F37110-1218E* Magnetic Stirring Bar, 12.7 x 3.2 mm (1/2" x 1/8")
BEL-F37110-1128E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 38.1 x 9.5 mm (1 1/2" x 3/8")
BEL-F37110-1238E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 12.7 x 9.5 mm (1/2" x 3/8")
BEL-F37110-1122E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 38.1 x 12.7 mm (1 1/2" x 1/2")
BEL-F37110-5838E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 15.9 x 9.5 mm (5/8" x 3/8")
BEL-F37110-0158E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 41.3 x 8 mm (1 5/8" x 5/16")
BEL-F37110-0078E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 22.2 x 8 mm (7/8" x 5/16")
BEL-F37110-0178E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 47.6 x 9.5 mm (1 7/8" x 3/8")
BEL-F37110-7838E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 22.2 x 9.5 mm (7/8" x 3/8")
BEL-F37110-0002E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 50.8 x 8 mm (2" x 5/16")
BEL-F37110-0001E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 25.4 x 8 mm (1" x 5/16")
BEL-F37110-0238E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 50.8 x 9.5 mm (2" x 3/8")
BEL-F37110-0138E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 25.4 x 9.5 mm (1" x 3/8")
BEL-F37110-0212E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 63.5 x 8 mm (2 1/2" x 5/16")
BEL-F37110-0118E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 28.6 x 8 mm (1 1/8" x 5/16")
BEL-F37110-2128E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 63.5 x 9.5 mm (2 1/2" x 3/8")
BEL-F37110-0112E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 38.1 x 8 mm (1 1/2" x 5/16")
BEL-F37110-0003E Magnetic Stirring Bar, 76.2 x 12.7 mm (3" x 1/2") *No pivot ring on this size.
Polygon Spinbar® Magnetic Stirring Bars Teflon® PTFE Sold Individually.
BEL-F37120-0012E Polygon Spinbar® Magnetic Stirring Bars, 12.7 x 8 mm (1/2" x 5/16") BEL-F37120-0112E Polygon Spinbar® Magnetic Stirring Bars, 38.1 x 9.5 mm (1 1/2" x 3/8") BEL-F37120-0030E Polygon Spinbar® Magnetic Stirring Bars, 30 x 8 mm (1 3/16" x 5/16") BEL-F37120-0050E Polygon Spinbar® Magnetic Stirring Bars, 50 x 8 mm (2" x 5/16")
Octagon Shaped Spinbar® Magnetic Stirring Bars Color-Coded Teflon® PTFE
BEL-F37109-0034E* Magnetic Stirring Bar, Red, 12.7 x 3.2 mm (1/2" x 1/8") BEL-F37109-0035E* Magnetic Stirring Bar, Yellow, 12.7 x 3.2 mm (1/2" x 1/8") BEL-F37109-0036E* Magnetic Stirring Bar, Blue, 12.7 x 3.2 mm (1/2" x 1/8") BEL-F37109-0001E Magnetic Stirring Bar, Red, 12.7 x 8 mm (1/2" x 5/16") BEL-F37109-0002E Magnetic Stirring Bar, Yellow, 12.7 x 8 mm (1/2" x 5/16") BEL-F37109-0003E Magnetic Stirring Bar, Blue, 12.7 x 8 mm (1/2" x 5/16") BEL-F37109-0004E Magnetic Stirring Bar, Red, 15.9 x 8 mm (5/8" x 5/16") BEL-F37109-0005E Magnetic Stirring Bar, Yellow, 15.9 x 8 mm (5/8" x 5/16")
All PTFE coded Spinbar® Magnetic Stirring Bars are available in red, yellow or blue. Sold Individually.
79
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
BEL-F37109-0006E Magnetic Stirring Bar, Blue, 15.9 x 8 mm (5/8" x 5/16") *No pivot ring on this size.
Fax : (514) 326 8961
SHAKERS & STIRRERS
SHAKERS & STIRRERS
Teflon® PTFE with Molded-On Pivot Ring. Sold Individually.
Orbit™ LS Low Speed Shaker
Specifications
Orbit™ LS Low Speed Shaker
Speed Range
3 - 60 rpm
Timer
20 - 120 min (10 min inc.) or continuous
Motion
Circular, 19 mm
Maximum Load
11 lbs (5 kg)
Ambient Operating Range
+4° to 70°C
Dimensions (W x D x H)
10" x 12.6" x 6.3" (25.5 x 32 x 16 cm)
Weight
14.5 lbs (6.6 kg)
Electrical
120 V~, 60 Hz or 230 V~, 50 Hz
SHAKERS & STIRRERS
The Orbit™ LS Low Speed Shaker is a high quality, general purpose shaker with economical analog control. Styled after the other models in the line, the Orbit™ LS features a streamlined, compact design with easy-access control panel. Electronic controls are utilized for setting speed and time. The knobs used for selecting parameters turn easily and are clearly marked with corresponding values. A large orbit and low speed make the Orbit™ LS useful for staining and destaining gels, washing blots and general mixing. The shaker is supplied with a 30 x 30 cm stainles steel flat platform and non-slip rubber mat to keep plates, dishes and other sample containers in place.
LAB-S2030-LS Orbit™ LS Low Speed Orbital Shaker W/ Flat Platform LAB-S2031-12D Stacked Double Flat Platform W/ Rubber Mat
Orbit™ 300 Multipurpose Vortexer Three interchangeable platforms (available separately) accommodate a variety of sample containers to make the Orbit™ 300 a truly multipurpose shaker. The flat platform, covered with a nonslip rubber mat, holds plates, dishes, boxes, etc. The microplate platform will accommodate up to four microplates. The remaining platform has spring loaded retaining bars that adjust to hold flasks, bottles, racks and other containers in place. Time and speed are set and displayed digitally. Values are shown on the large, three digit LED. The broad speed range allows the Orbit™ 300 to be used for gentle mixing as well as vigorous agitation. The shaker housing is constructed of heavy gauge, coated steel to reduce motor noise and lend stability to the unit. This compact shaker can be used in temperature controlled environments making it ideal for cold room or incubator use. Features • Three versatile platform options • Shaking, mixing, agitating or vortexing • Heavy-duty construction • Safe for cold room or incubator use
LAB-S2030-300 Orbit™ 300 Digital Multipurpose Shaker, Base Only LAB-S2030-10 Platform For Four Microplates LAB-S2030-12 Flat Platform (30 x 30 cm) W/ Nonslip Rubber Mat LAB-S2030-13 Spring Loaded Platform For Flasks, Bottles, Etc.
Specifications
Orbit™ 300 Multipurpose Vortexer
Speed Range
100 - 1200 rpm
Timer
0 to 99 minutes or continuous
Motion/Orbit Size
Horizontally circular, 3 mm
Maximum Load
12.3 lbs (5.6 kg)
Ambient Operating Range
+ 4° to 65°C
Dimensions (W x D x H)
10.1" x 12.5" x 5" (25.6 x 31.7 x 12.7 cm)
Weight
16 lbs (7.3 kg)
Electrical*
120 V~, 60 Hz
*Other voltages available upon request.
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
80
Surface Tension SURFACE TENSION
Bostwick Consistometer
The Bostwick Consistometer is the preferred choice for measuring consistency, flow rate and viscosity in a variety of products. You can use the Bostwick on any viscous material like sauces, salad dressings, paints, chemicals or cosmetics where you want to measure the distance a material flows in a given time interval. The Bostwick complies to Mill Spec R81294D and ASTM F1080-93 and is made of stainless steel construction. Features • Durable Stainless Steel Construction, resists corrosion, suitable for laboratory and plant use • Convenient Size Uses little bench space, requires only 75 mL of sample 14"L x 3 1/2"W x 5 1/2"H • Spring Loading Gate Instantaneous gate release, prevents premature flowing of sample
• Reproductivity 2 leveling screws and spirit levels, precise positioning of flow angle • Precision Engraved graduations of 0.5 cm divisions, assures accurate results, wear & smear resistant Uses • Food Processing Tomato sauces + others, preserves, fillings, soups, baby foods, salad dressings & suggested by USDA • Manufacturing Epoxy removers, polyurethane paint, adhesives, coatings & mil spec R-81294B • Cosmetics Formulations Lotions, shampoos & flow base creams • Chemical Production Selected solvents, viscous liquids, slurries & emulsions
CS-24925000 Bostwick Consistometer
Features • Rapid Measurement Ring method allows readings to be made in 15 - 30 seconds (Ideal for colloidal suspensions which exhibit rapid changes in surface tension) • Direct Reading Circular scale is graduated in dynes/cm eliminating the need for mathematical calculations • Reproducible Results Improved technique allows accurate readings to be reproduced within ±0.05 dyne/cm • Portability Compact unit comes with carrying case for easy transport • Stability Unit is mounted on a cast tripod support with convenient leveling screws
Precision & Interfacial DuNouy Tensiometer
Measure surface tension and interfacial tension quickly and accurately in oils, detergents, serums, colloidal suspensions, chromium solutions, etc. to better control your process and your product quality. The DuNouy Tensiometer is easy-to-use, accurate, portable and gives surface tension results reproducible to within ±0.05 dyne/cm.
CS-70535000 Precision DuNouy Tensiometer CS-70545000 Interfacial DuNouy Tensiometer
The DuNouy Tensiometer is available in two models • Precision DuNouy Tensiometer (upward direction) This model tensiometer provides precise readings of upward interfacial and surface tensions by the ring method to values reproducible within ±0.05 dyne/cm. This instrument is specified for determining interfacial tension of oil against water by the ring method in ASTM Method D971 and solutions of surface-active agents in ASTM Method D1331. It is also specified for testing synthetic rubber lattices in ASTM D1417 and determining the surface tension of industrial water and industrial wastewater in ASTM Method D1590.
zero and a double vernier is provided. The two scales and corresponding verniers have graduations and figures of different colors to indicate whether the measured force is upward or downward. • Both instruments can be quickly adjusted and calibrated. They are supplied completely assembled and are furnished with three extra torsion wires, a 6 cm platinum-iridium ring and carrying case.
Quality surface tension testing and the DuNouy Tensiometer has become an indispensable asset to a variety of industries including paints, coatings and inks; chrome, nickel, and brass plating; soap; surfactants; emulsions; • Interfacial DuNouy Tensiometer (dual direction) Where the Precision Tesiometer measures only the upward pull on the crude and transformer oils and many more. The CSC DuNouy ring, the Interfacial Tensiometer is designed to measure both upward and Tensiometer is also being used in many universities and technical centers downward forces on the ring. Graduated dial reads in both directions from as an important instrument for scientific studies.
81
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Ultrasonics The Sonifier product line, originally established as the benchmark in cell disruption, has become a liquid processing workhorse in the laboratory.
ULTRASONIC SONIFIERS & BATHS
Each Sonifier system consists of a power supply, converter, and mechanically tuned processing horn. Standard units are available from 100 to 1000 Watts for matching the equipment to your application.
Applications include: • Emulsification of immiscible liquids • Disaggregation and dispersion • Homogenization • Chip assay • Acceleration of reactions • Cell lysing • Processing DNA and proteins • Leaching and extraction
Branson SONIFIER® SLP Series The Branson Sonifier SLP Series – available in both time and energy (joules) models – are capable of processing today’s laboratory requirements. Software prevents inappropriate data entry and sounds an alarm if the process moves outside set limits. The SLP Series units include the generator / power supply, converter, 1/8" microtip, all interconnects, and an I/O port for external control. They operate at 40 kHz, 50/60 Hz. • Autotune plus Memory (AT/M) – provides fully-automatic tuning and stores frequency at the end of each cycle • Digital parameter entry for precise, easy setup • Digital amplitude control allows for critical applications (range from 10% to 100% in 1% increments) • Continuous or pulsed operation • LED readout displays parameter settings during setup and operation for easy reference and monitoring
• Provides storage of last-used cycle parameters even if the system is shut off or a power interruption occurs • Local or remote (p/c) control capability • Total processing time: 1 second to 99 hours (SLPt unit) • Adjustable total energy: 1 to 10,000 joules (SLPe unit)
Model
Output Dimensions
Weight
Part Number Input Power
Included Horn
SLPt Time
150 Watts 7 3/4" x 13 1/4" x 9" 196.85 x 338.58 x 228.6 mm
17 lbs 7.71 kg
101-063-723
117 Volt, 1ø, 50/60 Hz, 2 amps
1/8" Microtip
SLPt Time
150 Watts 7 3/4" x 13 1/4" x 9" 196.85 x 338.58 x 228.6 mm
17 lbs 7.71 kg
101-063-724
240 Volt, 1ø, 50/60 Hz, 1 amps
1/8" Microtip
SLPe Energy 150 Watts 7 3/4" x 13 1/4" x 9" 196.85 x 338.58 x 228.6 mm
17 lbs 7.71 kg
101-063-726
117 Volt, 1ø, 50/60 Hz, 2 amps
1/8" Microtip
SLPe Energy 150 Watts 7 3/4" x 13 1/4" x 9" 196.85 x 338.58 x 228.6 mm
17 lbs 7.71 kg
101-063-727
240 Volt, 1ø, 50/60 Hz, 1 amps
1/8" Microtip
SLP Microtips
Rosette Cell
Acoustic Sound Enclosure
Microtips for the SLP Sonifier are available in four sizes to handle volumes up to 100 mL. The microtips are also designed to process samples to the smallest diameter vessels.
Branson’s Rosette Cell provides a unique flow pattern of substances for exposure to ultrasonic energy during circulation through the cell. When it is immersed in a cooling bath, the enlarged glass surface area and circulation through the side arms provide an efficient means of heat exchange. Three sizes are available.
The Branson Acoustic Sound Enclosure creates a sound barrier that reduces the ambient noise level a minimum of 24 dBs from the working environment. Its small footprint allows for placement in virtually all laboratory or medical locations.
1/8" microtip is already provided with the SLP Sonifiers.
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
82
ULTRASONIC SONIFIERS & BATHS
Branson SONIFIER® Analog Cell Disruptor Branson Sonifier digital products take advantage of benefits enabled by newer digital technology. This is particularly useful where precise process control and parameter measurement is required. These 20 kHz units include automatic amplitude control, broadband tuning, and include enhanced features like: • Autotune plus Memory (AT/M) – provides fully-automatic tuning and stores frequency at the end of each cycle • Multiple mode operation – continuous, pulsed, timed, and temperature end-point • Setup menu in five languages • Digital parameter setting with valid parameter range checking • Digital timer (9 hours, 59 minutes, 59 seconds) • Amplitude is adjustable from 10 - 100% • User I/O offers remote start / stop control and the ability to view temperature, amplitude, and power values during experiments
• Automatic end-of-cycle shutoff using limit parameters • Self diagnostics on start-up • Twenty user-programmed presets for convenience All units have digital controls including a membrane switch for easy data entry, 10-hour timer, digital wattmeter, 80 character LCD display to monitor parameters, and much more. The parallel printer interface and RS-232C serial computer interface add even more utility. All units are supplied as an operational package including power supply, converter, and standard horn.
Model
Output
Dimensions
Weight
Part Number
Input Power
Included Horn
S-250D
200 Watts
7 3/8" x 17 5/8" x 9 5/8" 187.32 x 447.68 x 244.48 mm
20 lbs 9.07 kg
101-063-588 101-063-589
115 Volt, 60 Hz, 1ø 230 Volt, 50/60 Hz, 1ø
1/2" Tapped
S-450D
400 Watts
7 3/8" x 17 5/8" x 9 5/8" 187.32 x 447.68 x 244.48 mm
22 lbs 9.98 kg
101-063-593 101-063-591
115 Volt, 60 Hz, 1ø 230 Volt, 50/60 Hz, 1ø
1/2" Tapped
S-450D
400 Watts
7 3/8" x 17 5/8" x 9 5/8" 187.32 x 447.68 x 244.48 mm
22 lbs 9.98 kg
101-063-590 101-063-592
115 Volt, 60 Hz, 1ø 230 Volt, 50/60 Hz, 1ø
3/4" Solid
Branson SONIFIER® Digital Cell Disruptor Branson Sonifier analog products use traditional analog technology to produce the same reliable results you have received from Branson for over 60 years. Automatic amplitude compensation provides constant horn amplitude at different energy levels encountered during sample processing. The broadband tuning feature precisely adjusts the 20 kHz output frequency to optimum levels even when process tooling is changed. The analog control package includes:
All of these features are housed in a rugged, compact package with slanted front control panel for clear visibility and easy access. All units are supplied as an operational package including power supply, converter, and standard disruptor horn.
• Autotune plus Memory (AT/M) - provides fullyautomatic tuning and stores frequency at the end of each cycle • Adjustable output power to meet the needs of each application • Energy pulsing to minimize heating of sensitive samples • Mechanical timer to limit process time while freeing the operator • An output meter to monitor process power and provide for repeatability Model
Output
Dimensions
Weight
Part Number Input Power
Included Horn
S-250A
200 Watts
7 3/8" x 17 5/8" x 9 5/8" 187.32 x 447.68 x 244.48 mm
19 lbs 9.07 kg
101-063-196 101-063-197
115 Volt, 60 Hz, 1ø 230 Volt, 50/60 Hz, 1ø
1/2" Tapped
S-450A
400 Watts
7 3/8" x 17 5/8" x 9 5/8" 187.32 x 447.68 x 244.48 mm
25 lbs 11.34 kg
101-063-198 101-063-199
115 Volt, 60 Hz, 1ø 230 Volt, 50/60 Hz, 1ø
1/2" Tapped
S-450A
400 Watts
7 3/8" x 17 5/8" x 9 5/8" 187.32 x 447.68 x 244.48 mm
25 lbs 11.34 kg
101-063-200 101-063-201
115 Volt, 60 Hz, 1ø 230 Volt, 50/60 Hz, 1ø
3/4" Solid
Accessories for use with 250 and 450 units
High Intensity Cup Horn
83
Cup Horn
Sealed Atmosphere Chanmber
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Continuous Flow Chamber
Flow-Through Horn
Microtip with Coupler (Double-Step), 1/8" Microtip
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Tapered Microtip
Standard Disruptor Horn
Ultrasonic Cleaners
Branson Ultrasonic Cleaners
Model 1510
Model 2510
Model 3510
Model 5510
Model 8510
Tank Size
6"L x 5.5"W x 4"D
9.5"L x 5.5"W x 4"D
11.5"L x 6"W x 6"D
11.5"L x 9.5"W x 6"D
19.5"L x 11.5"W x 6”D
Overall Size
10"L x 12"W x 11.5"D
10"L x 12"W x 11.5"D
16"L x 12"W x 14.5"D
16"L x 15.5"W x 14.5"D
24"L x 18"W x 14.5"D
Tank Capacity
0.5 gal. (1.9 L)
0.75 gal. (2.8 L)
1.5 gal. (5.7 L)
2.5 gal. (9.5 L)
5.5 gal. (20.8 L)
Weight
7 lbs
9 lbs
12 lbs
14 lbs
26 lbs
Frequency
40 kHz
40 kHz
40 kHz
40 kHz
40 kHz
Drain
No
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
120V Models
B1510-DTH CPN-952-118
B2510-DTH CPN-952-218
B3510-DTH CPN-952-318
B5510-DTH CPN-952-518
B8510-DTH CPN-952-818
230/240V Models B1510E-DTH CPN-952-138
B2510E-DTH CPN-952-238
B3510E-DTH CPN-952-338
B5510E-DTH CPN-952-538
B8510E-DTH CPN-952-538
B1510-MTH CPN-952-117
B2510-MTH CPN-952-217
B3510-MTH CPN-952-317
B5510-MTH CPN-952-517
B8510-MTH CPN-952-817
230/240V Models B1510E-MTH CPN-952-137
B2510E-MTH CPN-952-237
B3510E-MTH CPN-952-337
B5510E-MTH CPN-952-537
B8510E-MTH CPN-952-837
B1510-MT CPN-952-116
B2510-MT CPN-952-216
B3510-MT CPN-952-316
B5510-MT CPN-952-516
B8510-MT CPN-952-816
230/240V Models B1510E-MT CPN-952-136
B2510E-MT CPN-952-236
B3510E-MT CPN-952-336
B5510E-MT CPN-952-536
B8510E-MT CPN-952-836
120V Models
120V Models
Typical applications for ultrasonic cleaners • Scientific labs • Frames • Medical and dental labs • Industry • Electronics • Jewelry Features • Digital Control Plus Heat and Timer (DTH) • Mechanical Timer Plus Heat (MTH) • Mechanical Timer (MT)
ULTRASONIC SONIFIERS & BATHS
Ultrasonic cleaning is faster, more consistent, and safer than any other method. Hand scrubbing, soaking, or steams don’t even come close. It's powerful enough to remove heavy oils, buffing compounds, or proteins, consistent enough to manage difficult laboratory cleaning every time, and safe enough for those delicate electronic components or fine jewelry. Ultrasonic sound waves moving through a cleaning solution create an effect called cavitation, the rapid formation and collapse of microscopic bubbles. This powerful collapse, along with the cleaning chemistry, scrubs every wetted surface. The deep cleaning action of ultrasonics removes the most stubborn contaminants, even from blind holes and internal surfaces; the addition of heat enhances this process.
Digital models feature microprocessor controlled timer and thermostat with fingertip input and clear LED readout of parameters.
Industrial type ultrasonic transducers assure maximum power in the cleaning tank.
Rugged 60 minute mechanical timer features a hold position for continuous operation.
Models 1510, 2510, 3510, 5510, and 8510 are supplied with a cover.* Standard 2-year Warranty. ISO 9001:2000 Certified
Cover (supplied with unit)
Perforated Tray
Mesh Basket
Solid Insert Tray
Beaker Positioning Cover
Support Racks
Beakers (for all models)
Model 1510
A12-1 100-032-320
A12-3 100-410-160
100-916-333
A12-2 100-410-170
A12-4 (1 x 600 mL) CPN-246-010
CPN-916-039
A250 250 mL Glass 000-140-001
Model 2510
A22-1 100-032-321
A22-3 100-410-162
100-916-334
A22-2 100-410-172
A22-5 (2 x 600 mL) CPN-246-011 A22-6 (2 x 250 mL) CPN-246-015
CPN-916-040
A400 400 mL Polypropylene 000-265-061
Model 3510
A32-1 100-032-322
A32-3 100-410-164
100-916-335
A32-2 100-410-174
A32-4 (3 x 250 mL) CPN-246-016 A32-5 (2 x 600 mL) CPN-246-012
CPN-916-041
Model 5510
A52-1 100-032-323
A52-3 100-410-166
A52-2 100-410-176
A52-4 (4 x 600 mL) CPN-246-013
CPN-916-042
Model 8510
A82-1 000-917-050 (Stainless Steel)
A82-3 100-410-168
A82-2 100-410-178
A82-4 (6 x 600 mL) CPN-246-014 (Stainless Steel)
CPN-916-043
www.ereinc.com
A600-1 600 mL Glass 000-140-004 A600-2 600 mL Stainless Steel 000-410-055
sales@ereinc.com
84
ULTRASONIC SONIFIERS & BATHS
Branson B-300 Branson’s Model B-300 cleaner will provide a quick, consistent, high quality cleaning over a wide variety of applications; specifically designed to clean parts or instruments in just minutes. Unit comes with a 15-minute timer, cover, and parts basket. One year warranty. Specifications Tank Size: 11.8"L x 3.9"W x 2.9"D Overall Size : 13.2"L x 5.3"W x 5.9"D Tank Capacity: 0.5 gal. (1.9 liter) Weight: 4.6 lbs Frequency: 40 kHz
Branson B-3 Pint Size
Branson B-200 Jewelry and Optical Cleaner
Branson’s Model B-3 pint size ultrasonic cleaner is especially useful for cleaning small items, quickly and efficiently. Useful in lab, medical, hobby, jewelry and small industrial applications. One year warranty. Unit comes with a cover and parts basket. Specifications Tank Size: 3.5"D x 3" dia. Overall Size: 5.25"L x 5.25"W x 6.25"D Tank Capacity: 1 pint (0.47 liter) Weight: 3 lbs Frequency: 55 kHz
Branson’s Model 200 cleaner is compact and stylish, with the convenience of plug-inanywhere operation. This model has the ultrasonic cleaning ability to handle a wide variety of applications; it is specifically designed to clean jewelry and optical pieces quickly and effectively. A 5-minute timer, cover and parts basket are included. One year warranty. Specifications Tank Size: 6.5"L x 3.5"W x 2.25"D Overall Size: 8.75"L x 4.5"W x 5"D Tank Capacity: 15 oz. (0.4 liter) Weight: 3 lbs Frequency: 40 kHz
Branson Integrated Systems Models 1216 and 1620
Branson Higher Capacity DHA-1000 This low-cost 40 kHz ultrasonic cleaner is designed especially for medium and heavy duty industrial applications. It is fully integrated, with ultrasonic generator and cleaning tank in a single enclosure. Solution capacity is 10 gallons – enough to handle large, bulky parts or for batch cleaning of small components. It’s the only industrial size ultrasonic cleaner of its type available today. One year warranty. Specifications Tank Size: 14"L x 16"W x 10.5"D Overall Size: 17"L x 19"W x 19"D Tank Capacity: 10 gal. (37.8 liters) Weight: 70 lbs Frequency: 40 kHz
85
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Branson’s IC Series ultrasonic cleaning systems offer a full range of features to meet most precision cleaning requirements. These compact units incorporate 3/16, 14 gauge, all stainless steel construction, digital controls with cycle time up to 99 minutes and batch temperatures up to 69º celsius, a modern solidstate ultrasonic generator, and 25 or 40 kHz industrial transducers to deliver precise cleaning quickly, consistently, and cost effectively. The IC Series units, with their greater power per unit volume, can reduce cleaning cycle time or handle more difficult industrial applications including more denselypacked, smaller parts; heavier or more tenacious soils; investment removal from cast parts, and larger machined components. Includes cover and basket. Two year warranty.
Branson PC-620 Ultrasonic Cleaner
Specifications
IC 1216
IC 1620
Tank Size (L x W x D)
12" x 16" x 13"
16" x 20" x 16"
Overall Size (L x W x D)
20.75" x 19" x 16.75"
24.75" x 23" x 20.75"
Tank Capacity
10 gal. (37.8 liters)
21 gal. (79.5 liters)
Weight
80 lbs
120 lbs
The PC-620 at 40 kHz is ideal for cleaning pipettes, lab glassware, and other items requiring general cleaning. One year warranty. Specifications Tank Size: 19.5"L x 5.75"W x 6"D Overall Size: 20.25"L x 6.25"W x 10.5"D Tank Capacity: 2.75 gal. (10.4 liters) Weight: 23 lbs Frequency: 40 kHz
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Water Analysis
Dissolved Oxygen & BOD Meter with Graphic, Color LCD Display
BOD gives an indication of the biodegradable organic material present in a sample of water. The dissolved oxygen concentration is measured before and after an incubation period of 5 days and the BOD is calculated in mg per liter from the difference.
Specifications
HA-4421
Range
Features • Extended range up to 90 ppm and 600% saturation • True barometric atmospheric pressure compensation • Automatic or user calibration • Auto-hold to freeze LCD readings • AutoEnd mode for DO • Flexible logging with 3 modes • BOD (biochemical oxygen demand), OUR (oxygen uptake rate) and SOUR (specific oxygen uptake rate) • GLP • Two selectable alarm limits • Up to 100 logging lots, 200 OUR and SOUR reports and up to 200 BOD method entries
Dissolved Oxygen Barometric Pressure Salinity Compensation Temperature
0.00 to 90.00 ppm; 0.0 to 600.0% saturation 450 to 850 mmHg; 560 to 1133 mBar 0 to 45 ppt (g/L) -20.0 to 120.0°C; -4.0 to 248°F; 253.1 to 393.1K
Resolution
Dissolved Oxygen Barometric Pressure Temperature
0.01 ppm; 0.1% saturation 1 mm Hg 0.1°C/°F/K
Accuracy
Dissolved Oxygen Barometric Pressure Temperature Measurement Modes
WATER ANALYSIS
OUR and SOUR are used to determine the oxygen consumption or respiration rate. OUR is measured in mg of oxygen consumed per liter per hour, and SOUR is measured in mg of oxygen consumed per gram of volatile suspended solids per hour.
±1.5% of reading ±1 digit ±3 mm Hg + 1 least significant digit ±0.2°C/K/°F Direct DO; BOD (biochemical oxygen demand); OUR (oxygen uptake rate); SOUR (specific oxygen uptake rate)
Calibration
Dissolved Oxygen Barometric Pressure Temperature Compensation Probe (Included)
Automatic/user standard, 1 or 2 points Single point 0.0 to 50.0°C; 32.0 to 122.0°F; 237.1 to 323.1 K Polarographic with built-in temperature sensor
Logging HA-4421-01 Supplied W/ HA-76408 DO Probe, HA-7041S Electrolyte Solution (30 mL), HA-76407A/P Membrane Caps (2), HA-76404N Electrode Holder, Power Adapter & Instruction Manual (115 V)
HA-76407A/P Replacement Membrane (5 Pieces)
HA-76408 DO Probe For Laboratory Use, W/ 1 m (3.3') Cable
HA-920010 Serial Cable For PC Connection
HA-7040L Zero Oxygen Solution, 500 mL
HA-73114 USB Cable For PC Connection
Record Samples Logging Interval GLP Alarm PC Connection Display
HA-92000CD4 Windows® Compatible Software
Power Supply Dimensions / Weight
HA-7041S Electrolyte Solution, 30 mL
Up to 100 lots; 10000 samples/lot for automatic logging; 5000 samples/lot for manual logging from 1 second and up Last calibration data, calibration info (DO, BOD, OUR, SOUR) Inside and outside limits Opto-isolated USB and RS232 240 x 320 dot-matrix color LCD with on-screen help, graphing, language selection and custom configuration 12 V DC adapter (included) 159 x 230 x 93 mm (6.3" x 9.1" x 3.7"), 800 g (1.8 lbs)
Precision Turbidity & Free/Total Chlorine Meters HA-83414 • HA-88703 Specifications
HA-83414
HA-88703
Turbidity
0.00 to 9.99; 10.0 to 40.0 NTU / 0.0 to 99.9; 100 to 268 Nephelos / 0.00 to 9.80 EBC 0.01; 0.1 NTU / 0.1; 1 Nephelos / 0.01 EBC 0.00 to 9.99; 10.0 to 99.9; 100 to 4000 NTU / 0.0 to 99.9; 100 to 26800 Nephelos / 0.00 to 9.99; 10.0 to 99.9; 100 to 980 EBC 0.01; 0.1; 1 NTU / 0.1; 1 Nephelos / 0.01; 0.1, 1 EBC Automatic ±2% of reading plus 0.02 NTU (0.15 Nephelos; 0.01 EBC) ±5% of reading above 1000 NTU (6700 Nephelos; 245 EBC) ±1% of reading or 0.02 NTU (0.15 Nephelos; 0.01 EBC) whichever is greater < 0.02 NTU (0.15 Nephelos; 0.01 EBC) Silicon Photocell Nephelometric method (90°) or Ratio Nephelometric Method 108.1 and Standard Method 2130 B. Method (90° & 180°), Adaptation of the USEPA Normal, Average, Continuous <0.1, 15, 100, 750 and 2000 NTU Two, three, four or five-point calibration
Range - Non Ratio Mode Resolution - Non Ratio Mode Range - Ratio Mode Resolution - Ratio Mode Range Selection Accuracy
Features • HA-83414 features 4 measuring ranges: Ratio Turbidity; Non-Ratio Turbidity; Free Chlorine; Total Chlorine • HA-88703 features 2 measuring ranges: Ratio Turbidity; Non-Ratio Turbidity • Meets USEPA requirements • Exclusive chlorine CAL CHECK™ calibration validation for HA-83414 • Good laboratory practice capabilities • 2, 3, 4 or 5 point turbidity calibration • USB PC connectivity • Backlit LCD • On-screen tutorial modes • Log and recall up to 200 measurements • Contextual help menus • Auto shut-off
www.ereinc.com
Repeatability Stray Light Light Detector Method Measuring Mode Turbidity Standards Calibration Free & Total Chlorine
Range Resolution Accuracy Detector Method Standards Calibration
Free: Cl2: 0.00 to 5.00 mg/L / Total: Cl2: 0.00 to 5.00 mg/L 0.01 mg/L from 0.00 to 3.50 mg/L; 0.10 above 3.50 mg/L ±0.02 mg/L @ 1.00 mg/L Silicon photocell with 525 nm narrow band interference filters Adaptation of the USEPA Method 330.5 and Standard Method 4500-Cl G. 1 mg/L free chlorine, 1 mg/L total chlorine One-point calibration
HA-88703-01 supplied with (5) sample cuvets and caps, calibration cuvets, silicone oil (HA-93703-58), tissue for wiping cuvets, power cord and instruction manual.
HA-83414-01 supplied with (5) sample cuvets and caps, calibration cuvets for turbidimeter and colorimeter (HA-83414-11), silicone oil (HA-93703-58), tissue for wiping cuvets, scissors, power cord and instruction manual
sales@ereinc.com
86
HA-83200, 2008 Series 2008 Series is a multiparameter bench colorimeter dedicated for laboratory analysis. It can measure up to 45 methods using specific liquid or powder reagents. The amount of reagent is precisely dosed to ensure maximum repeatability.
WATER ANALYSIS
Features • Log and recall data at a push of a button • Light blocking cuvet holder • Backlit LCD • Battery Error Prevention System (BEPS) • PC compatible via USB • On-screen tutorial and context sensitive help screens • Powered by rechargeable batteries or 12 V DC
Easy Lab Analysis HA-83200-01 2008 Series Supplied W/ A Rugged Carrying Case, Cuvettes (4), Bottle For DO Tests, Scissors, Cuvette Cleaning Cloths (4), 12 V DC Adapter, & An Instruction Manual (115 V) (Test, Range & Method)
HA-93746-01** Iron LR, 0 To 400 μg/L, TPTZ
HA-93712-01 Aluminum, 0.00 To 1.00 mg/L, Aluminon
HA-93709-01 Manganese, HR 0.0 To 20.0 mg/L, Periodate Oxidation
HA-93755-01 Alkalinity, 0 To 500 mg/L, Colorimetric
HA-93748-01** Manganese LR, 0 To 300 μg/L, PAN
HA-93715-01 Ammonia, MR 0.00 To 10.00 mg/L, Nessler
HA-93730-01 Molybdenum, 0.0 To 40.0 mg/L, Mercaptoacetic Acid
HA-93700-01 Ammonia, LR 0.00 To 3.00 mg/L, Nessler
HA-93726-01 Nickel HR, 0.00 To 7.00 g/L, Photometric
HA-93716-01 Bromine, 0.00 To 8.00 mg/L, DPD
HA-93740-01** Nickel LR, 0.000 mg/L To 1.000 mg/L, PAN
HA-937521-01** Calcium, 0 To 400 mg/L, Oxalate
HA-93728-01 Nitrate, 0.0 To 30.0 mg/L, Cadmium Reduction
HA-93738-01 Chlorine Dioxide, 0.00 To 2.00 mg/L, Chlorophenol Red
HA-93708-01 Nitrite HR, 0 To 150 mg/L, Ferrous Sulfate
HA-93701-01 Chlorine*, Free 0.00 To 2.50 mg/L DPD
HA-93707-01 Nitrite LR, 0.00 To 0.35 mg/L, Diazotization
HA-93711-01 Chlorine*, Total 0.00 To 3.50 mg/L, DPD
HA-93732-01 Oxygen, Dissolved (DO), 0.0 To 10.0 mg/L, Winkler
HA-93723-01 Chromium, VI HR 0 To 1000 μg/L, Diphenylcarbohydrazide
HA-93757-01 Ozone, 0.00 To 2.00 mg/L, DPD
HA-93749-01 Chromium, VI LR 0 To 300 μg/L, Diphenylcarbohydrazide
HA-93710-01 pH, 6.5 To 8.5 pH, Phenol Red
N/A Color, 0 To 500 PCU, Colorimetric Platinum Cobalt
HA-93717-01 Phosphate HR, 0.0 To 30.0 mg/L, Amino Acid
HA-93702-01 Copper, HR 0.00 To 5.00 mg/L, Bicinchoninate
HA-93713-01 Phosphate LR, 0.00 To 2.50 mg/L, Ascorbic Acid
HA-95747-01 Copper, LR 0 To 1000 μg/L, Bicinchoninate
HA-93706-01 Phosphorus, 0.0 To 15.0 mg/L, Amino Acid
HA-93714-01 Cyanide, 0.000 To 0.200 mg/L, Pyridine-Pyrazalone
HA-93750-01 Potassium HR, 20 To 200 mg/L, Turbidimetric Tetraphenylborate
HA-93722-01 Cyanuric Acid, 0 To 80 mg/L, Turbidimetric
HA-93750-01 Potassium MR, 10 To 100 mg/L, Turbidimetric Tetraphenylborate
HA-93729-01 Fluoride, 0.00 To 2.00 mg/L, SPADNS
HA-93750-01 Potassium LR, 0.0 To 20.0 mg/L, Turbidimetric Tetraphenylborate
HA-93720-01 Hardness (Calcium), 0.00 To 2.70 mg/L, Colorimetric
HA-93705-01 Silica, 0.00 To 2.00 mg/L, Heteropoly Blue
HA-93719-01 Hardness (Magnesium), 0.00 To 2.00 mg/L, Colorimetric
HA-93737-01** Silver, 0.000 To 1.000 mg/L, PAN
HA-93704-01 Hydrazine, 0 To 400 μg/L, p-Dimethylaminobenzaldehyde
HA-93751-01 Sulfate, 0 To 150 mg/L, Turbidimetric
HA-93718-01 Iodine, 0.0 To 12.5 mg/L, DPD
HA-93731-01 Zinc, 0.00 To 3.00 mg/L, Zincon
HA-93721-01 Iron HR, 0.00 To 5.00 mg/L, Phenantroline
All reagents with -01 final code are for 100 tests unless noted otherwise.
HA-937520-01** Magnesium, 0 To 150 mg/L, Calmagite
* For chlorine, liquid reagents are available ** Reagents for 50 tests
87
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
HA-83224-01 Supplied W/ Sample Vials (10), Vial Cleaning Cloths (4), Scissors & Instruction Manual. (115 V) HA-94764A-25 Ammonia LR Range: 0.00 To 3.00 mg/L Method: Nessler, 25 Tests
HA-83224 Multiparameter Photometer With bar code recognition of sample vials Features • Measures Ammonia, Chlorine, COD, Nitrate, Nitrogen and Phosphorus • Bar code reader detects the method and range automatically • Three operation modes: Automatic, Semi-Automatic and Manual • Bar coded pre-dosed reagent vials • On-screen step-by-step tutorial • Logs up to 200 samples • Context sensitive help screen at a touch of a button • Selection of languages • USB connection • Graphic LCD Specifications
HA-83224
Light Source
Tungsten lamps with narrow-band interference filters
Light Detector
Silicon photocells
Data Logging
Up to 200 samples
Power Supply
230 V AC or 115 V AC power adapter
Dimensions / Weight
235 x 212 x 143 mm (9.2" x 8.34" x 5.62"), 2.3 kg (5.1 lbs)
COD Test Tube Heater
HA-94764B-25 Ammonia HR Range: 0 To 100 mg/L Method: Nessler, 25 Tests HA-93701-01 Chlorine, Free Range: 0.00 To 5.00 mg/L Method: DPD, 100 Tests
WATER ANALYSIS
A Complete Lab for Wastewater Analysis
HA-93711-01 Chlorine, Total Range: 0.00 To 5.00 mg/L Method: DPD, 100 Tests HA-94754A-25 Chemical Oxygen Demand LR Range: 0 To 150 mg/L (As COD) Method: Dichromate, Mercuric Sulfate, 25 Tests HA-94754B-25 Chemical Oxygen Demand MR Range: 0 To 1500 mg/L (As COD) Method: Dichromate, Mercuric Sulfate, 25 Tests HA-94754C-25 Chemical Oxygen Demand HR Range: 0 To 15000 mg/L (As COD) Method: Dichromate, Mercuric Sulfate, 25 Tests HA-94766-50 Nitrate Range: 0.0 To 30.0 mg/L (As NO3-N) Method: Chromotropic Acid, 50 Tests HA-94767A-50 Nitrogen, Total LR Range: 0.0 To 25.0 mg/L (As N) Method: Chromotropic Acid, 50 Tests HA-94767B-50 Nitrogen, Total HR Range: 10 To 150 mg/L (As N) Method: Chromotropic Acid, 50 Tests HA-94758B-50 Phosphorus, Acid Hydrolyzable Range: 0.00 To 1.60 mg/L (As P) Method: Ascorbic Acid, 50 Tests HA-94758A-50 Phosphorus, Reactive Range: 0.00 To 1.60 mg/L (As P) Method: Ascorbic Acid, 50 Tests HA-94763A-50 Phosphorus, Reactive HR Range: 0.0 To 32.6 mg/L (As P) Method: Vanadomolybdophosphoric Acid , 50 Tests HA-94758C-50 Phosphorus, Total Range: 0.00 To 1.15 mg/L (As P) Method: Ascorbic Acid, 50 Tests HA-94763B-50 Phosphorus, Total HR Range: 0.0 To 32.6 mg/L (As P) Method: Vanadomolybdophosphoric Acid, 50 Tests
Accuracy & Safety!
Features • The HA-839800 thermo-reactor is constructed of durable materials with a vial capacity to perform up to 25 digestions simultaneously. • The reactor is equipped with a user-selectable temperature setting to allow COD and total phosphorus reactions at 150°C and also 105°C for total nitrogen analysis. • To ensure the highest accuracy of digestion, a timer up to 120 minutes is incorporated. • An audible alarm indicates when the incubating period is completed.
HA-839800 COD Test Tube Heater HA-740216 Test Tube Cooling Rack (25 Tube Capacity) HA-740217 Laboratory Bench Safety Shield HA-151-00 Electronic Thermometer For Reactor (°C) HA-151-01 Electronic Thermometer For Reactor (°F)
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
88
Klett™ Colorimeters
WATER ANALYSIS
Use for colorimetric and turbidimetric determinations including: color, concentration, haze and density measurements and microbiology growth curves. These photometric colorimeters use specific light filters to give readings on a unique KlettTM scale. The readings are directly proportional to the concentration or optical density of a solution, in accordance with Beers Law. Two matched photocells and a suspension galvanometer give the instrument a broad range of measurement making it light and ambient temperature independent. A fully compensated and carefully balanced electrical circuit provides accuracy and consistency in readings while using simple and rugged equipment. The precision galvanometer has an illuminated logarithmic scale, graduated from 1 to 1000 KlettTM and the scale is graduated in units proportional to the optical density. Repeatability is ±0.33% of the full scale. Two units are available. The Industrial Model accepts rectangular solution cells, which can be used in either of two directions. Measurements can then be taken at depths of 10 mm, 20 mm, or 40 mm. A reduction plate is available to minimize solution depth to 2.5 mm. An adapter is available which permits the use of test tubes. The Clinical Model uses standard 14.25 x 125 mm test tubes. Calibrated or uncalibrated tubes are available. In addition, micro test tubes can be used for samples as small as 2.5 mL. Both models are supplied with the two most commonly used filters, blue for 400-450 nm and green for 520-580 nm. Additional filters are available to permit measurements over the complete visual range. Each unit has detailed instructions, standards and guides for a wide range of tests.
Durable Construction for Long Service Life Filters For Both Clinical & Industrial Models BEL-T37012-0000 KlettTM Colorimeter, Model 800-3, 115 V AC Clinical Model
BEL-T37014-0040 KS-40 Color Filter, Range: 380-430
BEL-T37012-0001 KlettTM Colorimeter, Model 800-3, 220 V AC Clinical Model
BEL-T37014-0042 KS-42 Color Filter, Blue Range: 400-450
BEL-T37013-0000 KlettTM Colorimeter, Model 900-3, 110 V AC Industrial Model
BEL-T37014-0044 KS-44 Color Filter, Range: 410-480
BEL-T37013-0001 KlettTM Colorimeter, Model 900-3, 220 V AC Industrial Model
BEL-T37014-0047 KS-47 Color Filter, Range: 445-505 *
For Klett™ Colorimeter, Clinical Model BEL-T37012-0000 BEL-T37012-0010 KlettTM 801 Test Tubes, Uncalibrated 12/Pack BEL-T37012-0020 KlettTM 802 Test Tubes, Calibrated 12/Pack BEL-T37012-1020 KlettTM Test Kit, Calibrated, Each Includes Three Test Tubes # 0,1, & 2, Test Filter & Instructions
BEL-T37014-0050 KS-50 Color Filter, Range: 470-530 * BEL-T37014-0052 KS-52 Color Filter, Range: 485-550 * BEL-T37014-0054 KS-54 Color Filter, Green Range: 520-580 BEL-T37014-0055 KS-55 Color Filter, Range: 520-600 * BEL-T37014-0056 KS-56 Color Filter, Range: 540-590
For Klett™ Colorimeter, Industrial Model BEL-T37013-0000
BEL-T37014-0059 KS-59 Color Filter, Range: 565-630
BEL-T37013-0010 KlettTM 901 Solution Cell, 20/40 mm
BEL-T37014-0060 KS-60 Color Filter, Range: 580-640 *
BEL-T37013-0020 KlettTM 902 Solution Cell, 10 mm
BEL-T37014-0062 KS-62 Color Filter, Range: 590-660 *
BEL-T37013-0030 KlettTM 903 Reduction Plate
BEL-T37014-0064 KS-64 Color Filter, Range: 620-680 *
BEL-T37013-0041 KlettTM 904M Special Test Tube Adaptor
BEL-T37014-0066 KS-66 Color Filter, Red Range: 640-700
BEL-T37013-1015 KlettTM Test Kit, Industrial, Each Includes Three Test Tubes # 0,1, & 2, Test Filter, Test Tube Adapter & Instructions
BEL-T37014-0069 KS-69 Color Filter, Range: 660-740 BEL-T37014-0070 KS-6225T Color Filter, Range: 590-660 * *Special Order
89
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Water Purification Aries Laboratory Water Purification System
ARIES-1102
Max. Flow Rate
2.0 LPM (0.5 gpm)
Max. Inlet Pressure
60 psi
Min. Inlet Pressure
20 psi
Max. Inlet Temperature
100°F
Inlet Connection
3/8" Tube
Outlet Connection
1/4" FNPT
Bacteria Filter
0.2 micron capsule
Weight
32 lbs (dry) / 38 lbs (operating)
Dimensions
25" H x 23" W x 8.5" D
WATER PURIFICATION
Features • Exceeds Type I water standards • Uses large media cartridges for low operating costs • Need for storage eliminated • Ideal for universities, hospitals, and research
Specifications
The unit takes feed water supply through three disposable cartridges and a 0.2 micron final filter to supply high purity water meeting or exceeding Type I water requirements. A quiet recirculation pump ensures consistent water purity. A built-in timer cycles the unit on and off to prevent extra wear on components and eliminates heat build up. Resistivity is temperature compensated and monitored on a digital display. Adjustable set point for notification of cartridge change out is provided. Disposable VP Series cartridges are spring loaded into position without the use of tools. Unit can be free standing or wall mounted. Direct Feed option will have a secondary port to feed auxiliary lab equipment for on-demand Type I water. Includes: a built in pressure regulator & 0.2 micron final filter. For pyrogen free water, use a 0.05 micron ultrafilter. Media cartridges not included. When feeding from a central DI, RO, or distilled water source, (3) mixed bed cartridges are recommended. Recommended feed water influent: DI, RO or Distilled.
Gemini Water System Ultrapure Water Purification Features • Exceeds Type I water standards • Highest flow rate of 3.7 LPM • Multi-pass UV with sterile dispensing port • Programmable up to four separate volumes • Ideal for reagent preparation, carboy filling, life science, and analytical systems
The Gemini Ultra High Purity System provides up to 3.7 LPM of 18.2 megohm, 0.2 micron filtered water. The multi-pass ultraviolet system irradiates the water at three separate passes in the recirculation loop. The dispensing port is continuously exposed to UV for complete sterility at the outlet. System meets and exceeds ASTM & NCCLS Type I water and ASTM Biomedical grade specifications. Volumetric dispensing is controlled by a soft touch key pad and the unit can be programmed to dispense four different set points. An integral drain basin accommodates filling large containers and controls drips and spills. Standard unit includes (2) Low TOC high purity and (1) 0.2 micron cartridges. Options available are UV TOC destruct, ultrafiltration, RO pretreatment, recirculating dispensing gun, and basinless Gemini-MB version. Recommended feed water influent: DI, RO or Distilled.
www.ereinc.com
Specifications
GEMINI-1102
Max. Flow Rate
3.7 LPM (1.0 gpm)
Max. Inlet Pressure
90 psi
Min. Inlet Pressure
20 psi
Max. Inlet Temperature
100°F
Inlet Connection
3/8" Tube
Outlet Connection
0.2" FNPT
Bacteria Filter
0.2 micron capsule
Weight
50 lbs (dry) / 55 lbs (operating)
Dimensions
24" H x 28" W x 19" D
sales@ereinc.com
90
WATER PURIFICATION
LabStrong Fi-Streem 2S Glass Stills • Patented vapor trap eliminates carry-over of contaminants in the vaporborne water droplets • Easy push-button controls for automatic operation • Fi-Streem 2S was designed with dual feed capabilities for tap or pretreated inlet feedwater • Heating elements are protected with an over-temperature switch • 24-hour automatic operation when used with the 8 L Storage Reservoir (A1052LS) • Feed Water Pressure: Minimum 15 PSI & Maximum 80 PSI
LabStrong Fi-Streem III Glass Stills (4 Liter & 8 Liter) • Patented vapor trap eliminates carry-over of contaminants in the vaporborne water droplets • Totally enclosed still assures safety from breakage or hot surfaces • Fully automatic microprocessor controls simplify operation and cleaning, while assuring high reliability • Thermistor and heat sensor offer double protection against low water conditions • For convenience, unit is designed with capabilities for tap or pretreated inlet water • Automatic start / stop feature when connected to 40 L Storage Tank (B00121) or 50 L Storage Reservoir (A1058LS) • Feed Water Pressure: Minimum 15 PSI & Maximum 80 PSI Model
Product Water Capacity
Cooling Water
Size
Operating Weight
Shipping Weight
Volts (AC)
Amps
Feed Water Type
# of Heaters
Fi-Streem 2S Glass Stills A74415-60LS
1.4 LPH
30 LPH
13.8"L x 10.5"W x 31"H
48.5 lbs
60 lbs
120 V
15
Tap / pretreated
2
A74415LS
2 LPH
30 LPH
13.8"L x 10.5"W x 31"H
48.5 lbs
60 lbs
120 V
20
Tap / pretreated
2
A74410LS
2 LPH
30 LPH
13.8"L x 10.5"W x 31"H
48.5 lbs
60 lbs
220 V
13
Tap / pretreated
2
Fi-Streem III Glass Stills A56210-857LS
4 LPH
60 LPH
15"L x 12"W x 30"H
65 lbs
74 lbs
240 V
13
Tap / pretreated
2
A56218-857LS
4 LPH
60 LPH
15"L x 12"W x 30"H
65 lbs
74 lbs
208 V
13
Tap / pretreated
2
A56220-857LS
8 LPH
120 LPH
15"L x 22"W x 30"H
80 lbs
93 lbs
240 V
30
Tap / pretreated
4
A56228-857LS
8 LPH
120 LPH
15"L x 22"W x 30"H
80 lbs
93 lbs
208 V
30
Tap / pretreated
4
Fi-Streem Hose Nipple Cartridge & Wall Mount Bracket • Lower cost alternative • Ideal for small volume, pressure applications and pretreatment of Fi-Streem stills • Optional wall mount system includes hose fittings and flow control valve • Contains activated carbon to remove organics and chlorine from feedwater • Cartridge life capacity indicated by resin color change at two windows in cartridge
91
Model
Description
Size
Weight
D00121
Hose nipple cartridge
3"L x 3"W x 17"H
3 lbs
AY0012-2
Hose nipple cartridge wall mount bracket
7"L x 3.5"W x 20"H
4 lbs
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
LabStrong Fi-Streem III Bi-Distiller Glass Stills
Specifications
A56230-857LS
A56238-857LS
Bi-Distiller
Description Product Water Capacity
4 LPH 120 LPH
Cooling Water
15"L x 22"W x 30"H
Size
80 lbs
Operating Weight Shipping Weight
93 lbs
Feed Water Type
Tap / pretreated
Maximum Pressure
80 psi
Minimum Pressure
15 psi
Volts (AC)
240 V
Amps Hz # of Heaters
2408 V 30 50 / 60 4
Fi-Streem Storage Tank 40 L Capacity
Fi-Streem Storage Reservoir 8 L Capacity
Fi-Streem Storage Reservoir 50 L Capacity
• Fully automatic operation when connected to Fi-Streem 4 L, 8 L or Bi-Distiller stills • Vent filter prevents airborne contamination • Contains sight window for observation of water level • Bench or wall mounting options • 22"L x 18"W x 25"H • Operating Weight: 124 lbs • Model: B00121
• High density polyethylene rectangular carboy • Easy installation • Portable design is ideal for transporting distilled water to different lab sites • Includes draw valve • 6"L x 11"W x 18"H • Use with 2S glass stills • Operating Weight: 19 lbs • Model: A1052LS
• Fully automatic operation when used with FiStreem 4 L, 8 L or Bi-Distiller stills • Low density polyethylene portable carboy • Includes draw valve for easy dispensing of water • 15"L x 17"W x 26"H • Operating Weight: 116 lbs • Model: A1058LS
Answers:
Page 52 • Q5: Canaries are sensitive to toxic gases. Since canaries are songbirds, they offer an early warning; they stop singing when exposed before eventually dying. • Q6: Headaches, dizziness, and confusion occur within 6 – 8 hours at even the very mild concentration of 35 ppm. Larger concentrations can result in death within minutes.
TriviaZone
Page 25 • Q1: Xenon. The compound was xenon hexafluoroplatinate. • Q2: J Page 34 • Q3: The occhiolino or "little eye" • Q4: The refrigerator. He and Leo Szilard patented an absorption refrigerator with no moving parts.
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
WATER PURIFICATION
• Patented vapor trap eliminates carry-over of vapor-borne contaminants • Totally enclosed still assures safety from breakage or hot surfaces • Double distillation process increases water purity to above 1 Megohm-cm • Glass components eliminate the leaching impurities • Fully automatic microprocessor controls simplify operation and cleaning, while assuring high reliability • 24-hour automatic control activates still as required to maintain a full reservoir • Thermistor and heat sensor offer double protection against low water conditions • For convenience, unit is designed with capabilities for tap or pretreated inlet water • Space-saving design • Bench or wall mounting options • Automatic start / stop feature when connected to 40 L Storage Tank (B00121) or 50 L Storage Reservoir (A1058LS)
92
General Laboratory Supplies
Everything a lab needs to run smoothly, everyday 93
Scienceware® "SPACE SAVER" Vacuum Desiccators
LARGE INTERIOR VOLUME The space saving design of the desiccator dome provides maximum interior clearances. They offer an average of 13% greater interior volume than standard hemispherical domes.
• •
Features • A polypropylene stopcock with a Teflon® TFE plug which turns, allowing a slow, gentle entrance of air, preventing unnecessary Flange O.D.
Part Number
•
•
I.D.
Plate
Overall Height
Overall Height
149 mm (5 7/8") 197 mm (7 3/4") 240 mm (9 7/16")
140 mm No. 3 190 mm No. 4 230 mm No. 5
206 mm (8 1/8") 260 mm (10 1/4") 311 mm (12 1/8")
121 mm (4 3/4") 157 mm (6 3/16") 197 mm (7 3/4")
149 mm (5 7/8") 197 mm (7 3/4") 240 mm (9 7/16")
140 mm No. 3 190 mm No. 4 230 mm No.5
206 mm (8 1/8") 260 mm (10 1/4") 311 mm (12 1/8")
121 mm (4 3/4") 157 mm (6 3/16") 197 mm (7 3/4")
With Polypropylene Bottom BEL-F42010-0000 BEL-F42020-0000 BEL-F42025-0000
171 mm (6 3/4") 230 mm (9 1/16") 273 mm (10 3/4")
With Clear Polycarbonate Bottom BEL-F42012-0000 BEL-F42022-0000 BEL-F42027-0000
171 mm (6 3/4") 230 mm (9 1/16") 273 mm (10 3/4")
Secador® Auto-Desiccator Cabinets Protecting valuable humidity sensitive items such as reagents or electronics is easy and totally automatic with Secador® Auto-Desiccator Cabinets. A patented electronic dehumidification system is designed to reduce the relative humidity inside the cabinet from 75 to 25% and circulate dry air automatically, freeing users from monitoring or changing chemical desiccant. All contents are easily viewed through a large clear door that seals with positive latches and can be secured closed with tamper evident seals or padlock. A dial hygrometer in the door allows for easy monitoring of relative humidity.
Secador® 3.0 AutoDesiccator Cabinets The built-in Auto-Desiccator module regenerates desiccant and circulates dry air to assure safe storage of moisture sensitive products. The Secador® 3.0 Auto-Desiccator Cabinet has 1.58 cu. ft internal volume with overall dimensions of 41.7 H x 34. 1 W x 41.4 cm D (16.4" H x 13.4" W x 16.3" D). Three perforated shelves can be removed for different contents. The door opening is 31.2 H x 22.5 cm W (12.3" H x 8.9" W) and includes 2 latches and loops for lock or tamper evident seal. Includes three shelves. Shipping weight 10 kg (22 lbs).
Dry-Keeper™ Desiccator vertical cabinet Non-vacuum with dial hygrometer in door Made of methyl-methacrylate, this desiccator cabinet provides a clear view of contents. Shelf cleats permit 15 height adjustments. Includes three shelves with vent holes and three sets of shelf rails. The gasketed door has two metal hinges, two door latches and a metal handle. A desiccant tray is also included. The door opening is 25 x 45 cm (10" x 17 7/8").
BEL-F42073-1115 Secador® 3.0 Auto-Desiccator Cabinet Clear, 120 V AC BEL-F42073-1220 Secador® 3.0 Auto-Desiccator Cabinet Clear, 230 V AC
www.ereinc.com
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
EXTRA HEAVY WALLS Clear polycarbonate top and choice of white polypropylene or polycarbonate bottom. This strong, shatterproof desiccator will hold a full vacuum (29.9" Hg 759 mm) at room temperature for 24 hours and will remain airtight even if not under vacuum. Use at room temperature only.
turbulence and crucible damage. The stopcock handle is a highly visible red and has a port which accepts 6.4 mm (1/4") I.D. tubing. A large ribbed knob at the top center for easy lifting. A neoprene O-ring seal which does not require grease, but is not harmed if grease is used. A polypropylene plate 3.2 mm (1/8") thick with 3.2 mm (1/8") diameter perforations for air transfer. The plate rests on the retaining ledge of the bottom section and has a center hole for easy removal. Choice of bottom section: Polypropylene provides excellent chemical resistance and permits the use of incandescent crucibles with standard size porcelain plates. All-clear polycarbonate bottoms are available in the same sizes.
BEL-H42056-0001 Dry-Keeper™ 32 L x 39 D x 51 cm H (12 1/2" L x 15 1/2" D x 20" H)
sales@ereinc.com
94
Secador® 4.0
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Includes three shelves The built-in Auto-Desiccator module regenerates desiccant and circulates dry air to assure safe storage of moisture sensitive products. The Secador® 4.0 Auto-Desiccator Cabinet has 1.9 cu. ft internal volume with overall dimensions of 51.8 H x 34.1 W x 41.4 cm D (20.4" H x 13.4" W x 16.3" D). Three perforated shelves can be removed for different contents. The door opening is 41.7 H x 22.5 cm W (16.4" H x 8.9" W) and includes 2 latches and loops for lock or tamper evident seal. Shipping weight 10.9 kg (23.9 lbs).
BEL-F42074-1115 Secador® 4.0 Clear, 120 V AC BEL-F42074-1116 Secador® 4.0 Clear / Blue End Caps, 120 V AC (Not Shown) BEL-F42074-1117 Secador® 4.0 Blue / Clear Door, 120 V AC (Not Shown) BEL-F42074-1220 Secador® 4.0 Clear, 230 V AC BEL-F42074-1226 Secador® 4.0 Clear / Blue End Caps, 230 V AC (Not Shown) BEL-F42074-1227 Secador® 4.0 Blue / Clear Door, 230 V AC (Not Shown)
Protect your humiditysensitive items! USE A
desiccator
Need help choosing the perfect desiccator? Toll free:
1-888-287-3732
95
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Diamond Pipettors Diamond Pipettors are a cost-effective alternative to high priced name-brand pipettors. Manufactured for high accuracy and precision, the Diamond pipettors come with a certificate of calibration, a recalibration tool kit and a full one year warranty. They are calibrated in an ISO 17025 facility.
GS-3301-10 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 0.5 - 10 µl, Color: Pink, Pipette Tip No.: 3305 GS-3301-20 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 2 - 20 µl, Color: Pink, Pipette Tip No.: 3305 GS-3301-50 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 5 - 50 µl, Color: Yellow, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3301-100 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 10 - 100 µl, Color: Blue, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3301-200 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 20 - 200 µl, Color: Lavender, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
Features • High accuracy and precision guaranteed • Autoclavable tip cone and lower section assembly • Streamlined tip ejector designed for access to narrow-necked tubes and containers • Ergonomic, lightweight and soft plunger movement provides added comfort and minimizes fatigue • Two step plunger operation allows you to use both forward and reverse pipetting techniques depending on the nature of the liquid • Color coded for easy identification
GS-3301-1000 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 100 - 1000 µl, Color: Orange, Pipette Tip No.: 3307 GS-3301-5000 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 1000 - 5000 µl, Color: Green, Pipette Tip No.: 3308B Fixed Volume with Tip Ejector GS-3302-5 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 5 µl, Color: Pink, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3302-10 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 10 µl, Color: Pink, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3302-15 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 15 µl, Color: Pink, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3302-20 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 20 µl, Color: Yellow, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
Diamond Pro
GS-3302-25 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 25 µl, Color: Yellow, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3302-30 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 30 µl, Color: Yellow, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3302-40 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 40 µl, Color: Blue, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3302-50 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 50 µl, Color: Blue, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3302-100 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 100 µl, Color: Lavender, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3302-200 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 200 µl, Color: Lavender, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3302-250 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 250 µl, Color: Orange, Pipette Tip No.: 3307 GS-3302-500 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 500 µl, Color: Orange, Pipette Tip No.: 3307 GS-3302-1000 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 1000 µl, Color: Green, Pipette Tip No.: 3307
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Adjustable Volume with Tip Ejector
GS-3302-2000 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 2000 µl, Color: Green, Pipette Tip No.: 3308B GS-3302-3000 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 3000 µl, Color: Green, Pipette Tip No.: 3308B GS-3302-5000 Diamond Pipettor, Volume: 5000 µl, Color: Green, Pipette Tip No.: 3308B
The Diamond Pro research pipettor includes all of the features of the Diamond pipettor with the addition of a super-soft elastomer grip that minimizes fatigue of hands and fingers. The unique padding not only reduces thumb stress, but also minimizes the transfer of body heat to the pipette, resulting in consistent accuracy. All Diamond pipettors come with a certificate of calibration, a recalibration tool kit and full one year warranty. They are calibrated in an ISO 17025 facility. Adjustable Volume with Tip Ejector
Fixed Volume with Tip Ejector
GS-3311-10 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 0.5 - 10 µl, Color: Red, Pipette Tip No.: 3305
GS-3312-5 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 5 µl, Color: Red, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
GS-3311-20 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 2 - 20 µl, Color: Red, Pipette Tip No.: 3305
GS-3312-10 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 10 µl, Color: Red, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
GS-3311-50 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 5 - 50 µl, Color: Yellow, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
GS-3312-15 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 15 µl, Color: Red, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
GS-3311-100 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 10 - 100 µl, Color: Blue, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
GS-3312-20 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 20 µl, Color: Yellow, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
GS-3311-200 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 20 - 200 µl, Color: Lavender, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
GS-3312-25 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 25 µl, Color: Yellow, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
GS-3311-1000 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 100 - 1000 µl, Color: Orange, Pipette Tip No.: 3307
GS-3312-50 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 50 µl, Color: Blue, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
GS-3312-500 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 500 µl, Color: Orange, Pipette Tip No.: 3307
GS-3311-5000 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 1000 - 5000 µl, Color: Green, Pipette Tip No.: 3308B
GS-3312-100 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 100 µl, Color: Lavender, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
GS-3312-1000 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 1000 µl, Color: Green, Pipette Tip No.: 3307
GS-3312-200 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 200 µl, Color: Lavender, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
GS-3312-2000 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 2000 µl, Color: Green, Pipette Tip No.: 3308B
GS-3312-250 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 250 µl, Color: Orange, Pipette Tip No.: 3307
GS-3312-5000 Diamond Pro Pipettor, Volume: 5000 µl, Color: Green, Pipette Tip No.: 3308B
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
96
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Multi-Channel with Tip Ejector
Diamond Jr. Pipettors These fixed volume pipettors are accurate, economical and half the size of a standard pipettor. They are fully autoclavable and are perfect for kits, schools and single use applications where precision pipetting is required.
Globe’s 8-channel Diamond PRO pipettors feature a 360° rotating manifold which provides universal right or left hand use. Utilizing our super-soft elastomer grips, fatigue of the hands and fingers is minimized. The unique padding not only reduces thumb stress, but also minimizes the transfer of body heat to the pipette, resulting in consistant accuracy. All Diamond pipettors come with a certificate of calibration, a recalibration tool kit and a full one year warranty.
GS-3322-5 Diamond Jr. Pipettor, Volume: 5 μl, Color: Orange, Pipette Tip No.: 3305 GS-3322-10 Diamond Jr. Pipettor, Volume: 10 μl, Color: Pink, Pipette Tip No.: 3305 GS-3322-20 Diamond Jr. Pipettor, Volume: 20 μl, Color: Green, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3322-25 Diamond Jr. Pipettor, Volume: 25 μl, Color: Green, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3322-35 Diamond Jr. Pipettor, Volume: 35 μl, Color: Blue, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3322-50 Diamond Jr. Pipettor, Volume: 50 μl, Color: Purple, Pipette Tip No.: 3306 GS-3322-100 Diamond Jr. Pipettor, Volume: 100 μl, Color: Orange, Pipette Tip No.: 3306
GS-3303-10 8 Place Multi-Channel Pipettor, Volume: 0.5 - 10 μl, Color: Red GS-3303-50 8 Place Multi-Channel Pipettor, Volume: 5 - 50 μl, Color: Yellow GS-3303-300 8 Place Multi-Channel Pipettor, Volume: 30 - 300 μl, Color: Orange
Pipette Tips Diamond Pipette Tips are molded using premium grade plastic and offer consistent accuracy when used with Diamond pipettors.
GS-3305 0.1 - 20 μl, Natural, 1000/Pack GS-3305R 0.1 - 20 μl, Natural, 96/Rack, 10 Racks/Case GS-3306 1 - 200 μl, Yellow, 1000/Pack GS-3306R 1 - 200 μl, Yellow, 1000/Rack
RV-Pette™ Repeat Volume Pipettor The RV-Pette™ Pipette provides accurate and reproducible repetitive pipetting from the single filling of a disposable tip. Use of the RV-Pette™ saves time and reduces the fatigue associated with repetitive pipetting using a standard pipettor. Twenty-nine different volumes between 1 μl and 5000 μl may be dispensed with this pipette. As many as forty-eight pipetting steps may be carried out without refilling the reservoir tip. Samples can be dispensed at intervals as fast as 1 second without compromising accuracy or reproducibility. The slender body of the RVPette™ fits comfortably in the natural contour of your hand. The plunger is located on the top of the unit, like that of a standard pipette, for easy access and reduction of hand strain. The RV-Pette™ performs best when used with Globe’s dispenser syringe tips.
Racks The Diamond Acrylic Pipettor Stand offers safe and convenient storage for pipettors.
Features • Convenient tip selection chart located on the body of the pipette • Maintenance free • Use with Globe dispenser syringe tips • Comes with a certificate of calibration and one year warranty
GS-3307 100 - 1000 μl, Blue, 1000/Pack GS-3307R 100 - 1000 μl, Blue, 1000/Rack
GS-3310-4 Holds 4 Pipettors
GS-3308B 1000 - 5000 μl, Natural, 250/Pack
97
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
GS-3250 RV-Pette™ Repeat Volume Pipettor
GS-3310-6 Holds 6 Pipettors
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Fast Release Pipette Pump™ II Pipettors
Features Rapid Release Valve for One-Handed Operation
A
Designed for fast and efficient single-handed operation with glass or plastic pipettes. Pipettes are easily inserted into a unique collar with stabilizing fingers to hold pipette securely. Rotating the knurled thumb wheel draws liquid to the desired volume. To empty rapidly, apply light pressure to the fast release lever. For gradual dispensing, rotate the thumb wheel. Easily disassembled for cleaning. Sizes are color coded. Sold individually.
A. Transpette™ 8 Channel Transfer Pipettor Economical and Disposable Now you can perform plate washing, feeding and supernatant collection with one of the most unique pipetting devices available. The Transpette™ pipettor is an inexpensive, disposable, 8-channel transfer pipettor which can deliver and remove liquids from your microwell plates without the use of pipettors and pipette tips. To avoid radiation contamination of your expensive liquid handling devices, discard the Transpette™ transfer pipettor after "hot" radioactive uses. Molded of translucent plastic, the Transpette™ pipetting device holds 600 μl per channel. Available sterile or non-sterilized. Cannot be autoclaved.
BEL-F37911-1002 Fast Release Pipette Pump™ II Pipettor, 2 mL, Blue BEL-F37911-1010 Fast Release Pipette Pump™ II Pipettor, 10 mL, Green BEL-F37911-1025 Fast Release Pipette Pump™ II Pipettor, 25 mL, Red
Vaccu-Pette/96™ Pipetting Device The Vaccu-Pette/96™ pipetting device is a 96-channel pipetting device that can aspirate or dispense 96 wells in less than 10 seconds. It speeds up repetitive washing, dispensing or aspirating all wells simultaneously. Simply connect a disposable plastic syringe to the Vaccu Pette/96™ pipetting device and withdraw the plunger to transfer liquid. Use the Vaccu Pette/96™ pipetting device to remove spent medium from cultures in preparation for feeding. Molded of transparent plastics materials, it is 127 x 86 x 37 mm high (5" x 3 3/8" x 1 7/16") and has a vacuum outlet at one end. A short length of 3.2 mm I.D. (1/8") tubing is supplied for syringe connection. Requires a 30 mL or larger disposable sterile syringe (not included). Individually packed, sterile and disposable.
Disposable Gloves RONCO SILKTEX Latex Examination Gloves 5 mil thickness
www.ereinc.com
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
B
B. Disposable Pipetting Reservoir The pipetting reservoir has a 100 mL capacity for extended multi-channel pipetting into microwell plates, Mini-Tubes, Scienceware® Cube 2ube® Tubes and deep well blocks. This design allows ample clearance for all types of pipettors. BEL-F37873-0000 Transpette™ Pipettor, Non-Sterile, 25/Bag BEL-F37876-0000E Sterile, Disposable Vaccu-Pette/96™ Pipetting Device, Each
BEL-F37877-0000 Disposable Pipetting Reservoir Bulk Packed, Non-Sterile, 50/Box
BEL-37876-0001E Autoclavable, Reusable Vaccu-Pette/96™ Pipetting Device, Each
BEL-F37877-0001 Individually Packed, Radiation Sterilized, 50/Box
Powder Free
Lightly Powdered
RO-819 SILKTEX, Size X-Small, 100/Box
RO-519 SILKTEX, Size X-Small, 100/Box
RO-829 SILKTEX, Size Small, 100/Box
RO-529 SILKTEX, Size Small, 100/Box
RO-839 SILKTEX, Size Medium, 100/Box
RO-539 SILKTEX, Size Medium, 100/Box
RO-849 SILKTEX, Size Large, 100/Box
RO-549 SILKTEX, Size Large, 100/Box
RO-859 SILKTEX, Size X-Large, 100/Box
RO-559 SILKTEX, Size X-Large, 100/Box
"Evaluated & accepted by CFIA"
"Evaluated & accepted by CFIA"
sales@ereinc.com
98
Bel-Bulb™ Pipettor
Transfer Pipettes General Purpose
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
The Bel-Bulb™ Pipettor is a simple suction device with a soft tapered chuck to fit pipettes from 6 to 8 mm in diameter. The flexible vinyl bulb is 5 cm diameter x 7 cm long (2" x 2 3/4"). After filling your pipette, remove the bulb and quickly cover the top of the pipette with a finger to hold fluid or release it as needed.
These Transfer Pipettes are offered in a variety of sizes and styles. Choose from our standard graduated and non-graduated transfer pipettes, fine tip transfer pipettes, mini transfer pipettes and extra large 12" transfer pipettes. We have the right pipette for your requirements. Produced from flexible polyethylene (PE), these pipettes are perfect for all liquid transfer applications.
GS-137035-500
GS-137030-500
GS-135030-500
Standard Pipettes-Graduated GS-137035-500 3 mL Standard Transfer Pipettes, Graduated To 1 mL, Length: 140 mm, 21 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box GS-137030-500 5 mL Standard Transfer Pipettes, Graduated To 1 mL, Length: 145 mm, 24 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box
BEL-F37887-0000B Bel-Bulb™ Pipettor, 2/Bag
GS-135030-500 7 mL Standard Transfer Pipettes, Graduated To 3 mLl, Length: 155 mm, 23 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box
Fine Tip Transfer Pipettes
Also available in larger quantities. Also available sterile.
Ideal for dispensing small volumes, loading hemocytometers and transferring liquid to and from multi-well plates.
GS-134010-500
GS-134020-400
GS-134070-250
GS-138060-500
GS-136030-500
GS-139020-500
GS-134050-500
GS-134050-S20
GS-134090-400
GS-138080-500
GS-138030-400
GS-139040-250
Fine Tip Pipettes, Non-Graduated
99
GS-134010-500 1.3 mL Fine Tip Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Length: 51 mm, 45 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box
Standard Pipettes, Non-Graduated
GS-134020-400 1.5 mL Fine Tip Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Length: 104 mm, 50 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 400/Dispenser Box
GS-138060-500 4 mL Standard Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Blood Bank Style, Length: 130 mm, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box
GS-134070-250 3.3 mL Fine Tip Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Length: 153 mm, 50 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 250/Dispenser Box
GS-136030-500 4.5 mL Standard Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Narrow Stem, Length: 155 mm, 25 Drops/ml, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box
GS-134050-500 5.8 mL Fine Tip Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Length: 147 mm, 55 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box
GS-139020-500 6.5 mL Standard Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Narrow Stem, Length: 155 mm, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box
GS-134050-S20 5.8 mL Fine Tip Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Length: 147 mm, 60 Drops/mL, Sterile, 20/Bag, 20 Bags/Case, 400/Case
GS-138080-500 7 mL Standard Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Length: 155 mm, 23 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box
GS-134060-500 5.8 mL Fine Tip Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Length: 157 mm, 50 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box
GS-138030-400 8 mL Standard Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Large Bulb, Length: 157 mm, 20 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 400/Dispenser Box
GS-134090-400 8.7 mL Fine Tip Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Length: 147 mm, 45 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 400/Dispenser Box
GS-139040-250 15 mL Standard Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Large Bulb, Length: 155 mm, Non-Sterile, 250/Dispenser Box
Also available in larger quantities.
Also available in larger quantities.
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Mini Pipettes, Graduated & Non-Graduated
Mini Transfer Pipettes
GS-138040-500 1.2 mL Mini Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Length: 65 mm, 26 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box
Ideal for use in diagnostic test kits and where small volume samples are required.
GS-134010-500 1.3 mL Mini Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Fine Tip, Length: 51 mm, 45 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box GS-134020-400 1.5 mL Mini Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Fine Tip, Length: 104 mm, 50 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 400/Dispenser Box
GS-138020-500 1.7 mL Mini Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Length: 87 mm, 27 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box GS-136020-500 4 mL Mini Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Narrow Stem, Length :85 mm, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box
GS-138040-500
GS-134010-500
GS-134020-400
GS-136036-500
Also available in larger quantities.
Extra Long Transfer Pipettes Available in 9" and 12" lengths, these pipettes are ideal for reaching into large bottles, 24 hour urine containers, cylinders and jars.
GS-139030-500*
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
GS-136036-500 1.5 mL Mini Transfer Pipettes, Graduated To 0.3 ml, Length: 115 mm, 21 Drops/mL, Non-Sterile, 500/Dispenser Box
GS-139050
GS-138020-500
GS-136020-500
Extra Long Pipettes, Non-Graduated GS-139030-500* 6 mL Extra Long Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Length: 225 mm, 28 Drops/mL, 500/Dispenser Box GS-139050 23 mL Extra Long Transfer Pipettes, Non-Graduated, Length: 300 mm, 100/Dispenser Box
Paddle Transfer Pipettes
Also available in larger quantities.
These dual-purpose pipettes are used for small volume transfers and feature an integrated rigid paddle used for mixing, spreading and smearing.
Bellows Transfer Pipettes The accordian-shaped, high capacity bulb of the Bellows Pipette acts as a reservoir for filling and expelling liquids. The bulb provides strong suction for use with viscous liquids.
GS-136080-500
GS-136070-500
Bellows Pipettes
Transfer Pipettes with Paddle, Non-Graduated
GS-138002 7 mL Bellows Pipettes, Graduated To 1.5 mL, Excellent For Food And Cosmetic Applications, 100/Bag, 20 Bags/Case, 2000/Case, SPECIAL ORDER ITEM
GS-136080-500 0.8 mL Transfer Pipettes W/ Paddle, Non-Graduated, Length: 124 mm, 50 μL Drop Size, 500/Dispenser Box, Features A Paddle At One End To Facilitate The Spreading Of Substances
GS-138005 15 mL Bellows Pipettes, Graduated To 5 mL, Excellent For Food And Cosmetic Applications, 100/Bag, 12 Bags/Case, 1200/Case, SPECIAL ORDER ITEM
GS-136070-500 1 mL Transfer Pipettes W/ Paddle, Non-Graduated, Narrow Tip, Length: 130 mm, 30 μL Drop Size, 500/Dispenser Box, Features A Paddle At One End To Facilitate The Spreading Of Substances Also available in larger quantities.
Also available in larger quantities.
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
100
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Monoject 60 cc Syringes
Features • Bold dual graduations 60 cc in 5 cc increments and 2 oz in 1/4" oz increments • Autoclavable in rigid pack • Oriented, compact package • Sterile
Specimen Containers Leak Resistant
Monoject 140 cc Piston Syringes
Features • Bold dual graduations 140 cc in 5 cc increments and 5 oz in 1/4 oz increments • Autoclavable
Syringe Tip
Qty.
Part Number
Regular Luer
100
Non-Sterile
TY-8881560182
Eccentric Luer
100
TY-8881114014
Regular Luer
20
TY-8881560141
Catheter (Irrigation)
100
TY-8881114030
Luer Lock
20
TY-8881560125
Luer Lock
100
TY-8881114055
Catheter (Irrigation)
20
TY-8881560265
Toomey Type (Irrigation)
100
Sterile Luer Lock
20
TY-8881114063
Syringe Tip
Qty.
Part Number TY-8881560224
These Tite-Rite™ containers are the ultimate in leak-tight storage and transport of liquids. An expanded inner liner in the screwcap is designed to compress against the uppermost walls and top rim of the container thereby providing an air-tight seal. Technical information • Container = Polypropylene (PP) Cap = Polyethylene (PE) • Molded graduation marks • Ideal for hospital pneumatic tube systems
GS-6518 Tite-Rite™ Containers W/ Separate White Screwcap, Clarified Polypropylene, Graduated, Capacity: 20 mL (0.66 oz), Container Dimensions: Diameter: 1 1/2" (35 mm), Height: 1 3/4", 1000/Case GS-6520 Tite-Rite™ Container W/ Separate White Screwcap, Clarified Polypropylene, Graduated, Capacity: 40 mL (1.33 oz), Container Dimensions: Diameter: 2" (48 mm), Height: 1 5/8", 600/Case
Automatic Burettes Self Zeroing Glass Burettes These burettes have easy to read blue graduations against a white background. The delivery end is fitted into a plastic push button stopcock which permits drop by drop delivery. A small screw clamp adjusts drop speed as needed for titration. A polyethylene filling tube extends from the top of the burette into the bottle reservoir. Bottle, screw cap, and round base are polyethylene. Graduation accuracy is Class B. Sold Individually
BEL-H37918-0109E Automatic Burette, 10 mL, 0.05 mL Graduations, 500 mL Reservoir BEL-H37918-0110E Automatic Burette, 15 mL, 0.10 mL Graduations, 500 mL Reservoir BEL-H37918-0111E Automatic Burette, 25 mL, 0.10 mL Graduations, 1000 mL reservoir BEL-H37918-0112E Automatic Burette, 50 mL, 0.10 mL Graduations, 1000 mL Reservoir
101
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
GS-6522 Tite-Rite™ Container W/ Separate White Screwcap, Clarified Polypropylene, Graduated, Capacity: 60 mL (2 oz), Container Dimensions: Diameter: 2" (48 mm), Height: 2 3/8", 500/Case GS-6524 Tite-Rite™ Container W/ Separate White Screwcap, Clarified Polypropylene, Graduated, Capacity: 90 mL (3 oz), Container Dimensions: Diameter: 2" (48 mm), Height: 3", 400/Case GS-6525 Tite-Rite™ Wide Mouth Container W/ Separate White Screwcap, Clarified Polypropylene, Graduated, Capacity: 90 mL (3 oz), Container Dimensions: Diameter: 2 1/4" (53 mm), Height: 2 1/2", 300/Case GS-6527 Tite-Rite™ Container W/ Separate White Screwcap, Clarified Polypropylene, Graduated, Capacity: 120 mL (4 oz), Container Dimensions: Diameter: 2 1/4" (53 mm), Height: 3 1/8", 300/Case GS-6540 Tite-Rite™ Container W/ Separate Yellow Screwcap, Polypropylene, Graduated, Capacity: 250 mL (8 oz), Container Dimensions: Diameter: 3 1/2", Height: 2 1/4", 100/Case GS-6542 Tite-Rite™ Container W/ Separate Yellow Screwcap, Polypropylene, Graduated, Capacity: 500 mL (16 oz), Container Dimensions: Diameter: 3 1/2", Height: 4 3/8", 100/Case GS-6545 Tite-Rite™ Container W/ Separate Yellow Screwcap, Polypropylene, Graduated, Capacity: 1000 mL (33 oz), Container Dimensions: 4 3/8", Height: 5 3/8", 100/Case
Fax : (514) 326 8961
4 oz (120 mL) Specimen Containers with Screw Cap
Sterile Containers: Graduated to 100 mL, individually wrapped & trilingual patient ID label (English, Spanish & French) Container = Polypropylene (PP) Cap = Polyethylene (PE)
GS-5912 4 oz Specimen Container W/ Label, Individually Wrapped, Sterile, 100/Box GS-5910 4 oz Specimen Container W/ Label, Individually Wrapped, Sterile, 200/Box GS-5915 4 oz Specimen Container, Non-Sterile, 500/Box GS-5914 4 oz Specimen Container, Non-Sterile, 100/Box GS-5916 4 oz Specimen Container W/ Affixed Thermometer & Screw Cap, Non-Sterile, 500/Box
Sample Tubes These Sample Tubes have been designed for the storage and transport of biological material. They are manufactured of non-toxic polypropylene (PP) and offer a high degree of strength and clarity. The tubes come with external threads resulting in a smooth, uniform inner surface thereby reducing the risk of contamination.
Features • Tubes withstand a temperature range of -196°C to +121°C • Round bottom tubes can be centrifuged up to 17,000 x g • Autoclavable (121°C) in an upright position with caps loosened
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Our unique 4 oz Specimen Container features the EZ-Turn 1/4 turning screw cap which is designed to assist in the prevention of carpal tunnel syndrome. The lid opens and closes with one smooth movement, which minimizes the usage of the operator’s hand and lower arm area, and reduces the stress placed on the wrist.
Non-Sterile Containers: Graduated to 100 mL & frosted writing area
Sample tubes are available in the following two types:
The screw caps for the sample tubes are made of polypropylene (PP) and are available either with or without an O-Ring.
Non-Graduated
Graduated with White Writing Area
GS-6030 1.2 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Self-Standing, 1000/Box
GS-6050 1.2 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Self-Standing, 1000/Box
GS-6031 2.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Round Bottom, 1000/Box
GS-6051 2.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Round Bottom, 1000/Box
GS-6032 2.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Self-Standing, 1000/Box
GS-6052 2.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Self-Standing, 1000/Box
GS-6033 3.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Self-Standing, 1000/Box
GS-6053 3.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Self-Standing, 1000/Box
GS-6034 4.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Round Bottom, 1000/Box
GS-6054 4.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Round Bottom, 1000/Box
GS-6035 4.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Self-Standing, 1000/Box
GS-6055 4.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Self-Standing, 1000/Box
GS-6038 5.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Round Bottom, 1000/Box
GS-6058 5.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Round Bottom, 1000/Box
GS-6039 5.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Self-Standing, 1000/Box
GS-6059 5.0 mL, Polypropylene (PP), Self-Standing, 1000/Box
Screw Cap with O-Ring
Screw Cap without O-Ring
GS-6137C Screw Cap, Natural, W/ O-Ring, 1000/Box
GS-6136 Screw Cap, Natural, 1000/Box
GS-6137B Screw Cap, Blue, W/ O-Ring, 1000/Box
GS-6136B Scre Cap, Blue, 1000/Box
GS-6137G Screw Cap, Green, W/ O-Ring, 1000/Box
GS-6136G Screw Cap, Green, 1000/Box
GS-6137P Screw Cap, Pink, W/ O-Ring, 1000/Box
GS-6136R Screw Cap, Red, 1000/Box
GS-6137R Screw Cap, Red, W/ O-Ring, 1000/Box
GS-6136W Screw Cap, White, 1000/Box
GS-6137W Screw Cap, White, W/ O-Ring, 1000/Box
GS-6136Y Screw Cap, Yellow, 1000/Box
GS-6137Y Screw Cap, Yellow, W/ O-Ring, 1000/Box
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
102
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Glass Facts Features • Maximum visibility • Impervious to permeation of gases • Shapes and volumes do not change under vacuum pressure or when handled • Recyclable • Amber glass provides UV light protection • Chemically inert • Autoclavable Cap styles also available upon request: Black Phenolic Pulp/Vinyl, Black Phenolic Polyseal™, Black Phenolic Rubber & Bottle Only Bulk packages also available
Part Number
Capacity mL (oz)
Neck Size (mm)
Qty./Case
Amber Boston Rounds Green Thermoset F217 & Teflon® Cap Style QOR-GLC-01904
60 (2)
20 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01926
120 (4)
22 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01947
240 (8)
24 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01977
480 (16)
28 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-02004
960 (32)
33 - 400
12
Ready to Clean Bottles are designed for users who prefer to use their own cleaning process. Ready to Clean bottles are fully assembled with polypropylene caps and a friction fit .015" Teflon® disc. Both cap and liner can be washed, heated or autoclaved depending upon your application. The Teflon® disc is chemically inert, and will not interfere with your test results.
Amber Wide Mouths Green Thermoset F217 & Teflon® Cap Style QOR-GLC-09083
15 (.50)
28 - 400
48
QOR-GLC-02081
30 (1)
28 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-02096
60 (2)
33 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-02190
120 (4)
38 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-02118
250 (8.5)
45 - 400
24
Amber Boston Rounds Ready to Clean Black PP Cap & Teflon® Disc Cap Style
QOR-GLC-02135
500 (16)
53 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01920
QOR-GLC-02161
950 (32)
53 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01969
QOR-GLC-05924
1,250 (42)
70 - 400
6
QOR-01997
QOR-GLC-05941
2,500 (84)
70 - 400
12
Amber Wide Mouths Ready to Clean Black PP Cap & Teflon® Disc Cap Style
Clear Boston Rounds Green Thermoset F217 & Teflon® Cap Style
Part Number
Capacity mL (oz)
Neck Size (mm)
Qty./Case
120 (4) 480 (16)
22 - 400 28 - 400
24 12
960 (32)
33 - 400
30
48
QOR-GLC-06773
15 (.50)
28 - 400
QOR-GLC-01082
30 (1)
20 - 400
48
QOR-GLC-05984
30 (1)
28 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01099
60 (2)
20 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-02183
120 (4)
38 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01123
120 (4)
22 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-02108
250 (8.5)
45 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01151
240 (8)
24 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-02127
500 (16)
53 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01185
80 (16)
28 - 400
12
Clear Boston Rounds Ready to Clean Black PP Cap & Teflon® Disc Cap Style
QOR-GLC-01217
960 (32)
33 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-07282
120 (4)
22 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01141
240 (8)
24 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01176
480 (16)
28 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01209
960 (32)
33 - 400
12
24
Clear Standard Wide Mouths Green Thermoset F217 & Teflon® Cap Style QOR-GLC-01743
120 (4)
48 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01770
240 (8)
58 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01800
480 (16)
63 - 400
24
Clear Standard Wide Mouths Ready to Clean Black PP Cap & Teflon® Disc Cap Style
QOR-GLC-01833
960 (32)
70 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01738
120 (4)
48 - 400
QOR-GLC-01858
1,920 (64)
83 - 400
6
QOR-GLC-01761
240 (8)
58 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01882
3,785 (128)
89 - 400
4
QOR-GLC-01791
480 (16)
63 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01824
960 (32)
70 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01853
1920 (64)
83 - 400
6
Clear Straight Sided Rounds Green Thermoset F217 & Teflon® Cap Style QOR-GLC-01586
103
Ready To Clean Glass Containers
30 (1)
43 - 400
48
QOR-GLC-01611
60 (2)
53 - 400
24
Clear Straight Sided Rounds Ready to Clean Black PP Cap & Teflon® Disc Cap Style
QOR-GLC-01634
120 (4)
58 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01605
60 (2)
53 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-05919
180 (6)
63 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01627
120 (4)
58 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01672
240 (8)
70 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01655
240 (8)
58 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01692
480 (16)
89 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01665
240 (8)
70 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01721
960 (32)
89 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01708
480 (16)
63 - 400
12
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Precleaned by Vacuum & Ionization
Borosilicate Sample Vials
Contaminants such as loose dirt, carton lint, aerosols, and fine glass particles are removed by the Vacuum and Ionization process.
Part Number
Capacity mL (oz)
Neck Size (mm)
Clear Sample Vials are packed in Blue Plastic Corrugate to reduce carton dust.
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Qty./ Case
Vacuum & Ionized Amber Boston Rounds Green Thermoset F217 & Teflon® Cap Style QOR-GLC-01906
60 (2)
20 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01928
120 (4)
22 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01950
240 (8)
24 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01979
480 (16)
28 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-02006
960 (32)
33 - 400
12
Black Phenolic Pulp/Vinyl Cap Style QOR-GLC-01919
60 (2)
20 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01940
120 (4)
22 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01968
240 (8)
24 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01994
480 (16)
28 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-02020
960 (32)
33 - 400
12
24
Vacuum & Ionized Amber Wide Mouths Green Thermoset F217 & Teflon® Cap Style QOR-GLC-02083
30 (1)
28 - 400
QOR-GLC-02098
60 (2)
33 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-02192
120 (40)
38 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-02120
250 (8.5)
45 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-02137
500 (16)
53 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-02164
950 (32)
53 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-07007
1250 (42)
70 - 400
6
QOR-GLC-07354
2500 (84)
70 - 400
12
Part Number
Capacity mL (oz)
Dimensions
Neck Size (mm)
Qty./ Case
Amber Borosilicate Sample Vials Green Thermoset F217 & Teflon® Cap Style
Black Phenolic Pulp/Vinyl Cap Style QOR-GLC-02090
30 (1)
28 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-06786
1.85 (.50)
12 x 35
8 - 425
QOR-GLC-02107
60 (2)
33 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-06787
4 (1)
15 x 45
13 - 425
144
QOR-GLC-02204
120 (40)
38 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-06788
7.5 (2)
17 x 60
15 - 425
144
QOR-GLC-02126
250 (8.5)
45 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-06789
15 (4)
21 x 70
18 - 400
144
QOR-GLC-02149
500 (16)
53 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01056
20 (5)
27.75 x 57
24 - 400
144
QOR-GLC-02176
950 (32)
53 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01065
40 (10)
27.50 x 95
24 - 400
144
Vacuum & Ionized Clear Boston Rounds Green Thermoset F217 & Teflon® Cap Style QOR-GLC-01085 QOR-GLC-01102
30 (1) 60 (2)
144
Green PP Hole Caps & Teflon® PTFE/Silicone Septa Cap style
20 - 400 20 - 400
48 24
QOR-GLC-01058
20 (5)
27.75 x 57
24 - 400
144
QOR-GLC-01075
40 (10)
27.50 x 95
24 - 400
144
144
QOR-GLC-01126
120 (4)
22 - 400
24
Clear Borosilicate Sample Vials Green Thermoset F217 & Teflon® Cap Style
QOR-GLC-01154
240 (8)
24 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-00978
1.85 (.50 )
12 x 35
8 - 425
QOR-GLC-01188
480 (16)
28 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-00980
4 (1)
15 x 45
13 - 425
144
QOR-GLC-01220
960 (32)
33 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-00984
7.5 (2)
17 x 60
15 - 425
144 144
Black Phenolic Pulp/Vinyl Cap Style
QOR-GLC-00988
11 (3)
19 x 65
15 - 425
QOR-GLC-01096
30 (1)
20 - 400
48
QOR-GLC-00993
15 (4)
21 x 70
18 - 400
144
QOR-GLC-01118
60 (2)
20 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-00999
20 (5)
27.25 x 57.5
24 - 400
72
QOR-GLC-01140
120 (4)
22 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-06064*
20 (5)
27.25 x 57.5
24 - 400
144
QOR-GLC-01175
240 (8)
24 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01002
22 (6)
23 x 85
20 - 400
144
QOR-GLC-01207
480 (16)
28 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01006
22 (6)
27.25 x 70
24 - 400
72
QOR-GLC-01240
960 (32)
33 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01008
30 (8)
25 x 95
22 - 400
144
QOR-GLC-01039*
40 (10)
29.25 x 81
24 - 400
144
QOR-GLC-01022*
40 (10)
27.75 x 95
24 - 414
144
QOR-GLC-07876*
60 (15)
27.5 x 140
24 - 400
72
Vacuum & Ionized Clear Standard Wide Mouths Green Thermoset F217 & Teflon® Cap Style QOR-GLC-01746 QOR-GLC-01773
120 (4) 240 (8)
48 - 400 58 - 400
24 24
QOR-GLC-01806
480 (16)
63 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-01836
960 (32)
70 - 400
12
QOR-GLC-01861 QOR-GLC-01885
1920 (64) 3785 (128)
83 - 400 89 - 400
6 4
Green PP Hole Caps & Teflon® PTFE/Silicone Septa Cap Style QOR-GLC-01016*
20 (5)
27.25 x 57.5
24 - 400
144
QOR-GLC-01031*
40 (10)
27.75 x 95
24 - 414
144
QOR-GLC-07863*
60 (15)
27.5 x 140
24 - 400
72
*Indicates item is not available in blue plastic corrugate.
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
104
Amber & Clear Round Dropper Bottles
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
With black polypropylene hole cap with glass dropper assembly.
Polystop™ Dropper Bottle The dropper pulls out leaving the polypropylene stopper to protect the neck of the glass bottle. All parts disassemble to clean. Part Number
Capacity mL (oz)
Neck Size (mm)
Qty./Case
Amber Round Dropper Bottles QOR-GLC-05725
60 (2)
20 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-05727
120 (4)
22 - 400
24
Clear Round Dropper Bottles QOR-GLC-05723
30 (1)
20 - 400
48
QOR-GLC-05724
60 (2)
20 - 400
24
QOR-GLC-05726
120 (4)
22 - 400
24
Natural Polypropylene Jars with White PP Unlined Cap Style
105
Features • Soft vinyl bulb • Ground standard taper neck in bottle • "Bumper" opening protects the tip of the glass dropper BEL-F11604-0030 Polystop™ Dropper Bottle 30 mL, Each BEL-F11604-0060 Polystop™ Dropper Bottle 50 mL, Each BEL-F11604-0125 Polystop™ Dropper Bottle 125 mL, Each
White Polypropylene Jars with White PP Unlined Cap Style
Part Number
Capacity mL (oz)
Neck Size (mm)
Qty./Case
Part Number
Capacity mL (oz)
Neck Size (mm)
Qty./Case
72
QOR-PLC-03693
30 (1)
43 - 400
72
QOR-PLC-07184
30 (1)
43 - 400
QOR-PLC-03697
60 (2)
53 - 400
48
QOR-PLC-07185
60 (2)
53 - 400
48
QOR-PLC-03701
120 (4)
58 - 400
36
QOR-PLC-07186
120 (4)
58 - 400
36
QOR-PLC-03704
240 (8)
89 - 400
36
QOR-PLC-07187
240 (8)
70 - 400
36
QOR-PLC-03717
480 (16)
89 - 400
24
QOR-PLC-07188
480 (16)
89 - 400
24
QOR-PLC-03720
960 (32)
120 - 400
24
QOR-PLC-07189
960 (32)
120 - 400
24
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Clear Polystyrene Jars with White PP SturdeeSeal® PE Foam Cap Style
Capacity mL (oz)
Neck Size (mm)
Qty./Case
QOR-PLC-03724
60 (2)
53 - 400
48
QOR-PLC-03726
120 (4)
58 - 400
36
QOR-PLC-03727
240 (8)
89 - 400
36
QOR-PLC-03729
480 (16)
89 - 400
24
QOR-PLC-03730
960 (32)
120 - 400
24
Part Number
Capacity mL (oz)
Dimensions
Neck Size (mm)
Qty./ Case
QOR-PLC-03731
18.5 (5)
25 x 50
24 mm
144
QOR-PLC-03732
26 (7)
29 x 50
28 mm
144
QOR-PLC-03733
45 (13)
33.5 x 71.5
38 mm
144
QOR-PLC-03734
60 (15)
36 x 62
43 mm
144
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Part Number
Clear Polystyrene Snap Cap Vials
HDPE Hedpaks® Natural PP Gasket Lined Cap Style
Natural HDPE Wide Mouth Rounds White PP SturdeeSeal® PE Foam Cap Style
Part Number
Capacity mL (oz)
Dimensions
Neck Size (mm)
Qty./ Case
QOR-PLA-05975
2.5 Gallon
51 - 400
3H1/Y1.2/100
104
QOR-PLA-03326
5 Gallon
70 - 400
N/A
1
Wide Mouth Natural HDPE Lab Style Bottles Part Number
Capacity mL (oz)
Neck Size (mm)
Qty./Case
QOR-PLC-03559
30 (1)
28 - 400
48
QOR-PLC-03566
60 (2)
33 - 400
48
QOR-PLC-03642
120 (4)
38 - 400
48
QOR-PLC-03582
250 (8.5)
53 - 400
Natural PP Linerless Cap Style
Part Number
Capacity mL (oz)
Neck Size (mm)
Qty./Case
48
QOR-PLA-03168
30 (1)
28 - 415
72
60 (2)
28 - 415
72 72
QOR-PLC-03596
500 (16)
53 - 400
24
QOR-PLA-03170
QOR-PLC-03610
950 (32)
53 - 400
12
QOR-PLA-03172
120 (4)
38 - 415
QOR-PLC-03621
2,000 (68)
89 - 400
6
QOR-PLA-03174
240 (8)
43 - 415
72
QOR-PLC-03628
3,000 (100)
89 - 400
4
QOR-PLA-03176
480 (16)
53 - 415
48
QOR-PLC-03549
3,840 (128)
89 - 400 †
4
QOR-PLA-03178
960 (32)
63 - 415
24
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
106
Eliminates Dangerous Drips
Safety-Vented™ Labeled Wash Bottles
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
A unique, patented, 2-piece valve prevents pressure build-up of solvents within the wash bottle. The volatiles are vented eliminating solvent drips. Patented value allows dispensing with bottle upright or inverted. Wash bottles are labeled with six of the most commonly used solvent names. Bottles are low-density polyethylene, closures and venting assembly are polypropylene. Note: Use only with solvents compatible with LDPE.
BEL-F11642-0622B Acetone, 500 mL (16 oz), 3/Bag BEL-F11642-0612B Ethyl Acetate, 500 mL (16 oz), 3/Bag BEL-F11642-0624B Isopropanol, 500 mL (16 oz), 3/Bag BEL-F11642-0638B LYOB (Label Your Own Bottle), 500 mL (16 oz), 3/Bag BEL-F11642-0623B Methanol, 500 mL (16 oz), 3/Bag BEL-F11642-0611B Methyl Ethyl Ketone (MEK), 500 mL (16 oz), 3/Bag BEL-F11643-0222B Acetone, 250 mL (8 oz), 3/Bag BEL-F11643-0224B Isopropanol, 250 mL (8 oz), 3/Bag BEL-F11643-0238B LYOB (Label Your Own Bottle), 250 mL (8 oz), 3/Bag BEL-F11643-0223B Methanol, 250 mL (8 oz), 3/Bag
Write-On™ Bottles
Fluoropolymer Bottles with Rounded Bottoms
Simplify Labeling! Large dedicated labeling areas help to standardize the way bottle contents are identified. A separate area is provided for name and a larger area allows for detail of contents or safety information and includes a defined space for date information. Bottles are molded of rugged HDPE in 500 and 1000 mL (16 & 32 oz) sizes and are available as narrow or wide mouth with leak proof polypropylene cap. Ideal for storing and transporting liquids or dry material.
Sold Individually.
FEP Wash Bottles Fluoropolymer Wash Bottles, FEP Bottles; Tefzel ETFE closure/stem and draw tube. The most chemical-resistant wash bottle. Onepiece stem and closure for leak proof service. Provides contamination-free dispensing useful for trace element work. Packaged Individually.
JIP-BTP5009-0030N Narrow Mouth PFA Bottle W/ PFA Closure, 30 mL JIP-BTP5009-0060N Narrow Mouth PFA Bottle W/ PFA Closure, 60 mL JIP-BTP5009-0125N Narrow Mouth PFA Bottle W/ PFA Closure, 125 mL JIP-BTP5009-0250N Narrow Mouth PFA Bottle W/ PFA Closure, 250 mL JIP-BTP5009-0500N Narrow Mouth PFA Bottle W/ PFA Closure, 500 mL JIP-BTP5009-1000N Narrow Mouth PFA Bottle W/ PFA Closure, 1000 mL JIP-BTF5009-0030N Narrow Mouth FEP Bottle W/ Tefzel Closure, 30 mLl JIP-BTF5009-0060N Narrow Mouth FEP Bottle W/ Tefzel Closure, 60 mL JIP-BTF5009-0125N Narrow Mouth FEP Bottle W/ Tefzel Closure, 125 mL JIP-BTF5009-0125W Wide Mouth FEP Bottle W/ Tefzel Closure, 125 mL JIP-BTF5009-0250N Narrow Mouth FEP Bottle W/ Tefzel Closure, 250 mL JIP-BTF5009-0250W Wide Mouth FEP Bottle W/ Tefzel Closure, 250 mL
BEL-F10660-0500B Write-On™ Bottles, 500 mL (16 oz), Narrow Mouth, 12/Bag BEL-F10660-1000B Write-On™ Bottles, 1000 mL (32 oz), Narrow Mouth, 6/Bag BEL-F10662-0500B Write-On™ Bottles, 500 mL (16 oz) Wide Mouth, 12/bag BEL-F10662-1000B Write-On™ Bottles, 1000 mL (32 oz) Wide Mouth, 6/Bag
107
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
JIP-BTF5009-0500N Narrow Mouth FEP Bottle W/ Tefzel Closure, 500 mL JIP-WBT5008-125F FEP Wash Bottle, 125 mL, Each JIP-WBT5008-250F FEP Wash Bottles, 250 mL, Each JIP-WBT5008-500F FEP Wash Bottles, 500 mL, Each JIP-WBT5008-1000F FEP Wash Bottles,1000 mL, Each
JIP-BTF5009-0500W Wide Mouth FEP Bottle W/ Tefzel Closure, 500 mL JIP-BTF5009-1000N Narrow Mouth FEP Bottle W/ Tefzel Closure, 1000 mL JIP-GBF5009-1000W Wide Mouth FEP Bottle W/ Tefzel Closure, 1000 mL JIP-BTF5009-2000N Narrow Mouth FEP Bottle W/ Tefzel Closure, 2000 mL
Fax : (514) 326 8961
PTFE Vials
PFA Vials with threaded closures designed primarily for storage of samples. Available with flat, conical and rounded inner style configurations. Some vials are molded with solid outside bottoms for use on hot plates. All vials also available in packs of 10 with tray. For vials with tray, add the letter "T" to the end of each catalog number for this configuration.
Features • Storage/shipping of valuable or aggressive materials • For small reactions at low pressure • Thick wall construction • Tapered inner walls for easy contents removal
All Plain Closure (Non-Septum) PFA vials available with PTFE liner inside closure. Add the letter "L" to the end of each catalog number for this configuration.
JIP-VIA0014-0025T PTFE Vial, 25 mL, 33 mm O.D., 78 mm Height, Each JIP-VIA0014-0050T PTFE Vial, 50 mL, 43 mm O.D., 78 mm Height, Each
Clavies® Autoclavable Bags
Safe, Convenient Biohazard Disposal For maximum protection and convenience when disposing of biohazardous wastes, Clavies® transparent, autoclave bags are made of .05 mm (.002") thick polypropylene. Fill the bag with used Petri dishes, membrane filters, culture plates, pipettes, etc., then autoclave and discard. The three largest sizes hold 65, 200 and 240 standard Petri dishes respectively. Steam autoclavable at 121°C (250°F). 100/Box, 10 Boxes/Case
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Fluoropolymer Vials
JIP-VIA5007-3VR 3 mL, PFA Vials, Bottom Style: Flat, Inner Style: Rounded, 23 mm, Plain Threaded Closure, Each JIP-VIA5007-6VRHD 6 mL, PFA Vials, Bottom Style: Flat, Inner Style: Rounded, 23 mm, Plain Threaded, Heavy Duty Closure, Each JIP-VIA5007-7VR 7 mL, PFA Vials, Bottom Style: Flat, Inner Style: Rounded, 24 mm, Plain Threaded Closure, Each JIP-VIA5007-15VR 15 mL, PFA Vials, Bottom Style: Flat, Inner Style: Rounded, 33 mm, Plain Threaded Closure, Each JIP-VIA5007-15VC 15 mL, PFA Vials, Bottom Style: Flat, Inner Style: Conical, 33 mm, Plain Threaded Closure, Each JIP-VIA5007-22VF 22 mL, PFA Vials, Bottom Style: Standard, Inner Style: Flat, 33 mm, Plain Threaded Closure, Each JIP-VIA5007-30VR 30 mL, PFA Vials, Bottom Style: Flat, Inner Style: Rounded, 33 mm, Plain Threaded Closure, Each JIP-VIA5007-30VC 30 mL, PFA Vials, Bottom Style: Flat, Inner Style: Conical, 33 mm, Plain Threaded Closure, Each JIP-VIA5007-60VF 60 mL, PFA Vials, Bottom Style: Flat, Inner Style: Flat, 33 mm, Plain Threaded Closure, Each
BEL-H13182-0810C Clavies® Autoclavable Bags, 20 x 25 cm (8" x 10"), 1000/Case BEL-H13182-0812C Clavies® Autoclavable Bags 20 x 30 cm (8" x 12"), 1000/Case BEL-H13182-0815C Clavies® Autoclavable Bags 20 x 38 cm (8" x 15"), 1000/Case BEL-H13182-1010C Clavies® Autoclavable Bags 25 x 25 cm (10" x 10"), 1000/Case BEL-H13182-1012C Clavies® Autoclavable Bags 25 x 30 cm (10" x 12"), 1000/Case BEL-H13182-1015C Clavies® Autoclavable Bags 25 x 38 cm (10" x 15"), 1000/Case
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
108
Whirl-Pak® Sterile Sampling Bags Sampling Bags with White Labeling Area Qty.: 500
Use these Sterile LDPE Bags to safely hold your solids and liquids. Easy-to-use, simply flip bag around wire/tape and bend wire to seal.
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
NA-B01067WA Capacity: 29 mL (1 oz), Size: 2.5" W x 5" L, Thickness: 2.25 mil
Features • Puncture-proof tabs ensure wire will not poke through even after extensive use • Sampling bags are available without or with a white labeling area • Guaranteed sterile • Reduced storage space • Easy identification • Leakproof closure
Sampling Bags without White Labeling Area Qty.: 500
NA-B01064WA Capacity: 58 mL (2 oz), Size: 3" W x 5" L, Thickness: 2.25 mil
NA-B01009WA Capacity: 58 mL (2 oz), Size: 3" W x 5" L,Thickness: 2.25 mil
NA-B01062WA Capacity: 118 mL (4 oz), Size: 3" W x 7.25" L, Thickness: 2.25 mil
NA-B00679WA Capacity: 118 mL (4 oz), Size: 3" W x 7.25" L, Thickness: 2.25 mil
NA-B01065WA Capacity: 532 mL (18 oz), Size: 4.5" W x 9" L, Thickness: 2.5 mil
NA-B00992WA Capacity: 207 mL (7 oz), Size: 3 .75" W x 7" L, Thickness: 3.0 mil
NA-B01297WA Capacity: 710 mL (24 oz), Size: 6" W x 9" L, Thickness: 3.0 mil
NA-B01018WA Capacity: 384 mL (13 oz), Size: 5.25" W x 7.5 " L, Thickness: 3.0 mil
NA-B01196WA Capacity: 710 mL (24 oz), Size: 6" W x 9" L, Thickness: 4.0 mil
NA-B00736WA Capacity: 532 mL (18 oz), Size: 4.5" W x 9" L, Thickness: 2.5 mil
NA-B01195WA Capacity: 1,627 mL (55 oz), Size: 7.5" W x 12" L, Thickness: 4.0 mil
NA-B01063WA Capacity: 710 mL (24 oz), Size: 6" W x 9" L, Thickness: 4.0 mil NA-B00990WA Capacity: 798 mL (27 oz), Size: 5" W x 12" L, Thickness: 3.0 mil
Stand-Up Sampling Bags Qty.: 500
NA-B00994WA Capacity: 1,065 mL (36 oz), Size: 5" W x 15" L, Thickness: 3.0 mil
NA-B01364WA Capacity: 118 mL (4 oz), Size: 3" W x 7.25" L, Thickness: 2.5 mil
NA-B01027WA Capacity: 1,242 mL (42 oz), Size: 6" W x 15" L, Thickness: 3.0 mil
NA-B01365WA Capacity: 532 mL (18 oz), Size: 4.5" W x 9" L, Thickness: 3.0 mil
"Speci-Sponge" Bags are designed to sample work surfaces and equipment for Listeria, Salmonella, and other food-borne pathogens. Contains a 38 x 76 mm (1.5" x 3") sponge that is free of bactericides and non-inhibitory, with write labeling area. The Whirl Pak® Stand-Up Bag gives you the freedom to perform important laboratory functions with both hands, because it will stand up completely by itself. The Whirl Pak® Retention Bag is used for long-term storage up to two years. Filter Bags contain a third layer of finely perforated polyethylene, which filters out the solids in the sample when used in a homogenizer blender.
Filter Bags (Contains Filter Layer) Qty.: 250 "Speci-Sponge" Bags for Environmental Surface Sampling Qty.: 100
NA-B01385WA Capacity: 207 mL (7 oz), Size: 3.75" W x 7" L, Thickness: 3.0 mil
NA-B01245WA Capacity: 532 mL (18 oz), Size: 4.5" W x 9" L, Thickness: 2.5 mil
NA-B01348WA Capacity: 710 mL (24 oz), Size: 6" W x 9" L, Thicknes s: 4.0 mil
NA-B01299WA Capacity: 1,627 mL (55 oz), Size: 7.5" W x 12" L, Thickness: 4.0 mil
NA-B01318WA Capacity: 1,627 mL (55 oz), Size: 7.5" W x 12" L, Thickness: 4.0 mil NA-B01416WA Capacity: 2.041 mL (69 oz), Size: 7.5" W x 15" L, Thickness: 4.0 mil
Sampling Bag Accessories Carrying Racks NA-B00677WA Double Grid 21 Compartment
Sampling Bag Accessories Playmate® Cooler
NA-B00678WA Double Grid 15 Compartment
NA-B00772WA Double Grid 18 Compartment Fits Regular Size Playmate® Cooler
NA-B00750WA Double Grid 30 Compartment
NA-B01109WA Double Grid 15 Compartment Fits Little Playmate® Cooler
NA-B00751WA Double Grid 12 Compartment
109
Sampling Bag Accessories Rack Tray for Shaking Incubation
NA-B01048WA Double Grid 6 Compartment (Also For Incubator Use)
Sampling Bag Accessories Rack Handle
NA-B01433WA Holds Rack NA-B00751WA, Medium Bags
NA-B01023WA Single Grid 18 Compartment
NA-B01309WA Rack Handle
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Single Scale Graduated Cylinders
BEL-F28452-0000E Single Scale Graduated Cylinders, Vol.: 10 mL, Subdivision: 0.2 mL, Each BEL-F28453-0000E Single Scale Graduated Cylinders, Vol.: 25 mL, Subdivision: 0.5 mL, Each BEL-F28454-0000E Single Scale Graduated Cylinders, Vol.: 50 mL, Subdivision: 1.0 mL, Each BEL-F28455-0000E Single Scale Graduated Cylinders, Vol.: 100 mL, Subdivision: 1.0 mL, Each
"No-Drip" Spout for Easy Pouring Graduated Beakers Griffin Low Form Polypropylene Beakers are translucent, chemical resistant and will stack without sticking together. Raised numeric graduations show approximate volume (±5%). All sizes are steam autoclavable at 121ºC (250ºF).
BEL-F26210-0000B Graduated Beakers, 50 mL, 12/Bag
BEL-F26215-0000B Graduated Beakers, 600 mL, 4/Bag
BEL-F26211-0000B Graduated Beakers, 100 mL, 12/Bag
BEL-F26216-0000B Graduated Beakers, 1000 mL, 3/Bag
BEL-F26212-0000B Graduated Beakers, 150 mL, 12/Bag
BEL-F26217-0000B Graduated Beakers, 2000 mL, 1/Bag
BEL-F26213-0000B Graduated Beakers, 250 mL, 6/Bag
BEL-F26219-0000B Graduated Beakers, 4000 mL, 1/Bag
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Roll-proof and easy to read! These Single Scale Graduated Cylinders have a single scale with raised numerals for easy reading. Flared top rims and large spouts facilitate pouring, and octagon-shaped bases provide stability. The "non-wetting" polypropylene surface eliminates concave meniscus and makes reading easier and more accurate. Chemically resistant and autoclavable at 121°C (250°F). Sold Individually.
BEL-F26214-0000B Graduated Beakers, 400 mL, 6/Bag
BEL-F28456-0000E Single Scale Graduated Cylinders, Vol.: 250 mL, Subdivision: 2.0 mL, Each BEL-F28457-0000E Single Scale Graduated Cylinders, Vol.: 500 mL, Subdivision: 5.0 mL, Each BEL-F28458-0000E Single Scale Graduated Cylinders, Vol.: 1000 mL, Subdivision: 10.0 mL, Each BEL-F28459-0000E Single Scale Graduated Cylinders, Vol.: 2000 mL, Subdivision: 20.0 mL, Each
Holdfast™ Graduated Cylinders
Large Volume Beakers 5 & 10 Liter Capacity Ideal for Pilot Plant Work These non-graduated beakers feature flared rims as well as spouts for quick, easy pouring when large volumes are handled. Made of polypropylene, they offer good chemical resistance and are steam autoclavable at 121ºC (250ºF).
Grip Handle for Steady Pouring The handle on a Holdfast™ Graduated Cylinder provides a secure, solid grip for superior control. The result is safer, more convenient pouring. The one-piece polypropylene cylinder will not create a meniscus. The "Total Contained, Total Delivered" double scale is accurate and easy to read, and the hexagonal base prevents tipping and rolling. The hand opening is 89 x 29 mm (3" x 1 1/8"). Steam autoclavable at 121°C (250°F).
BEL-F28461-1000E Holdfast™ Graduated Cylinders, 1000 mL, Each BEL-F28461-2000E Holdfast™ Graduated Cylinders, 2000 mL, Each
www.ereinc.com
BEL-F26219-0005E Large Volume Beaker, 5 Liter, Bottom O.D.: 16.5 cm (6 1/2"), Top O.D.: 21 cm (8 1/4"), Height: 26 cm (10 1⁄4"), Each BEL-F26219-0010E Large Volume Beaker, 10 Liter, Bottom O.D.: 22.2 cm (8 3/4"), Top O.D.: 26.6 cm (10 1/4"), Height: 31.1 cm (12 1/4"), Each
sales@ereinc.com
110
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Sterilizing Trays
PTFE Thick Wall Beakers
Lightweight and Corrosion Proof Molded polypropylene trays have rounded corners and smooth, tapered sides for nesting. Ideal for sterilizing instruments and cleaning glassware. Steam autoclavable at 121°C (250°F). Sold Individually.
Features • Isostatically molded in pure, FDA approved, PTFE • Machined base for good heat transfer • Molded-in pouring spout • Totally chemically resistant and inert
JIP-BEA5001-5 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 5 mL, Each JIP-BEA5001-10 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 10 mL, Each JIP-BEA5001-25 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 25 mL, Each JIP-BEA5001-50 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 50 mL, Each JIP-BEA5001-100 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 100 mL, Each JIP-BEA5001-150 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 150 mL, Each JIP-BEA5001-250 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 250 mL, Each JIP-BEA5001-400 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 400 mL, Each JIP-BEA5001-500 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 500 mL, Each JIP-BEA5001-600 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 600 mL, Each JIP-BEA5001-1000 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 1000 mL, Each JIP-BEA5001-2000 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 2000 mL, Each JIP-BEA5001-5000 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 5000 mL, Each
BEL-H16260-0000E Sterilizing Tray, 30 x 20 x 13 mm (12" x 7 3/4" x 5 1/8"), Each BEL-H16262-0000E Sterilizing Tray, 48 x 27 x 13 mm (19" x 10 1/2" x 5 1/8"), Each BEL-H16264-0000E Sterilizing Tray, 51 x 39 x 13 mm (20 1/4" x 15 1/2" x 5 1/8"), Each
Small Pails
Stainless Steel Storage Containers / Beakers Features • Highly non-corrosive stainless steel can be safely heated • Smooth finish provides for easy cleaning
These 7.6 Liter (8 qt) pails have an airtight lid, removable plated steel support ring and bail handle. The height is 25 cm (10") and the top I.D. is 20 cm (8"). The Scienceware® BEL-F16775-0000 pail and cover are steam autoclavable at 121°C (250°F). Packed individually.
BEL-F16771-0000E (Non-Autoclavable) White Polyethylene, Each BEL-F16775-0000E (Autoclavable) Natural Polypropylene, Each
111
JIP-BEA5001-1 PTFE Thick Wall Beakers, 1 mL, Each
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
No Pour Spout!
Part Number
Description
Dimensions (Dia. x H)
Fits Opening (IN)
Unit / Case
PW-1Y
1 1/4 Quart Bain Marie Pot
4 9/16" x 5 3/4"
4 1/4"
6
PW-2Y
2 1/6 Quart Bain Marie Pot
5 3/8" x 6 5/8"
5"
6
PW-3Y
3 Quart Bain Marie Pot
6 1/2" x 7"
6 1/16"
6
PW-4Y
4 3/4 Quart Bain Marie Pot
7 3/8" x 7 7/8"
6 13/16"
6
PW-6Y
6 1/8 Quart Bain Marie Pot
8" x 8 3/4"
7 3/8"
6
PW-8Y
8 1/4 Quart Bain Marie Pot
8 3/4" x 9 5/8"
8 1/8"
6
PW-12Y
12 1/8 Quart Bain Marie Pot
9 5/8" x 11"
9 1/8"
4
PW-1Y-2
Solid Bain Marie Covers
Cover Fits 1Y Pot
6
PW-2Y-2
Solid Bain Marie Covers
Cover Fits 2Y Pot
6
PW-3Y-2
Solid Bain Marie Covers
Cover Fits 3Y Pot
6
PW-4Y-2
Solid Bain Marie Covers
Cover Fits 4Y Pot
6
PW-6Y-2
Solid Bain Marie Covers
Cover Fits 6Y Pot
6
PW-8Y-2
Solid Bain Marie Covers
Cover Fits 8Y Pot
6
PW-12Y-2
Solid Bain Marie Covers
Cover Fits 12Y Pot
4
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Stainless Steel Graduated Measures
Stainless Steel Griffin Style Beakers Features • Seamless construction allows for safe transfer to liquids • Capacity full mark near top of beaker assures accurate measuring
Part Number
Description
Dimensions (Dia. x H)
Unit / Case
PW-T1062
16 oz Graduated Measure
3 3/4" x 4 5/8"
12
PW-T1063
32 oz Graduated Measure
4 3/4" x 5 1/4"
12
PW-T1064
64 oz Graduated Measure
5 1/2" x 6 1/2"
12
PW-125B
125 mL Griffin Style Beaker Without Handle
2 1/8" x 2 5/8"
12
PW-T1065
169 oz Graduated Measure
7" x 8 1/4"
1
PW-250B
250 mL Griffin Style Beaker Without Handle
2 5/8" x 3 1/4"
12
PW-600B
600 mL Griffin Style Beaker Without Handle
3 3/8" x 4 5/8"
6
PW-1200B
1200 mL Griffin Style Beaker Without Handle
4 1/8" x 6 1/16"
6
PW-2000B
2000 mL Griffin Style Beaker Without Handle
4 7/8" x 7 1/8"
6
PW-3000B
3000 mL Griffin Style Beaker Without Handle
5 1/2" x 8 1/4"
6
PW-4000B
4000 mL Griffin Style Beaker Without Handle
6 1/8" x 8 7/8"
4
PW-2W*
2000 mL Beaker With Closed Handle
5 1/16" x 6 5/8"
4
PW-3W*
3000 mL Beaker With Closed Handle
6 1/16" x 7"
4
PW-4W*
4000 mL Beaker With Closed Handle
6 7/8" x 8 7/8"
4
Part Number Description
Stainless Steel Funnels Features • With hanging hook & vented stem • Attached hang rings allow for convenient storage • Liquid flows smoothly through vented stem
Dimensions (Dia. x H)
Unit / Case
*No capacity mark
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Features • Graduated in ounces and cc's, measures have easy grip handles and large, smooth pouring spouts
Stainless Steel Lab / Utility Scoops Part Number Description
Dimensions (Dia. x H)
Stem Dimensions
Features • Heavy duty scoop has seamless body and strong, tubular handle for easy handling and cleaning
Unit / Case
PW-T1803F
2 3/8 oz Utility Funnel 3" x 3 3/4"
1/2" Dia. x 1 1/2" Long
6
PW-T1804F
6 3/8 oz Utility Funnel 4 1/8" x 4 7/8"
1/2" Dia. x 1 1/2" Long
6
PW-T1805F
13 oz Utility Funnel
5 1/8" x 5 5/8"
1/2" Dia. x 1 1/2" Long
6
PW-T1806F
22 1/4 oz Utility Funnel 6 1/4" x 6 5/8"
1/2" Dia. x 1 1/2" Long
6
PW-T1807F
32 oz Utility Funnel
7" x 8 3/8"
7/8" Dia. x 2 5/8" Long
6
PW-T1808F
64 oz Utility Funnel
8 3/8" x 9 1/2"
7/8" Dia. x 2 5/8" Long
3
Stainless Steel Solution Pails PW-T7009 Stainless Steel Lab / Utility Scoops, Capacity: 5 oz, Dimensions (Dia. x H): 5’’ x 2 1/2’’, Length: 9 1/2’’, Each PW-T7010 Stainless Steel Lab / Utility Scoops, Capacity: 40 oz, Dimensions (Dia. x H): 5’’ x 7 1/2’’, Length: 12’’, Each
Features • Pails are tapered for easy pouring. "Ears" for handles are an integral part of pail, resisting breakoff and allowing for easy cleaning
Stainless Steel Iodine / Oil Cups Features • Easily held during procedures
Part Number
Description
Dimensions (Dia. x H)
Unit / Case
PW-12N
13 Quart Bucket
11 5/8" x 9 1/4"
3
PW-16N
16 Quart Bucket
11 3/4" x 10 1/8"
3
PW-T20N
20 Quart Bucket
13 3/4" x 11 13/16"
3
www.ereinc.com
PW-6G Stainless Steel Iodine / Oil Cups, Capacity: 6 oz, Dimensions (Dia. x H): 3 7/16’’ x 2’’, Each PW-14G Stainless Steel Iodine / Oil Cups, Capacity: 14 oz, Dimensions (Dia. x H): 4 3/8’’ x 2 5/8’’, Each
sales@ereinc.com
112
Vibrasorb® Vibration Damping Mounts
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
No-Wire™ Autoclavable Test Tube Racks A great alternative to wire racks, with price and space saving advantages over other plastic racks currently available. These submersible racks are molded of a special blend of autoclavable polypropylene. They will sink in a water bath and maintain their stability even in agitated water. No-Wire™ racks are also perfect for use outside the water bath, and meet the exacting needs of daily usage in the lab. Supplied in numerous hole sizes, the racks are available in three colors for safety and identification in the lab. Each rack features end plates for labeling as well as numbered and lettered rows for tube identification. Interlocking feet allow stacking of racks for storage. The grid form base has holes 2.16 mm (.085") square. Assembly takes only seconds with fold up sides and end bars that lock into rack tops. Outside dimensions are all the same at 246 x 104 x 64 mm high (9.7" x 4.1" x 2.5"). Steam autoclavable at 121°C (250°F). Sold Individually. White
Red
Blue
Hold Tubes
Places
Rows
BEL-F18745-0000E
BEL-F18746-0000E
BEL-F18747-0000E
13 mm
90
6 x 15
BEL-F18745-0001E
BEL-F18746-0001E
BEL-F18747-0001E
16 mm
60
5 x 12
BEL-F18745-0002E
BEL-F18746-0002E
BEL-F18747-0002E
20 mm
40
4 x 10
BEL-F18745-0003E
BEL-F18746-0003E
BEL-F18747-0003E
25 mm
24
3x8
BEL-F18745-0004E
BEL-F18746-0004E
BEL-F18747-0004E
30 mm
21
3x7
Poxygrid® Labware Drain Stand Three rows of hairpin-loop supports (14 in all) hold labware with 18 mm I.D. necks or larger. The top row has 12 straight pins 102 mm (4") long to accommodate smaller items. A polystyrene tray at the bottom catches water as labware drains. The legs of the stand have rubber tipped feet for non-skid use on a tabletop, or the stand may be wall mounted using wire loops on the back. 43 x 17 x 48 cm H (16 3/4" x 6 1/2" x 19" H). Shipping weight 2 kg (4 1/2 lbs).
Stopcocks 2-Way and 3-Way Connections With a removable leak-proof plug made of chemical-resistant, non-stick Teflon® PTFE, these Polypropylene Stopcocks have serrated tubulations that accept 6.4 mm to 9.5 mm (1/4" to 3/8") I.D. tubing. 3-way models allow connection of any two or all three arms. Pressure rating is 240 KPa (35 psi). Sold Individually.
BEL-F30891-0000E Stopcock, 2-Way, Bore Size: 4 mm, Each BEL-F30894-0000E Stopcock, 3-Way, Bore Size: 2 mm, Each
113
BEL-F30895-0000E Stopcock, 3-Way, Bore Size: 4 mm, Each
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
BEL-H18386-0000 Vibrasorb® Vibration, 45 x 56 cm (18" x 22"), 39 kg (87 lbs) BEL-H18386-0001 Vibrasorb® Vibration, 35 x 35 cm (13 3/4" x 13 3/4"), 19 kg (42 lbs)
Cleanware™ Aqua-Clear™
BEL-F30890-0000E Stopcock, 2-Way, Bore Size: 2 mm, Each
BEL-H18805-0000 Poxygrid® Labware Drain Stand
Vibrasorb® Damping Mounts isolate sensitive analytical balances and other instruments from vibrations caused by nearby equipment such as pumps, stirrers, and blenders. Molded of dense black & white terrazzo, these 64 mm (2 1/2") thick platforms are supported on four VibroAbsorber™ cushions and neoprene feet and support up to 16 kg (35 lbs). The larger size Damping Mount will absorb vibrations down to 13 Hz. The smaller size Damping Mount will absorb vibrations down to 16 Hz with a 16 kg (35 lbs) load. With lighter loads, the minimum frequency of damping will increase to a value between 16 Hz and 25 Hz. A polished surface resists scratches and chemical attack. Overall height is 76 mm (3"). Available in two sizes.
Water Conditioner Aqua-Clear™ Water Conditioner stabilizes water in water baths and other water systems. Just 2 mL per liter of water provides long lasting protection against the growth of algae, bacteria and molds which often contaminate standing water. It also protects pumps and thermostats and helps prevent tubing from clogging. In addition, it may be added to water used in developer for color or X-ray films. It will not harm the film and permits longer use of the same solution. Aqua-Clear™ Water Conditioner adds a blue tint to the water which will fade after about 3 months reminding you to change the water and add new conditioner. 100 mL polyethylene bottle with cap. BEL-F17093-0000E Cleanware™ Aqua-Clear™, Each
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Biohazard Disposal Bags For an economical solution to biohazard waste disposal, use Scienceware® Biohazard Disposal Bags. Made of High Molecular Weight, High-Density (HMHD) polyethylene, these translucent bags can be used for the safe disposal of used pipettes, Petri dishes, culture plates, membrane filters and more. Biohazard Disposal Bags can be autoclaved at a maximum of 121°C (250°F) and discarded. The bags are .03 mm (.0012") thick and are made from material which meets or exceeds the dartimpact test requirement of 165 grams per ASTM D1709-98.
Printed with Sterilization Indicator Patch BEL-F13160-0009 Biohazard Disposal Bags W/ Label, Size: 30 x 61 cm (12" x 24"), 1/2 to 1 Gallon, 100/Box BEL-F13161-0009 Biohazard Disposal Bags W/ Label, Size: 61 x 76 cm (24" x 30"), 10 to 12 Gallons, 100/Box BEL-F13162-0009 Biohazard Disposal Bags W/ Label, Size: 61 x 91 cm (24" x 36"), 15 to 20 Gallons, 100/Box
Cleanware™ Laboratory Waste Bags Disposable waste bags with an adhesive strip across the top free bench or hood space when hung from walls, cabinets or virtually anywhere. Simply peel off the backing and hang close to your work area. The back panel is longer than the front for easy opening. White bags are made of High Molecular Weight High Density (HMHD) polyethylene which is steam autoclavable at 121°C (250°F). Maximum weight of contents should not exceed 1.36 kg (3 lbs).
Biohazard Disposal Bags - Orange-Red Orange-Red Biohazard Bags feature a printed sterilization patch that darkens when subjected to steam sterilization. A large black biohazard symbol and precautionary procedures printed in four languages are clearly visible for added safety. Made of High Molecular Weight, High-Density (HMHD) polyethylene and steam autoclavable to 121°C (250°F).
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
With Biohazard Warning Label; Look for the Sterilization Indicator Patch. Biohazard Disposal Bags are available with a printed sterilization patch that darkens when subjected to steam sterilization. The bags are printed with the standard biohazard warning symbol and precautionary procedures in four languages: English, French, German, and Spanish.
BEL-F13164-1419 Biohazard Disposal Bags, Thickness: .0317 mm, Size: 36 x 48 cm (14" x 19"), 2 to 4 Gallons, 200/Box BEL-F13164-1923 Biohazard Disposal Bags, Thickness: .0317 mm, Size: 48 x 58 cm (19" x 23"), 6 to 9 Gallons, 200/Box BEL-F13164-2535 Biohazard Disposal Bags, Thickness: .0317 mm, Size: 64 x 89 cm (25" x 35"), 10 to 12 Gallons, 200/Box BEL-F13164-3138 Biohazard Disposal Bags, Thickness: .0381 mm, Size: 79 x 97 cm (31" x 38"), 20 to 30 Gallons, 200/Box
Super Strength Biohazard Disposal Bags Extra Strength, High Impact, High Temperature Bags Reduce Autoclave Time Protect against dangerous tears and leaks with extra strong, high impact biohazard disposal bags. The orange-red bags are printed with the standard biohazard warning symbol and precautionary procedures in four languages: English, French, German and Spanish. Extra heavyduty bags are .05 mm (.002") thick blended polymer, autoclavable to 138°C (280°F) and feature a sterilization indicator patch that darkens when exposed to steam sterilization. Extra large sizes available, ask for a quotation.
BEL-F13165-1419 Super Strength Biohazard Disposal Bags, Size: 36 x 48 cm, (14" x 19"), 2 to 4 Gallons, 200/Box BEL-F13174-1008 Cleanware™ Laboratory Waste Bags, Size: 203 x 254 mm (8" x 10"), 50 bags/box BEL-F13174-1012 Cleanware™ Laboratory Waste Bags, Size: 305 x 406 mm (12" x 16"), 50 bags/box
www.ereinc.com
BEL-F13165-1923 Super Strength Biohazard Disposal Bags, Size: 48 x 58 cm, (19" x 23"), 6 to 9 Gallons, 200/Box BEL-F13165-2535 Super Strength Biohazard Disposal Bags, Size: 64 x 89 cm, (25" x 35"), 10 to 12 Gallons, 200/Box BEL-F13165-3138 Super Strength Biohazard Disposal Bags, Size: 79 x 96 cm, (31" x 38"), 20 to 30 Gallons, 200/Box
sales@ereinc.com
114
Broken Glass Disposal Boxes
Biohazard Incinerator Cartons
Maintain a safe lab with this sturdy corrugated cardboard receptacle. The box is supplied with a 2 mil thick polyethylene bag to contain broken glass fragments and spilled liquids. When the box is full, the safety cap is pulled into place and the entire unit is ready for disposal. The Broken Glass Disposal Box is printed with eye-catching graphics in four languages (English, German, French, Spanish). It is packaged flat to save space and shipping costs and is quickly assembled. Available in two sizes. The floor model holds 18 kg (40 lbs) of waste. The benchtop model holds 5.5 kg (12 lbs). Does not qualify as a DOT container.
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
No Need to Transfer Contents! Safe disposal and incineration of biohazard waste is simple and convenient with the Scienceware Biohazard Incinerator Carton. The entire carton is designed to be burned along with its contents. The corrugated cardboard receptable is supplied with a 0.038 mm (0.0015") thick High Molecular Weight, HighDensity (HMHD) polyethylene biohazard bag. A pair of tabs along the top edge keeps the bag from slipping out of place. The snug-fitting lid has a flap for easily inserting waste material. When the box is filled, the safety cap is pulled into place and the entire unit is ready for incineration. The Incinerator Carton features large, colourful biohazard graphics and instructions in four languages; English, French, German and Spanish. Packed flat to save space and shipping costs, the carton can be assembled in seconds. Available in two sizes. Features • Bag and contents protected within cardboard carton • Entire carton with its contents is intended to be burned • Fixed lid has a flap to cover and contain contents and odors
BEL-F24653-0001 Model: Floor, 30 L x 30 W x 69 cm H (12" L x 12" W x 27" H), 6.8 kg (15 lbs), 6/Pack BEL-F24653-0002 Model: Benchtop, 20 L x 20 W x 25 cm H (8" L x 8" W x 10" H), 3.2 kg (7 lbs), 6/Pack
Virgin TFE Lab Tape Clear Protective Lab Labeling Tapes
This Tape Stays Put! Go ahead, freeze it, autoclave it, even spill acids, alkalies and organic solvents on it. This tape stays put! It is resistant to chemicals and moisture. Provides great versatility for heavy-duty lab use. Test results prove that it remains securely affixed with no discoloration after being autoclaved for 40 minutes at 125°C (258°F), as well as after one week in liquid nitrogen at 196°C (-384°F). Clear polyester tapes are 1 mil (.001"), (.025 mm) thick with 1 mil of acrylic adhesive. Rolls are 32.9 meters (36 yards) long.
Features • Made from 100% Virgin Teflon PTFE • Use where non-contamination standards are high, including environmental, water, oil, chemical, medical and food processing applications • No pigments or additives • Excellent thread seal tape • Density = .4 • 3 mil thick • Temperature range of - 450°F to + 550°F • Meets or exceeds Mil Spec. T-27730A • Conveniently packaged 3 rolls/bag
JIP-TAP5075-25-5203 Virgin PTFE Lab Tape, 1/4" W x 520" L, 3 Rolls/Pack JIP-TAP5075-05-5203 Virgin PTFE Lab Tape, 1/2" W x 520" L, 3 Rolls/Pack
BEL-F13205-0001 Model: Floor, 30.5 L x 30.5 W x 68.5 H cm (12" L x 12" W x 27" H), 6/Pack BEL-F13205-0002 Model: Benchtop, 19.6 L x 19.6 W x 25.4 H cm (8" L x 8" W x 10" H), 6/Pack
115
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
JIP-TAP5075-75-5203 Virgin PTFE Lab Tape, 3/4" W x 520" L, 3 Rolls/Pack BEL-F13453-0020C Clear Protective Lab Labeling Tapes, 51 mm (2") Wide, (3 Rolls Required For 1000, 76 mm (3") Long Labels), 24/Case
JIPTAP5075-1-5203 Virgin PTFE Lab Tape, 1" W x 520" L, 3 Rolls/Pack
Fax : (514) 326 8961
A. Screw Clamp This tubing clamp offers on/off and fine control so accurate that it replaces stopcocks in many applications. It may be put in place without disconnecting tubing or interrupting your operation. Molded of DelrinÂŽ plastic, the clamp is autoclavable and resistant to acids, alkalies and organic solvents. Accepts flexible tubing up to 14 mm (1/2") O.D.
Clamp Your Tube In Place! GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
B. Spring Tubing Clamps Perfect for all flexible tubing, this positiveaction, self-closing clamp opens by squeezing the handles together. Made of chemical and stain-resistant DelrinÂŽ plastic and stainless steel.
C. Tubing Clamp Strong acetal plastic clamp with serrated jaws provides secure closure on tubing with a wall of .82 mm (1/32") or thinner. The open clamp slides over tubing for easy installation at any point and may be left clipped in an open position for convenient storage without constricting flow. It locks when closed and springs open when the locking tab is released. Jaws are 27 mm (1 1/16") long; total length is 59 mm (2 5/16") long.
BEL-F18212-0000B A. Screw Clamp, 3/Bag BEL-H18213-0000B B. Spring Tubing Clamps Fits Tubing O.D. Up To 8 mm (5/16"), 3/Bag BEL-H18214-0000B B. Spring Tubing Clamps Fits Tubing O.D. Up To 12 mm (15/32"), 3/Bag BEL-F18218-0000B C. Tubing Clamp, 12/Bag
Disposable Gloves RONCO SILKTEX
Portable Glove Box System Economical containment barrier unit ideal for isolating material to be processed. The operator and the ambient environment are protected with this lightweight, self-contained portable isolation cabinet. A large acrylic window with glove ports permits safe viewing of operations, and the 8" diameter side port allows easy insertion of material and equipment. Included large size neoprene gloves provide good protection against gas, liquid or solid penetration and are secured to the glove box with clamping rings. Body molded from LDPE with round corners throughout for easy cleaning. Overall dimensions 68.5 W x 33 D x 55 cm H (27" W x 13" D x 22" H). Shipping weight 38 lbs. BEL-H50028-2000 Glove Box System Fully Assembled W/ 1 Pair Of Gloves & 2 Clamping Rings, Ready To Use BEL-H50028-0000 Glove Box Only BEL-H50029-0000 Neoprene Gloves Replacement (Size Large), For BEL-H50028 Only BEL-H50029-0200 Clamping Rings Replacement For BEL-H50028 Only
www.ereinc.com
Latex Examination Gloves 5 mil thickness
Powder Free
Lightly Powdered
RO-819 SILKTEX, Size X-Small, 100/Box
RO-519 SILKTEX, Size X-Small, 100/Box
RO-829 SILKTEX, Size Small, 100/Box
RO-529 SILKTEX, Size Small, 100/Box
RO-839 SILKTEX, Size Medium, 100/Box
RO-539 SILKTEX, Size Medium, 100/Box
RO-849 SILKTEX, Size Large, 100/Box
RO-549 SILKTEX, Size Large, 100/Box
RO-859 SILKTEX, Size X-Large, 100/Box
RO-559 SILKTEX, Size X-Large, 100/Box
"Evaluated & accepted by CFIA"
"Evaluated & accepted by CFIA"
sales@ereinc.com
116
FEP Bench/Surface Protector
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Features • Corrosion resistant • Self-adhesive • Easy to apply • Easy to clean • Impact absorbing • Attractive
JIP-PROT18-2515 General Purpose Type PROT18 Surface Protector, Vinyl Backed FEP Material, 25’’ Wide x 15 ft JIP-PROT12-2515 High Temp Foil Surface Protector - Standard Roll, Backed FEP, 25’’ Wide x 15 ft
Labmat™ Liner & Sheets White or Biohazard Safety Orange Disposable Labmat™ Bench Liner speeds clean-up and safeguards work surfaces from stains, spills and wear. The highly absorbent upper surface traps water, dyes, corrosive chemicals and radioactive solutions. The flexible polyethylene film backing is non-skid and prevents soak-through of most solutions. The entire sheet can be rolled up and discarded after contamination.
Labmat™ Liner is 50.8 cm (20") wide and is packed in 15.2 m (50 ft) rolls, each in a handy dispenser carton. Required footage is easily cut off with scissors while the roll is retained in the dispenser. 6 Rolls (In Dispenser Cartons)/Case Cut sheets package 100/Box BEL-F24675-0000C White, 50 ft Roll, 6 Rolls/Case BEL-F24675-1000C Safety Orange For Biohazard Designated Use, 50 ft Roll, 6 Rolls/Case BEL-F24675-0020C Cut Sheets, White Only, 50.8 x 61 cm (20" x 24"), 100/Box
Polyurethane Sleeves
Shoe Covers
Features 100% Polyurethane, length: 19.5", colour: white, blue or yellow, thickness: 5.5 mil, heavy duty strength, easy to clean, resistant to wide of variety of chemicals, acids, oils, fuels, solvents, detergents, and alcohols
Features • 100% polypropylene • Colour: blue • Anti-slip strips • Durable
RO-39-368W White Polyurethane Sleeves, 100/Case
RO-1991S Shoe Covers, Small, 1000/Case
RO-39-368B Blue Polyurethane Sleeves, 100/Case
RO-1991 Shoe Covers, Regular, 1000/Case
RO-39-368Y Yellow Polyurethane Sleeves, 100/Case
RO-1991XL Shoe Covers, X-Large, 1000/Case
"Evaluated & accepted by CFIA"
21" Cova-Cap Pleated Bouffant
RO-771 White Cova-Cap, 1000/Case
Features 100% non-woven polypropylene, pleated, latex free, diameter: 21" or 24", colour: blue, green, pink, white or yellow, soft elastic headband for maximum protection and hair retention, fluid resistant, lightweight and breathable, ideal for department colour coding
RO-773 Yellow Cova-Cap, 1000/Case RO-775 Blue Cova-Cap, 1000/Case RO-777 Pink Cova-Cap, 1000/Case RO-779 Green Cova-Cap, 1000/Case
24" RO-781 White Cova-Cap, 1000/Case RO-785 Blue Cova-Cap, 1000/Case
117
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
Biodegradable, Concentrated & Residue Free! Powdered Precision Cleaner Concentrated, anionic detergent for manual and ultrasonic cleaning. Free rinsing to give you reliable results without interfering residues. Ideal for cleaning contaminants from glassware, metals, plastic, ceramic, porcelain, rubber and fiberglass. Excellent replacement for corrosive acids and hazardous solvents. USDA authorized. Dilute 1:100. pH 9.5. AL-1104-1 4 Pound Box AL-1112-1 Dispenser Box, (50 x 1/2 oz)
TERGAZYME Enzyme Active Powdered Detergent Concentrated, anionic detergent with protease enzyme for manual and ultrasonic cleaning. Excellent for removal of proteinaceous soils, tissue, blood, and body fluids from glassware, metals, plastic, ceramic, porcelain, rubber and fiberglass with no interfering residues. Ideal as a cleaning agent in Reverse Osmosis and UltraFiltration Systems. USDA authorized. Dilute 1:100. pH 9.5.
Low Foaming Critical Detergent Low foaming, heavy-duty alkaline detergent for use in labware washers, parts washers, powerspray systems, and ultrasonic cleaning systems. Concentrated, highly emulsifying and penetrating formula is free rinsing, and leaves no interfering residues. Protects interior working parts of washers. USDA authorized. Dilute 1:100. pH 13. AL-1632-1 1 Quart (Plastic Bottle) AL-1601-1 1 Gallon (Plastic Bottle)
TERGAJET Low Foaming Phosphate Free Powdered Detergent Nonionic, low foaming phosphate free powdered cleaner for use in labware washers, manual and ultrasonic cleaning. Corrosion inhibited formula recommended for glassware, metals, plastic, ceramic, porcelain, rubber and fiberglass. Free rinsing for reliable results and no interfering residues. Passes inhibitory residue test Dilute 1:200. pH 11.5. AL-2204-1 4 Pound Box
LIQUINOX
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
ALCONOX
DETOJET
Critical Cleaning Liquid Detergent Concentrated, anionic liquid detergent for manual and ultrasonic cleaning. Free rinsing to yield reliable results with no interfering residues. Extremely mild and completely soluble in hard and soft water. USDA authorized. Dilute 1:100. pH 8.5. AL-1232-1 1 Quart (Plastic Bottle)
AL-1304-1 4 Pound Box
AL-1201-1 1 Gallon (Plastic Bottle)
CITRAJET Low Foaming Liquid Acid Cleaner Low foaming, phosphate-free, concentrated, liquid cleaner and metal brightener for high performance removal of metal oxides, scale, salts and inorganic residues in labware washers, parts washers, power-spray systems and manual and ultrasonic cleaning. Corrosion inhibit-ed and free rinsing leaving no interfering residues. Ideal for acid washing and rinsing. Dilute 2:100. pH 2.5. AL-2001-1 1 Gallon
CITRANOX Liquid Acid Cleaner and Detergent Phosphate free, concentrated cleaner and metal brightener for high performance removal of metal oxides, scale, salts and inorganic residues in manual and ultrasonic cleaning. Corrosion inhibited and free rinsing for reliable results and no interfering residues. Ideal for trace metal analysis. USDA authorized. Dilute 2:100. pH 2.5. AL-1801-1 1 Gallon (Plastic Bottle)
ALCOJET
SOLUJET
Low Foaming Powdered Detergent Nonionic, low foaming cleaner for use in labware washers, parts washers, power-spray systems, manual and ultrasonic cleaning. Corrosion inhibited formula recommended for glassware, metals, plastic, ceramic, porcelain, rubber and fiberglass. Free rinsing for reliable results and no interfering residues. USDA authorized. Dilute 1:200. pH 12.
Low Foaming Phosphate Free Detergent Nonionic, low foaming phosphate free liquid cleaner for use in labware washers, manual and ultrasonic cleaning. Corrosion inhibited formula recommended for glassware, metals, plastic, ceramic, porcelain, rubber and fiberglass. Free rinsing for reliable results and no interfering residues. Passes inhibitory residue test Dilute 1:200. pH 12.4.
AL-1404-1 4 Pound Box
AL-2101-1 1 Gallon (Plastic Bottle)
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
118
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Detergent Selection Guide Application Key Concerns
Articles Cleaned/ Soil Removed
Cleaning Method
Recommended Powder
Cleaner Liquid
Healthcare/Veterinary Effective preparation for sterilization, longer instrument life. Reduce waste.
Surgical, anaesthetic, and examining instruments and equipment. Catheters and tubes. Blood, body fluids, tissue on instruments.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Machine washer, sani-sterilizer Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak
ALCONOX ALCOJET TERGAZYME
LIQUINOX (p-free) DETOJET
Pharmaceutical/Medical Device/Biotechnology Passing cleaning validation for FDA good manufacturing practices. For stainless steel, glass, plastic, elastomer cleaning.
Titanium dioxide, petrolatum, oils, emulsions, ointments, carbopols, lacquers, zinc oxides, proteins, steroids, alcohols, sugars, and Eudragit* (L/S/L30/D55/NE30D) polymers.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Machine washer, power wash, CIP
ALCONOX ALCOJET TERGAJET (p-free)
Inorganic residues, salts, metallics, pigments. Eudragit* (E/RL/RS/E100) polymers, amphoterics, coatings, amines, ethers, starches, alkaloids.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Machine washer, power wash, CIP
Protein/ferment residues. R/O, U/F membranes.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak
TERGAZYME
SOLUJET (p-free)
Glass, metal, plastic labware, ceramics, tissue culture, porcelain, clean rooms, animal cages, bioreactors, tubing, benches, safety equipment.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Machine, power spray, labware washer, washer-sterilizer, cage-washers
ALCONOX ALCOJET TERGAJET (p-free)
LIQUINOX (p-free) DETOJET SOLUJET (p-free)
Tubes, reusable pipets.
Siphon-type washer-rinsers
Microbiology, water lab, and environmental sampling. Phosphate-sensitive labware. EPA procedures. (Acid for water rinse cycle.)
Field, Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Machine washer, labware washer
TERGAJET (p-free) TERGAJET
LIQUINOX (p-free) SOLUJET-base CITRAJET-acid
Radioactive equipment/contaminants. Stopcock grease.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Machine washer, warewasher
ALCONOX ALCOJET
LIQUINOX SOLUJET
Trace metals, metal oxides, scale, salts, starches, amines.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Machine washer, warewasher
Proteinaceous soils, bio-wastes, tissue, blood and other body fluids, fermentation residues.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Glassware washer
TERGAZYME ALCOJET
Glass, ceramic, porcelain, stainless steel, plastic, rubber. Oils, chemicals, particulates.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Machine washer, power wash
Aluminum, brass, copper, and other soft metal parts. Oils, chemicals, particulates (acid for oxides, salts, buffing compound).
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak
ALCONOX ALCOJET TERGAJET (p-free) ALCONOX TERGAJET (p-free) ALCOJET TERGAJET (p-free)
Inorganics, metallic complexes, trace metals and oxides, scale, salts, metal brightening.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Parts washer, power wash
LIQUINOX (p-free) DETOJET SOLUJET (p-free) LIQUI-NOX-base CITRANOX-acid SOLUJET-base CITRAJET-acid CITRANOX CITRAJET
Silicone oils, mold-release agents, buffing compounds.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Parts washer, pressure spray
ALCONOX ALCOJET
CITRANOX SOLUJET (p-free)
Delicate substrates/neutral for waste.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Machine wash, pressure spray
LUMINOX (Neutral pH)
Circuit boards, assemblies, screens, parts, conductive residues, resins, rosins, fluxes, particulates, salts.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Machine washer, power spray board and screen washers
DETERGENT 8
Ceramic insulators and components.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Parts washers
ALCONOX ALCOJET
LIQUINOX (p-base) SOLUJET
Stainless steel, food-contact equipment.
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Machine wash, pressure wash, CIP Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak Machine wash, pressure wash, CIP Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak
ALCONOX ALCOJET
LIQUINOX DETOJET CITRANOX CITRAJET
Manual, Ultrasonic, Soak
ALCONOX
LIQUI-NOX-base CITRANOX-acid
Parts washers, power spray
ALCOJET
SOLUJET-base CITRAJET-acid
Laboratory/Environmental Reproducible results, no interfering residues, extending equipment life. Keep laboratory accreditation. Laboratory safety.
Metalworking, Precision Manufacturing, and Optics Clean parts, avoid volatile solvents, strong acids, and other hazardous chemicals.
Electronics Avoid conductive residues, avoid CFCs, pass cleaning criteria.
Food and Dairy Avoid interfering residues on food-contact equipment.
Oxides, scale, trace metals, salts, milkstone. Filter membranes. Proteins/biofouling.
Cosmetics Avoid crosscontamination.
Nuclear Avoid waste interference
Product contact surfaces (acids for pigments and salts).
Reactor cavities, pipes, tools, protective equip
Parts washer, power wash
LIQUINOX (p-free) SOLUJET (p-free)
CITRANOX CITRAJET
ALCOTABS (tablets)
CITRANOX CITRAJET
SOLUJET
TERGAZYME
Manual, Soak, Spray
DETERGENT 8
p-free=phosphate-free
More Detergent Cleaners Available ... Call for Your Free Sample! 119
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
We also carry... Jars and Containers
Graduated Cylinders and Beakers
Detergent Cleaners
Instrumentation
Water Testing Equipment
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Pipettors and Pipettes
www.ereinc.com
sales@ereinc.com
120
Filtration
GENERAL LABORATORY SUPPLIES
Laboratory Gloves
Sieves
We carry supplies for all your laboratory needs. Call for more information! 121
Phone : 1 888 287 3732
Fax : (514) 326 8961
I
A Air Sampling
1
Immersion Circulators
Sampling for Gel-Impaction Slides
1
Incubators
Sampling for Viable Bioaerosols
1
Inverted Microscopes
Anaerobic Chambers
2
Autoclaves
3
14 27-31 36
J
Bags
44
108-109, 114
Balances
K
4-11
Baths & Circulators
12-15
Baths
Knife Mills
46
12-13
Immersion Circulators
14
Cooling & Heating Circulator Baths
15
Beakers
110-112
Bottles
103-107
L Leaf Spectrometers
61 M
C Microscopes Cabinets
25-26
32-43
Elite Compound Microscopes
Carbon dioxide testing
53
Compound Microscopes
Cell Disruptors
83
Inverted Microscopes
Centrifuge tubes
17
Zoom Stereomicroscopes
32 33-35 36 37-38
Elite Microscope Cameras
38
Circulator Baths
15
Basic Microscope Cameras
39
Colony Counters
95
Meiji Techno Microscopes
Centrifuges
16-23
Compound Microscopes
33-35
Consistometers
40-43
Microscope Accessories
43
81
Containers Cryoscopes Cutting Mills
101-108
Mills & Grinders
24
Jaw Crushers
46
Rotor Mills
44-49 44 44-45
Cutting Mills D
46
Knife Mills
46
Disc Mills
47
Mortar Grinders Desiccators
94-95
Detergents
118-119
Disc Mills
47
50
Ethylene Gas Analyzer
64
47-48
Planetary Ball Mills
48-49
Mixer Mills
47-48
Molecular Biology
50-51
E Electrophoresis Systems
47
Mixer Mills
Electrophoresis Systems & Transilluminators
50
Thermal Cyclers
51
Mortar Grinders
47
O F
Osmometers
24
Oxygen and Carbon Dioxide Testing Fume Hoods & Cabinets
52-53
25-26 P G pH
General Laboratory Supplies Gloves Graduated Cylinders
93-121 116 110,112
Photosynthesis System Pipettors Planetary Ball Mills Plant Canopy Imager
54-60 63 96-100 48-49 61
Plant Physiology
61-65
Polarimeters
72-73
INDEX
Jaw Crushers
B
R Racks
97,113
Refractometers
66-73
Refractometers
66-71
Polarimeters
72-73
Root Imagers
65
INDEX
Rotor Mills
44-45
S Saccharimeters
73
Sampling Tubes
102
Sampling for Gel-Impaction Slides
1
Sampling for Viable Bioaerosol
1
Scales
4-11
Shakers & Stirrers
77-80
Sieves & Sieve Shakers
74-76
Stainless Steel
111-112
Surface Tension
81
T Tapes
115
Thermal Cyclers
51
Transilluminators
50
U Ultrasonic Sonifiers & Baths
82-85
Ultrasonics
82-83
Ultrasonic Cleaners
84-85
W Water Analysis
86-89
Water Baths
12-13
Water Purification
90-92
Z Zoom Stereomicroscopes
37-38
Don`t miss out!
Request your FREE PureSample and Enviro-Rentals Catalogs today! Toll free:
1-888-287-3732 ENVIRO-RENTALS Did you know that ERE offers sampling, monitoring and remediation equipment rentals for your projects?
PureSample Vol. 4 Offering a wide range of products in a vast 330 pages, PureSample catalog is becoming the single source supplier for sampling and monitoring of air, groundwater, wastewater and soil. Table of Contents • Air Sampling • Air Monitoring • Environmental Monitoring • Water Sampling • Water Monitoring • Laboratory • Hydrocardon Sampling & Recovery • Sludge & Sediment Sampling
• • • • • • • •
Powder & Solid Sampling Soil Sampling Soil Monitoring Field Supplies & Accessories Maintenance Health & Safetly Books Filtration / Remediation
Advantages of our Rental Program • No maintenance and calibration costs for you • Calibration certified by ERE • Rent by day, week, or month • ERE does not charge on weekends or days of transport • You don’t need space for storage of rental equipment • Gives you an option of trying equipment prior to an eventual purchase • Choose from a vast variety of equipment required specifically catered to your site needs
4
8605, Champ d’Eau Montreal, Quebec, H1P 3B8, CANADA Tel: (514) 326 8852 • Fax: (514) 326 8961 Phone: 1 888 287 3732 Web: www.ereinc.com Email: sales@ereinc.com
PLEASE CIRCULATE TO: • Laboratory Manager • Quality Control Department • Purchasing Department
BALANCES
ORDERS, SERVICE & TECH SUPPORT:
1-888-287-3732 Discounts available for bulk orders or yearly contracts!
CRYOSCOPES
pH
INCUBATORS
AIR SAMPLING
WATER PURIFICATION
www.ereinc.com
ORDERS, SERVICE & TECH SUPPORT:
1-888-287-3732
TEL
514-326-8852
sales@ereinc.com